
PART I
1 
These Regulations shall come into operation on 11th August 1986,
and may be cited as the Road Vehicles (Construction and Use) Regulations 1986.

2 
The Regulations specified in Schedule 1
are hereby revoked.
3 

(1) In these Regulations,
unless the context otherwise requires—
(a) any reference
to a numbered regulation or a numbered Schedule is a reference to the regulation
or Schedule bearing that number in these Regulations,
(b) any reference
to a numbered or lettered paragraph or sub-paragraph is a reference to the
paragraph or sub-paragraph bearing that number or letter in the regulation
or Schedule or (in the case of a sub-paragraph) paragraph in which the reference
occurs, and
(c) any reference
to a Table, or to a numbered Table, is a reference to the Table, or to the
Table bearing that number, in the regulation or Schedule in which that reference
occurs.
(2) In these Regulations,
unless the context otherwise requires, the expressions specified in column
1 of the Table have the meaning, or are to be interpreted in accordance with
the provisions, specified for them in column 2 of the Table.

TABLE(regulation 3(2))

1 2
Expression Meaning

The 1971 Act The Vehicles (Excise) Act 1971.

The 1972 Act The Road Traffic Act 1972.

The 1981 Act The Public Passenger Vehicles Act
1981.
The 1984 Act The Road Traffic Regulation Act 1984
.
The 1988 Act The Road Traffic Act 1988

The Approval Marks Regulations The Motor Vehicles (Designation of
Approval Marks) Regulations 1979.
The EC Whole Vehicle Type Approval Regulations The Motor Vehicles (EC Type Approval) Regulations 1998
The Lighting Regulations The Road Vehicles Lighting Regulations
1984.
The Plating and Testing Regulations The Goods Vehicles (Plating and Testing)
Regulations 1982.
The Type Approval Regulations The Motor Vehicles (Type Approval) Regulations 1980.
The Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations
 The Motor Vehicles (Type Approval) (Great Britain) Regulations 1984
.
The Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations Commission Regulation (EU) No 1230/2012 of 12 December 2012 implementing Regulation (EC) No 661/2009 of the European Parliament and of the Council with regard to type-approval requirements for masses and dimensions of motor vehicles and their trailers and amending Directive 2007/46/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council as amended by Commission Regulation (EU) 2019/1892 of 31 October 2019.
The Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations (Northern Ireland) Commission Regulation (EU) No 1230/2012 of 12 December 2012 implementing Regulation (EC) No 661/2009 of the European Parliament and of the Council with regard to type-approval requirements for masses and dimensions of motor vehicles and their trailers and amending Directive 2007/46/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council as amended by Commission Regulation (EU) 2019/1892 of 31 October 2019, as it has effect in Northern Ireland by virtue of the Protocol on Ireland/Northern Ireland in the EU withdrawal agreement.
The (European Union) Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations Commission Regulation (EU) No 1230/2012 of 12 December 2012 implementing Regulation (EC) No 661/2009 of the European Parliament and of the Council with regard to type-approval requirements for masses and dimensions of motor vehicles and their trailers and amending Directive 2007/46/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council as amended by Commission Regulation (EU) 2019/1892 of 31 October 2019, as it has effect in EU law.
The Type Approval for Goods Vehicles
Regulations The Motor Vehicles (Type Approval for Goods Vehicles)
(Great Britain) Regulations 1982.
The Type Approval for Agricultural Vehicles
Regulations The Agricultural or Forestry Tractors and Tractor
Components (Type Approval) Regulations 1979.

The Vehicle Approval Regulations The Road Vehicles (Approval) Regulations 2009
The Act of Accession the Treaty concerning the Accession of the Kingdom
of Denmark, Ireland, the Kingdom of Norway and the United Kingdom of Great
Britain and Northern Ireland to the European Economic Community and the European
Atomic Energy Community
aerodynamic devices and equipment devices or equipment that are designed to reduce the aerodynamic drag of road vehicles, with the exception of elongated cabs, type-approved in accordance with—(a) Article 4a of The Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations;(b) Article 4a of The Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations (Northern Ireland); or(c) Article 4a of The (European Union) Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations.
agricultural or forestry tractor an agricultural or forestry tractor within the meaning of Community Directive 82/890.
agricultural motor vehicle a motor vehicle which is constructed or adapted
for use off roads for the purpose of agriculture, horticulture or forestry
and which is primarily used for one or more of those purposes, not being a
dual-purpose vehicle.
agricultural
trailer a trailer which is constructed
or adapted for the purpose of agriculture, horticulture or forestry and which
is only used for one or more of those purposes, not being an agricultural
trailed appliance.
agricultural
trailed appliance a trailer—
(a) which is an implement constructed or
adapted—
(i) for use off roads for the purpose of
agriculture, horticulture or forestry and which is only used for one or more
of those purposes, and
(ii) so that, save in the case of an appliance
manufactured before 1st December 1985, or a towed roller, its maximum gross
weight is not more than twice its unladen weight; but
(b) which is not—
(i) a vehicle which is used primarily as
living accommodation by one or more persons, and which carries no goods or
burden except those needed by such one or more persons for the purpose of
their residence in the vehicle; or
(ii) an agricultural, horticultural or forestry
implement rigidly but not permanently mounted on any vehicle whether or not
any of the weight of the implement is supported by one or more of its own
wheels; so however that such an implement is an agricultural trailed appliance
if
 —part of the weight of the implement is supported by
one or more of its own wheels, and
 —the longitudinal axis of the greater part of the implement
is capable of articulating in the horizontal plane in relation to the longitudinal
axis of the rear portion of the vehicle on which it is mounted.
agricultural trailed
appliance conveyor an agricultural trailer
which—(a)
has an unladen weight which does not exceed 510 kg;(b) is clearly and indelibly marked with its unladen
weight;(c) has a
pneumatic tyre fitted to each one of its wheels;(d) is designed and constructed for the purpose of
conveying one agricultural trailed appliance or one agricultural, horticultural
or forestry implement.
anti-lock braking system (“ABS”)  a part of a service braking system which automatically controls the degree of slip, in the direction of rotation of the wheel or wheels, on one or more wheels of the vehicle during braking.
articulated
bus a bus so constructed that—
(a) it can be divided
into two parts, both of which are vehicles and one of which is a motor vehicle,
but cannot be so divided without the use of facilities normally available
only at a workshop; and(b)
 passengers carried by it can at all times pass from either part
to the other.
articulated
vehicle a heavy motor car or motor car,
not being an articulated bus, with a trailer so attached that part of the
trailer is superimposed on the drawing vehicle and, when the trailer is uniformly
loaded, not less than 20% of the weight of its load is borne by the drawing
vehicle.
axle any reference to the number of axles of a vehicle
is to be interpreted in accordance with paragraph (8).

axle weight in relation to each axle of a vehicle, the sum of the weights
transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels of that axle, having regard
to the provisions of paragraph (8).

braking efficiency the maximum braking force capable of being developed
by the brakes of a vehicle, expressed as a percentage of the weight of the
vehicle including any persons or load carried in the vehicle.
braking system is to be interpreted in accordance with paragraph (6).
bus a motor
vehicle which is constructed or adapted to carry more than eight seated passengers
in addition to the driver.
camera-monitor system  has the same meaning as in ECE Regulation 46.04.
car transporter  a trailer which is constructed and normally used for the purpose of carrying at least two other wheeled vehicles.
category T tractor A vehicle in “category T” as defined in Article 4(1) of Regulation (EU) No 167/2013 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 5 February 2013 on the approval and market surveillance of agricultural and forestry vehicles.

cc cubic centimetre(s).
close-coupled 
in relation to wheels on the same side of a trailer, fitted so that at all
times while the trailer is in motion they remain parallel to the longitudinal
axis of the trailer, and that the distance between the centres of their respective
areas of contract with the road surface does not exceed 1 m.
. . . . . .
cm centimetre(s).

cm2 square
centimetre(s).
coach  means a large bus with a maximum gross weight of more than 7.5 tonnes and with a maximum speed exceeding 60 mph;
Community Directive,
followed by a number the Directive adopted
by the Council or the Commission of the European Communities or the European Parliament and the Council of the European Union of which identifying
particulars are given in the item in column 3 of Table I in Schedule
2 in which that number appears in column 2;
where such a Directive amends a previous Directive mentioned in column 3(d)
of the Table  the reference to the amending Directive includes a reference to  that previous Directive as so amended.
Any reference to a Directive which has been amended
by the Act of Accession is a reference to the Directive as so amended.
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
composite trailer a combination of a converter dolly and a semi-trailer.

container an article of equipment, not being a motor vehicle or trailer,
having a volume of at least 8 cubic metres, constructed wholly or mostly of
metal and intended for repeated use for the carriage of goods or burden.
converter dolly 
(a) a trailer which is— 
(i) equipped with 2 or more wheels,
(ii) designed to be used in combination with a semi-trailer without any part of the weight of the semi-trailer being borne by the drawing vehicle, and
(iii) not itself a part either of the semi-trailer or the drawing vehicle when being so used; or
(b) a trailer which is—
(i) equipped with 2 or more wheels;
(ii) designed to be used in combination with a semi-trailer with part of the weight of the semi-trailer being borne by the drawing vehicle;
(iii) not itself a part either of the semi-trailer or the drawing vehicle when being so used; and
(iv) used solely for the purposes of agriculture, horticulture or forestry, or for any two or for all of those purposes.
Council Regulation (EEC), followed by a number
 the Regulation adopted by the Council
of the European Communities.

deck a floor or platform on which seats
are provided for the accommodation of passengers.
design weight 
in relation to the gross weight, each axle weight or the train weight of a
motor vehicle or trailer, the weight at or below which in the opinion of the
Secretary of State or of a person authorised in that behalf by the Secretary
of State the vehicle could safely be driven on roads.
double-decked vehicle a vehicle having two decks one of which is wholly or partly above
the other and each of which is provided with a gangway serving seats on that
deck only.
dual-purpose vehicle
 a vehicle constructed or adapted for
the carriage both of passengers and of goods or burden of any description,
being a vehicle of which the unladen weight does not exceed 2040 kg, and which
either—
(i) is so constructed or adapted that the
driving power of the engine is, or by the appropriate use of the controls
of the vehicle can be, transmitted to all the wheels of the vehicle; or
(ii) satisfies the following conditions as
to construction, namely—
(a) the vehicle must be permanently fitted
with a rigid roof, with or without a sliding panel;
(b) the area of the vehicle to the rear of
the driver's seat must—
(i) be permanently fitted with at least one
row of transverse seats (fixed or folding) for two or more passengers and
those seats must be properly sprung or cushioned and provided with upholstered
back-rests, attached either to the seats or to a side or the floor of the
vehicle; and
(ii) be lit on each side and at the rear
by a window or windows of glass or other transparent material having an area
or aggregate area of not less than 1850 square centimetres on each side and
not less than 770 square centimetres at the rear; and
(c) the distance between the rearmost part
of the steering wheel and the back-rests of the row of transverse seats satisfying
the requirements specified in head (i) of sub-paragraph (b)
 (or, if there is more than one such row of
seats, the distance between the rearmost part of the steering wheel and the
back-rests of the rearmost such row) must, when the seats are ready for use,
be not less than one-third of the distance between the rearmost part of the
steering wheel and the rearmost part of the floor of the vehicle.
ECE Regulation, followed by a
number the Regulation, annexed to the Agreement concerning the adoption
of uniform conditions of approval for Motor Vehicles Equipment and Parts and
reciprocal recognition thereof concluded at Geneva on 20th March 1958 as amended,
to which the United Kingdom is a party, of which identifying particulars
are given in the item in column (3)(a), (b) and (c) of Table
II in Schedule 2in which that number appears
in column (2); and where that number contains a full-stop followed by another number, it refers
to that Regulation with the amendments in force at the date specified in column
(3)(d) in that item.
elongated cab the cab of a vehicle or a combination of vehicles that complies with—(a) Appendix 5 of Annex I of The Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations;(b) Appendix 5 of Annex I of The Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations (Northern Ireland); or(c) Appendix 5 of Annex I of The (European Union) Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations.
engine power in kilowatts (kW) the maximum net power ascertained in accordance with Community Directive 80/1269.
engineering equipment  engineering plant and any other plant or equipment designed and constructed for the purpose of engineering operations.
engineering plant (a) movable plant or
equipment being a motor vehicle or trailer specially designed and constructed
for the special purposes of engineering operations, and which cannot, owing
to the requirements of those purposes, comply with all the requirements of
these Regulations and which is not constructed primarily to carry a load other
than a load being either excavated materials raised from the ground by apparatus
on the motor vehicle or trailer or materials which the vehicle or trailer
is specially designed to treat while carried thereon; or(b) a mobile crane which does not comply in all respects
with the requirements of these Regulations.
EU Tachographs Regulation Regulation (EU) No. 165/2014 of the European Parliament and of the Council on tachographs in road transport as read with the Community Drivers’ Hours and Recording Equipment Regulations 2007.
exhaust system a complete
set of components through which the exhaust gases escape from the engine unit
of a motor vehicle including those which are necessary to limit the noise
caused by the escape of those gases.
first used is to be interpreted
in accordance with paragraph (3).

Framework Directive Council Directive 70/156/EEC as amended by Council Directive 87/403/EEC, Council Directive 92/53/EEC, Commission Directive 93/81/EEC and Commission Directive 98/14/EC.
fuel cell a device in which hydrogen reacts with oxygen, creating water and generating an electric current.
gangway the space provided for obtaining access from any entrance
to the passengers' seats or from any such seat to an exit other than an emergency
exit, but excluding a staircase and any space in front of a seat which is
required only for the use of passengers occupying that seat or a seat in the
same row of seats.
gas any fuel which is wholly gaseous at 17.5°C under
a pressure of 1.013 bar absolute.
gas-fired appliance a device carried on a motor vehicle or trailer when in use on a road, which consumes gas and which is none of the following—(a) a device owned or operated by or with the authority of a gas transporter for the purposes of detecting gas;(b) an engine for the propulsion of a motor vehicle;(c) a lamp which consumes acetylene gas;(d) a fuel cell.
gas transporter a holder of a licence under section 7(1) of the Gas Act 1986 except where the holder is acting otherwise than for purposes connected with—(a) the carrying on of activities authorised by the licence;(b) the conveyance of gas through pipes which—(i) are situated in an authorised area of the licence holder; or(ii) are situated in an area which was an authorised area of the licence holder, or an authorised area of a previous holder of the licence, and were so situated at a time when it was such an area; or(c) the conveyance through pipes of gas which is in the course of being conveyed to or from a country of territory outside Great Britain.
goods
vehicle a motor vehicle or trailer constructed
or adapted for use for the carriage or haulage of goods or burden of any description.

gritting trailer a trailer which is used on a road for the purpose
of spreading grit or other matter so as to avoid or reduce the effect of ice
or snow on the road.
gross
weight (a)
in relation to a motor vehicle, the sum of the weights transmitted to the
road surface by all the wheels of the vehicle.(b) in relation to a trailer, the sum of the weights
transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels of the trailer and of any
weight of the trailer imposed on the drawing vehicle.
heavy motor car 
a mechanically propelled vehicle, not being a locomotive, a motor tractor,
or a motor carry, which is constructed itself to carry a load or passengers
and the weight of which unladen exceeds 2540 kg.
indivisible load 
a load which cannot without undue expense or risk of damage be divided into
two or more loads for the purpose of conveyance on a road.
industrial tractor a tractor, not being an agricultural motor vehicle, which—
(a) has an unladen
weight not exceeding 7370 kg,
(b) is designed and used primarily for work off roads, or for work
on roads in connection only with road construction or maintenance (including
any such tractor when fitted with an implement or implements designed primarily
for use in connection with such work, whether or not any such implement is
of itself designed to carry a load), and
(c) has a maximum speed not exceeding 20 mph.
intermodal transport operation shall be construed in accordance with paragraph 9(3) of Part IV of Schedule 11A.
invalid carriage 
a mechanically propelled vehicle the weight of which unladen does not exceed
254 kg and which is specially designed and constructed, and not merely adapted,
for the use of a person suffering from some physical defect or disability
and is solely used by such a person.
ISO  International Organisation for Standardisation.
ISO 7638 connector  an electrical connector that complies with standard ISO 7638: 1997–1 or ISO 7638: 1997–2 and is used to provide a dedicated power supply and a communication link between the tow vehicle and trailer.
kerbside weight the weight
of a vehicle when it carries—
(a) in the case of a motor vehicle, 
(i) no person; and
(ii) a full supply of fuel in its tank, an
adequate supply of other liquids incidental to its propulsion and no load
other than the loose tools and equipment with which it is normally equipped;

(b) in the case of a trailer, no person and
is otherwise unladen.
kg kilogram(s).
km/h kilometre(s)
per hour.
kW kilowatt(s).
large bus  means a vehicle constructed or adapted to carry more than 16 seated passengers in addition to the driver;
light trailer  a trailer with a maximum gross weight which does not exceed 3500 kg.
liquefied petroleum gas (a) butane gas in any phase which meets the requirements contained in the specification of commercial butane and propane issued by the British Standards Institution under the number BS 4250: 2014 and published on 30th November 2014; or(b) propane gas in any phase which meets the requirements contained in the said specification; or(c) any mixture of such butane gas and such propane gas.

living van a vehicle used primarily as
living accommodation by one or more persons, and which is not also used for
the carriage of goods or burden which are not needed by such one or more persons
for the purpose of their residence in the vehicle.
locomotive a mechanically
propelled vehicle which is not constructed itself to carry a load other than
the following articles, that is to say, water, fuel, accumulators and other
equipment used for the purpose of propulsion, loose tools and loose equipment,
and the weight of which unladen exceeds 7370 kg.
longitudinal plane 
a vertical plane parallel to the longitudinal axis of a vehicle.
low platform trailer  
a trailer fitted with tyres with a rim diameter size code of less than 20 and displaying a rectangular plate which–

(a) is at least 225 mm wide and at least 175 mm high; and
(b) bears two black letters “L” on a white ground each at least 125 mm high and 90 mm wide with a stroke width of 12 mm.
low loader  
a semi-trailer which is constructed and nor mally used for the carriage of engineering equipment so constructed that the major part of the load platform does not extend over or between the wheels and the upper surface of which is below the height of the top most point of the tyres of those wheels, measured on level ground and when–

(a) any adjustable suspension is at the normal travelling height,
(b) all pneumatic tyres are suitably infl ated for use when the vehicle is fully laden, and
(c) the semi-trailer is unladen,

(see also the definition of stepframe low loader).

m 
metre(s).
m2
 square metre(s).
m3 cubic metre(s).
maximum permitted axle weight  
in relation to an axle–

(a) in the case of a vehicle which is equipped with a Ministry plate in accordance with regulation 70, the axle weight shown in column (2) of that plate (where the plate is in the form required by  Schedule 10 or 10B) or in column (2) of that plate (where the plate is in the form required by  Schedule 10A or 10C) in relation to that axle;
(b) in the case of a vehicle which is not equipped with a Ministry plate but which is equipped with a plate in accordance with regulation 66, the maximum axle weight shown for that axle on the plate in respect of item 9 of Part I of Schedule 8 in the case of a motor vehicle and item 7 of Part II of Schedule 8 in the case of a trailer; and
(c) in any other case, the weight which the axle is designed or adapted not to exceed when the vehicle is travelling on a road.
maximum gross weight (a) in the case of a vehicle equipped with a Ministry
plate in accordance with regulation 70,
the design gross weight shown in column (3) of that plate or, if no such weight
is shown, the gross weight shown in column (2) of that plate (where the plate is in the form required by Schedule 10 or 10B) or in column (4) of that plate (where the plate is in the form required by Schedule 10A or 10C).;(b) in the case of a vehicle
not equipped with a Ministry plate, but which is equipped with a plate in
accordance with regulation 66,
the maximum gross weight shown on the plate in respect of item 7 of Part 1 of Schedule 8
in the case of a motor vehicle and item 6 of Part II of Schedule
8 in the case of a trailer;(c) in any other case, the weight which the vehicle
is designed or adapted not to exceed when the vehicle is travelling on a road.

maximum total design axle weight (an expression used only in relation to trailers)  
(a) in the case of a trailer equipped with a Ministry plate in accordance with regulation 70, the sum of the relevant axle weights;
(b) in the case of a trailer which is not equipped with a Ministry plate, but which is equipped with a plate in accordance with regulation 66, the sum of the maximum axle weights shown on the plate in respect of item 4 of Part II of Schedule 8; or
(c) in the case of any other trailer, the sum of the axle weights which the trailer is designed or adapted not to exceed when the vehicle is travelling on a road;
and for the purposes of sub-paragraph (a) the relevant axle weight, in respect to an axle, is the design axle weight shown in column (3) of the Ministry plate (where the plate is in the form required by Schedule 10 or 10B) or in column (4) of that plate (where the plate is in the form required by Schedule 10A or 10C) in relation to that axle or if no such weight is shown, the axle weight shown in column (2) of that plate in relation to that axle;
maximum speed the speed which a vehicle is incapable, by reason
of its construction, of exceeding on the level under its own power when fully
laden.
minibus a motor vehicle which is constructed or adapted
to carry more than 8 but not more than 16 seated passengers in addition to
the driver.
Ministry plate
 is to be interpreted in accordance with regulation 70.
mm 
millimetre(s).
motor ambulance
 a motor vehicle which is specially designed
and constructed (and not merely adapted) for carrying, as equipment permanently
fixed to the vehicle, equipment used for medical, dental, or other health
purposes and is used primarily for the carriage of persons suffering from
illness, injury or disability.

motor car a mechanically propelled vehicle,
not being a motor tractor, a motor cycle or an invalid carriage, which is
constructed itself to carry a load or passengers and the weight of which unladen—
(a) if it is constructed
solely for the carriage of passengers and their effects and is adapted to
carry not more than seven passengers exclusive of the driver does not exceed
3050 kg;(b) if it
is constructed for use for the conveyance of goods or burden of any description,
does not exceed 3050 kg;(c)
 does not exceed 2540 kg in a case falling within neither of the
foregoing paragraphs.
motor caravan  means a motor vehicle which is constructed or adapted for the carriage of passengers and their effects and which contains, as permanently installed equipment, the facilities which are reasonably necessary for enabling the vehicle to provide mobile living accommodation for its users;
motor
cycle a mechanically propelled vehicle,
not being an invalid carriage, having less than four wheels and the weight
of which unladen does not exceed 410 kg.
motor tractor a mechanically
propelled vehicle which is not constructed itself to carry a load, other than
the following articles, that is to say, water, fuel, accumulators and other
equipment used for the purpose of propulsion, loose tools and loose equipment,
and the weight of which unladen does not exceed 7370 kg.
motor vehicle 
a mechanically propelled vehicle intended or adapted for use on roads.
mph 
mile(s) per hour.
N/mm
2 newton(s) per square
millimetre.
an NHS ambulance service 
(a) an NHS trust or NHS foundation trust established under the National Health Service Act 2006 which has a function of providing ambulance services;
(b) an NHS trust established under the National Health Service (Wales) Act 2006 which has a function of providing ambulance services;
(c) the Scottish Ambulance Service Board.
off-road vehicle  an off-road vehicle as defined in Annex I to Council Directive 70/156/EEC of 6th February 1970 as read with Council Directive 87/403/EEC of 25th June 1987.
overall height
 the vertical distance between the ground
and the point on the vehicle which is furthest from the ground, calculated
when—(a) the
tyres of the vehicle are suitably inflated for the use to which it is being
put;(b) the vehicle
is at its unladen weight; and
(c) the surface of the ground under the vehicle is reasonably flat;
but, in the case of a trolley bus, exclusive of the
power collection equipment mounted on the roof of the vehicle.
overall length in relation to a vehicle, the distance between transverse planes
passing through the extreme forward and rearward projecting points of the
vehicle inclusive of all parts of the vehicle, of any receptacle which is
of a permanent character and accordingly strong enough for repeated use, and
any fitting on, or attached to, the vehicle except—
(i) for all purposes— 
(a) any driving mirror;
(b) any expanding or extensible contrivance
forming part of a turntable fire escape fixed to a vehicle;
(c) any snow-plough fixed in front of a vehicle;

(d) any receptacle specially designed to
hold and keep secure a seal issued for the purposes of customs clearance;

(e) any tailboard which is let down while
the vehicle is stationary in order to facilitate its loading or unloading;

(f) any tailboard which is let down in order
to facilitate the carriage of, but which is not essential for the support
of, loads which are in themselves so long as to extend at least as far as
the tailboard when upright;
(g) any fitting attached to a part of, or
to a receptacle on, a vehicle which does not increase the carrying capacity
of the part or receptacle but which enables it to be 
 —transferred from a road vehicle to a railway vehicle
or from a railway vehicle to a road vehicle,
 —secured to a railway vehicle by a locking device, and

 —carried on a railway vehicle by the use of stanchions:

(h) any plate, whether rigid or movable,
fitted to a trailer constructed for the purpose of carrying other vehicles
and designed to bridge the gap between that trailer and a motor vehicle constructed
for that purpose and to which the trailer is attached so that, while the trailer
is attached to the motor vehicle, vehicles which are to be carried by the
motor vehicle may be moved from the trailer to the motor vehicle before a
journey begins, and vehicles which have been carried on the motor vehicle
may be moved from it to the trailer after a journey ends;
(i) any sheeting or other readily flexible
means of covering or securing a load;
(j) ...
(k) any empty receptacle which itself forms
a load;  
(l) any receptacle which contains an indivisible
load of exceptional length;
(m) any receptacle manufactured before 30th
October 1985, not being a maritime container (namely a container designed
primarily for carriage on sea transport without an accompanying road vehicle);
...
(n) any special appliance or apparatus as
described in regulation 81(c)
which does not itself increase the carrying capacity of the vehicle; ...
(o) any rearward projecting buffer made of rubber or other resilient material; ... 
(p) any aerodynamic devices and equipment; or
(q)  any camera-monitor system.
(ii) for the purposes of   regulations 7, 13A, 13B and 13C— 
(a) any part of a trailer (not being in the
case of an agricultural trailed appliance a drawbar or other thing with which
it is equipped for the purpose of being towed) designed primarily for use
as a means of attaching it to another vehicle and any fitting designed for
use in connection with any such part;
(b) the thickness of any front or rear wall
on a semi-trailer and of any part forward of such front wall or rearward of
such rear wall which does not increase the vehicle's load-carrying space.

overall width
 the distance between longitudinal planes
passing through the extreme lateral projecting points of the vehicle inclusive
of all parts of the vehicle, of any receptacle which is of permanent character
and accordingly strong enough for repeated use, and any fitting on, or attached
to, the vehicle except—
(a) any driving mirror;
(b) any snow-plough fixed in front of the
vehicle;
(c) so much of the distortion of any tyre
as is caused by the weight of the vehicle;
(d) any receptacle specially designed to
hold and keep secure a seal issued for the purposes of customs clearance;

(e) any lamp or reflector fitted to the vehicle
in accordance with the Lighting Regulations;
(f) any sideboard which is let down while
the vehicle is stationary in order to facilitate its loading or unloading;

(g) any fitting attached to part of, or to
a receptacle on, a vehicle which does not increase the carrying capacity of
the part or receptacle but which enables it to be 
 —transferred from a road vehicle to a railway vehicle
or from a railway vehicle to a road vehicle;
 —secured to a railway vehicle by a locking device; and

 —carried on a railway vehicle by the use of stanchions;

(h) any sheeting or other readily flexible
means of covering or securing a load;
(i) any receptacle with an external width,
measured at right angles to the longitudinal axis of the vehicle, which does
not exceed 2.5 m;
(j) any empty receptacle which itself forms
a load;
(k) any receptacle which contains an indivisible
load of exceptional width;
(l) any receptacle manufactured before 30th
October 1985, not being a maritime container (namely a container designed
primarily for carriage on sea transport without an accompanying road vehicle);
...
(m) any special appliance or apparatus as
described in regulation 81(c)
which does not itself increase the carrying capacity of the vehicle ; ...
(n)  any apparatus fitted to a bus which enables it to be guided wholly or mainly by means of wheels bearing outwards against fixed apparatus, provided that no part of the apparatus projects more than 75mm beyond the side of the bus when the wheels of the bus are parallel to its longitudinal axis  ; ... 
(o) any aerodynamic devices and equipment; or 
(p) any camera-monitor system.and the reference in paragraph (n) above to the side of a bus is a reference to the longitudinal plane passing through the extreme lateral projecting points of the vehicle inclusive of all parts of the vehicle, of any receptacle which is of permanent character and accordingly strong enough for repeated use, and any fitting on, or attached to, the vehicle except those items referred to in paragraphs (a) to (n).
overhang the distance measured horizontally and parallel to the longitudinal
axis of a vehicle between two transverse planes passing through the following
two points—
(a) the rearmost point of the vehicle exclusive
of— 
(i) any expanding or extensible contrivance
forming part of a turntable fire escape fixed to a vehicle;
(ii) in the case of a motor car constructed
solely for the carriage of passengers and their effects and adapted to carry
not more than eight passengers exclusive of the driver, any luggage carrier
fitted to the vehicle; and
(b) 
(i) in the case of a motor vehicle having
not more than three axles of which only one is not a steering axle, the centre
point of that axle;
(ii) in the case of a motor vehicle having
three axles of which the front axle is the only steering axle and of a motor
vehicle having four axles of which the two foremost are the only steering
axles, a point 110 mm behind the centre of a straight line joining the centre
points of the two rearmost axles; and
(iii) in any other case a point situated
on the longitudinal axis of the vehicle and such that a line drawn from it
at right angles to that axis will pass through the centre of the minimum turning
circle of the vehicle.
passenger vehicle a vehicle
constructed solely for the carriage of passengers and their effects.
pedestrian-controlled vehicle a motor vehicle which is controlled by a pedestrian
and not constructed or adapted for use or used for the carriage of a driver
or passenger.
pneumatic tyre
 a tyre which—(a) is provided with, or together with the wheel
upon which it is mounted forms, a continuous closed chamber inflated to a
pressure substantially exceeding atmospheric pressure when the tyre is in
the condition in which it is normally used, but is not subjected to any load;
(b) is capable of
being inflated and deflated without removal from the wheel or vehicle; and
(c) is such that,
when it is deflated and is subjected to a normal load, the sides of the tyre
collapse.
public works vehicle
 
 a mechanically propelled vehicle which is used on a road by or on behalf of–
(a) the Central Scotland Water Development Board;
(b) a ferry undertaking;
(c) a highway or roads authority;
(d) a local authority;
(e) a market undertaking;
(f) the National Rivers Authority;
(g) an operator of  an electronic communications code network;
(h) a police authority or local policing body;
(i) a universal service provider (within the meaning of  Part 3 of the Postal Services Act 2011) in connection with the provision of a universal postal service (within the meaning of that Part);
(j) a public electricity supplier within the meaning of Part I of the Electricity Act 1989;
(k) a public gas transporter within the meaning of Part I of the Gas Act 1986;
(l) a statutory undertaker within the meaning of section 329(1) of the Highways Act 1980;
(m) an undertaking for the supply of district heating;
(n) a water authority within the meaning of the Water (Scotland) Act 1980; or
(o) a water or sewerage undertaker within the meaning of the Water Act 1989;for the purpose of works which such a body has a duty or power to carry out, and which is used only for the carriage of–
(i) the crew, and
(ii) goods which are needed for works in respect of which the vehicle is used.
recut pneumatic tyre 
a pneumatic tyre in which all or part of its original tread pattern has been
cut deeper or burnt deeper or a different tread pattern has been cut deeper
or burnt deeper than the original tread pattern.
refuse vehicle 
a vehicle designed for use and used solely in connection with street cleansing,
the collection or disposal of refuse, or the collection or disposal of the
contents of gullies or cesspools.

registered registered under any of the
following enactments—
(a) the Roads Act 1920,
(b) the Vehicles (Excise) Act 1949,
(c) the Vehicles (Excise) Act 1962,
or(d) the 1971 Act
and,in relation to the date
on which a vehicle was registered, the date on which it was first registered
under any of those enactments.

relevant braking requirement a requirement
that the brakes of a motor vehicle (as assisted, where a trailer is being
drawn, by the brakes on the trailer) comply—
(i) in a case to which item 1 in Table 1 in regulation
18 applies, with the requirements specified
in regulation 18(3)
for vehicles falling in that item;(ii) in any other
case, with the requirements specified in regulation 18(3)
for vehicle classes (a) and (b) in item 2 of that Table (whatever the date
of first use of the motor vehicle and the date of manufacture of any trailer
drawn by it may be).
resilient
tyre a tyre, not being a pneumatic tyre,
which is of soft or elastic material, having regard to paragraph (5).
restricted speed vehicle  a vehicle displaying at its rear a “50” plate in accordance with the requirements of Schedule 13.
retreaded tyre a tyre which has been reconditioned to extend its useful life by replacement of the tread rubber or by replacement of the tread rubber and renovation of the sidewall rubber.
rigid vehicle 
a motor vehicle which is not constructed or adapted to form part of an articulated
vehicle or articulated bus.
rim diameter  is to be interpreted in accordance with the British Standard BS AU 50: Part 2: Section 1: 1980 entitled “British Standard Automobile Series: Specification for Tyres and Wheels Part 2. Wheels and rims Section 1. Rim profiles and dimensions (including openings for valves)” which came into effect on 28th November 1980.
rim diameter size code is to be interpreted in accordance with the British Standard referred to in the meaning given in this Table to “rim diameter”.

secondary braking system a braking system
of a vehicle applied by a secondary means of operation independent of the
service braking system or by one of the sections comprised in a split braking
system.
service braking system
 the braking system of a vehicle which
is designed and constructed to have the highest braking efficiency of any
of the braking systems with which the vehicle is equipped.
semi-trailer 
a trailer which is constructed or adapted to form part of an articulated vehicle including (without prejudice to the generality of that) a vehicle which is not itself a motor vehicle but which has some or all of its wheels driven by the drawing vehicle.

silencer a contrivance suitable and sufficient for reducing as far
as may be reasonable the noise caused by the escape of exhaust gases from
the engine of a motor vehicle.

single-decked vehicle a vehicle upon
which no part of a deck or gangway is vertically above another deck or gangway.

split braking system in relation to a motor vehicle, a braking system
so designed and constructed that—
(a) it comprises two independent sections of mechanism capable
of developing braking force such that, excluding the means of operation, a
failure of any part (other than a fixed member or a brake shoe anchor pin)
of one of the said sections will not cause a decrease in the braking force
capable of being developed by the other section;(b) the said two sections are operated by a means
of operation which is common to both sections;(c) the braking efficiency of either of the said
two sections can be readily checked.
stepframe low loader  
a semi-trailer (not being a low loader) which is constructed and normally used for the carriage of engineering equipment and is so constructed that the upper surface of the major part of the load platform is at a height of less than 1m above the ground when measured on level ground and when–

(a) any adjustable suspension is at the normal travelling height,
(b) all pneumatic tyres are suitably inflated for use when the vehicle is fully laden, and
(c) the semi-trailer is unladen.
stored energy in relation
to a braking system of a vehicle, energy (other than the muscular energy of
the driver or the mechanical energy of a spring) stored in a reservoir for
the purpose of applying the brakes under the control of the driver, either
directly or as a supplement to his muscular energy.
straddle carrier 
a motor vehicle constructed to straddle and lift its load for the purpose
of transportation.
staircase  means a staircase by means of which passengers on a double-decked vehicle may pass to and from the upper deck of the vehicle;
statutory
power of removal a power conferred by
or under any enactment to remove or move a vehicle from any road or from any
part of a road.
swap body a part of a vehicle which is intended to bear the load, has supports and, by means of a device which is part of the vehicle, may be detached from the vehicle and re-incorporated into it.
temporary
use spare tyre a pneumatic tyre which
is designed for use on a motor vehicle only—(a) in the event of the failure of one of the tyres
normally fitted to a wheel of the vehicle, and(b) at a speed lower than that for which such normally
fitted tyres are designed.

three-wheeled motor cycle a motor cycle
having three wheels, not including a two-wheeled motor cycle with a sidecar
attached.
towing implement
 a device on wheels designed for the
purpose of enabling a motor vehicle to draw another vehicle by the attachment
of that device to that other vehicle in such a manner that part of that other
vehicle is secured to and either rests on or is suspended from the device
and some but not all of the wheels on which that other vehicle normally runs
are raised off the ground.

track-laying in relation to a vehicle,
so designed and constructed that the weight thereof is transmitted to the
road surface either by means of continuous tracks or by a combination of wheels
and continuous tracks in such circumstances that the weight transmitted to
the road surface by the tracks is not less than half the weight of the vehicle.

trailer means a vehicle drawn by a motor vehicle and is to be interpreted
in accordance with paragraphs (9)
and (11).

train weight in relation to a motor vehicle which may draw a
trailer, the maximum laden weight for the motor vehicle together with any
trailer which may be drawn by it.

transverse plane a vertical plane at
right angles to the longitudinal axis of a vehicle.
trolley bus a
bus adapted for use on roads without rails and moved by power transmitted
thereto from some external source.

unbraked trailer any trailer other than
one which, whether or not regulation 15 or 16
applies to it, is equipped with a braking system in accordance with one of
those regulations.
unladen
weight the weight of a vehicle or trailer
inclusive of the body and all parts (the heavier being taken where alternative
bodies or parts are used) which are necessary to or ordinarily used with the
vehicle or trailer when working on a road, but exclusive of the weight of
water, fuel or accumulators used for the purpose of the supply of power for
the propulsion of the vehicle or, as the case may be, of any vehicle by which
the trailer is drawn, and of loose tools and loose equipment.
vehicle in the service of a visiting
force or of a headquarters a vehicle
so described in Article 8(6)
of the Visiting
Forces and International Headquarters (Application of Law) Order 1965
wheel 
a wheel the tyre or rim of which when the vehicle is in motion on a road is
in contact with the ground; two wheels are to be regarded as one wheel in
the circumstances specified in paragraph (7).

wheeled in relation to a vehicle, so constructed that the whole
weight of the vehicle is transmitted to the road surface by means of wheels.

Wide tyre a pneumatic tyre of which the area of contact with the road
surface is not less than 300mm in width when measured at right angles to the
longitudinal axis of the vehicle.

works trailer a trailer designed for
use in private premises and used on a road only in delivering goods from or
to such premises to or from a vehicle on a road in the immediate neighbourhood,
or in passing from one part of any such premises to another or to other private
premises in the immediate neighbourhood or in connection with road works while
at or in the immediate neighbourhood of the site of such works.
works truck a motor vehicle (other than a straddle carrier) designed for use
in private premises and used on a road only in delivering goods from or to
such premises to or from a vehicle on a road in the immediate neighbourhood,
or in passing from one part of any such premises to another or to other private
premises in the immediate neighbourhood or in connection with road works while
at or in the immediate neighbourhood of the site of such works.
(2A) Without prejudice to section 17 of the Interpretation Act 1978 and subject to the context, a reference in these Regulations to any enactment comprised in subordinate legislation (within the meaning of that Act) is a reference to that enactment as from time to time amended or re-enacted with or without modification.
(3) For the purpose of
these Regulations, the date on which a motor vehicle is first used is—

(a) in the case of
a vehicle not falling within sub-paragraph (b)
and which is registered, the date on which it was registered;
(b) in each of the
following cases—
(i) a vehicle
which is being or has been used under a trade licence as defined in section 16 of the 1971 Act (otherwise
than for the purposes of demonstration or testing or of being delivered from
premises of the manufacturer by whom it was made or of a distributor of vehicles,
or dealer in vehicles, to premises of a distributor of vehicles, dealer in
vehicles or purchaser thereof or to premises of a person obtaining possession
thereof under a hiring agreement or hire purchase agreement);
(ii) a vehicle
belonging, or which has belonged, to the Crown and which is or was used or
appropriated for use for naval, military or air force purposes;
(iii) a vehicle
belonging, or which has belonged, to a visiting force or a headquarters or
defence organisation to which in each case the Visiting Forces and International
Headquarters (Application of Law) Order 1965
applies;
(iv) a vehicle
which has been used on roads outside Great Britain before being imported into
Great Britain; and
(v) a vehicle
which has been used otherwise than on roads after being sold or supplied by
retail and before being registered;the date of manufacture of the vehicle.In sub-paragraph (b) (v) of
this paragraph “sold or supplied by retail”
means sold or supplied otherwise than to a person acquiring
it solely for the purpose of resale or re-supply for a valuable consideration
.
(4) The date of manufacture
of a vehicle to which the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations apply
shall be the date of manufacture described in regulation 2(4)(a)
of those Regulations.
(5) Save where otherwise
provided in these Regulations a tyre shall not be deemed to be of soft or
elastic material unless the said material is either—
(a) continuous round
the circumference of the wheel; or
(b) fitted in sections
so that so far as reasonably practicable no space is left between the ends
thereof,and is of such thickness and design as to minimise, so far as reasonably
possible, vibration when the vehicle is in motion and so constructed as to
be free from any defect which might in any way cause damage to the surface
of a road.
(6) For the purpose of
these Regulations a brake drum and a brake disc shall be deemed to form part
of the wheel and not of the braking system.
(7) For the purpose of
these Regulations other than regulations 26 and 27
any two wheels of a motor vehicle or trailer shall be regarded as one wheel
if the distance between the centres of the areas of contact between such wheels
and the road surface is less than 460 mm.
(8) For the purpose of
these Regulations other than regulations 26 and 27
in counting the number of axles of, and in determining the sum of the weights
transmitted to the road surface by any one axle of, a vehicle, all the wheels
of which the centres of the areas of contact with the road surface can be
included between any two transverse planes less than  0.5  m apart shall be
treated as constituting one axle.
(8A) For the purposes of these Regulations, a reference to axles being closely-spaced is a reference to—
(a) two axles (not being part of a group of axles falling within sub-paragraph (b) or (c)) which are spaced at a distance apart of not more than 2.5m;
(b) three axles (not being part of a group of axles falling within sub-paragraph (c)) the outermost of which are spaced at a distance apart of not more than 3.25m; or
(c) four or more axles the outermost of which are spaced at a distance apart of not more than 4.6m;
the number of axles for the purposes of these paragraphs being determined in accordance with paragraph (8); and a reference to any particular number of closely-spaced axles shall be construed accordingly.
(9) The provisions of
these Regulations relating to trailers do not apply to any part of an articulated
bus.
(10) For the purpose
of  paragraph (8A) above, regulations 51,  76, 77 and 79  and  Schedules 11 and 11A...,
the distance between any two axles shall be obtained by measuring the shortest
distance between the line joining the centres of the areas of contact with
the road surface of the wheels of one axle and the line joining the centres
of the areas of contact with the road surface of the wheels of the other axle.

(11) For the purpose
of the following provisions only, a composite trailer shall be treated as
one trailer (not being a semi-trailer or a converter dolly)—
(a) regulations 7, 76 and 83;

(b) paragraph (2) of, and items 3
and 10 in the Table in, regulation 75;

(c) item 2 in the
Table in regulation 78.

3A 
Schedule 2A shall have effect for the purpose of modifying these Regulations in relation to vehicles in respect of which a Minister’s approval certificate has been issued by virtue of the Motor Vehicles (Approval) Regulations 1996.
4 

(1) Save where the context
otherwise requires, these Regulations apply to both wheeled vehicles and track-laying
vehicles.
(2) Where a provision
is applied by these Regulations to a motor vehicle first used on or after
a specified date it does not apply to that vehicle if it was manufactured
at least six months before that date.
(3) Where an exemption
from, or relaxation of, a provision is applied by these Regulations to a motor
vehicle first used before a specified date it shall also apply to a motor
vehicle first used on or after that date if it was manufactured at least six
months before that date.
(4) Subject to paragraph (7), the regulations specified
in an item in column 3 of the Table do not apply in respect of a vehicle of
a class specified in that item in column 2.

TABLE(regulation 4(4))

1 2
 3
Item Class of Vehicle 
Regulations which do not apply
1 A vehicle proceeding
to a port for export. The regulations
in Part II insofar
as they relate to construction and equipment, except regulations 16 (insofar as it
concerns parking brakes) 20, 30, 34, 37 and 53.
Regulations 66 to 69
and 71.

2 A vehicle brought temporarily into Great Britain by a person resident
abroad, provided that the vehicle complies in every respect with the requirements
relating to motor vehicles or trailers contained in—(a) article 21 and paragraph (1) of article 22
of the Convention
on Road Traffic concluded at Geneva on 19th September 1949 and  Part I, Part II (so far as it relates to direction
indicators and stop lights) and Part III of Annex 6 to that Convention;
or(b) paragraphs I, III and VIII of article 3
of the International
Convention relative to Motor Traffic concluded at Paris on 24th April 1926
 The regulations in Part II
insofar as they relate to construction and equipment except 
regulations 7, 8, ... 10, 10A,  40 and 53; and 
(a) additionally, in respect of any passenger vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 10 tonnes registered in one or more member States, regulations 36A(2), 36A(7) and 36A(9);
(b) additionally, in respect of any goods vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 12 tonnes registered in one or more member States, regulations 36(B)(2), 36B(9) and 36B(11).Regulations 66 to 69 and 71.

3 A vehicle manufactured in Great Britain which complies with the
requirements referred to in item 2 above and contained in the Convention of
1949, or, as the case may be, 1926 referred to in that item as if the vehicle
had been brought temporarily into Great Britain, and either—(a) is exempt from car tax by
virtue of  section 7(1), (2) and (3) of the Car Tax Act 1983, or(b) has been zero rated under  regulation 56 or 57 of the Value Added Tax (General) Regulations 1985. 
The regulations in Part II
insofar as they relate to construction and equipment, except 
regulations 7, 8, ... 10, 10A,  40 and 53.Regulations 66 to 69 and 71.

4 A vehicle in the service of a visiting force or of a headquarters.
 The regulations in Part II insofar as they relate
to construction and equipment, except regulations ... 16
(insofar as it concerns parking brakes), 21, 53 ... and 61.
Regulations 66 to 69,  71, 75 to 79 and 93A.

5 A vehicle which has been submitted for an examination under section 43 or  section 45  of
the 1972 Act while it is being used on a road in connection with the carrying
out of that examination and is being so used by a person who is empowered
under that section to carry out that examination, or by a person acting under
the direction of a person so empowered. 
The regulations in Part II .... Regulations 75 to 79 and 100.

6 A motor car or a motor cycle in respect of which a certificate
has been issued by the Officer in Charge of the National Collections of Road
Transport, the Science Museum, London SW7. that it was designed before 1st
January 1905 and constructed before 31st December 1905. Regulations 16
(except insofar as it applies requirements 3 and 6 in Schedule
3), 21, 37(4), 63 and 99(4).

7 
(a) A towing implement which is being drawn
by a motor vehicle while it is not attached to any vehicle except the one
drawing it if— 
(i) the towing implement is not being so
drawn during the hours of darkness, and
(ii) the vehicle by which it is being so
drawn is not driven at a speed exceeding 20 mph; or
(b) a vehicle which is being drawn by a motor
vehicle in the exercise of a statutory power of removal. The regulations in Part II
insofar as they relate to the construction and equipment of trailers, except regulation 20.
8 Tramcars The regulations in Parts II, III and IV
9 A public works vehicle which has a maximum design weight of 7500kg and is specifically designed for use and used solely for the purpose of street cleansing. Regulation 15(1E) and (5B) in respect of the requirements in Community Directive 98/12/EC and ECE Regulation 13.09 which require the fitting of ABS to goods vehicles over 3500kg in weight.
10 A vehicle being used by a Police Authority  or local policing body which has been authorised by a Chief Constable to perform accident reconstruction duties. Regulation 15(1E) and (5B) in respect of the requirements in Community Directive 98/12/EC and ECE Regulation 13.09 which prohibit the use of an isolation switch for the operation of ABS.
11 A vehicle being used on a road by a vehicle examiner, who has been authorised in writing by the Secretary of State for the purpose of—
(a) submitting the vehicle for an examination under section 45 of the Road Traffic Act 1988 in order to ascertain whether the examination is carried out in accordance with regulations made under that section; or
(b) removing the vehicle following that examination. The regulations in Part 2. Regulations 67, 75 to 79 and 100.
(5) Any reference to
a broken down vehicle shall include a reference to any towing implement which
is being used for the drawing of any such vehicle.
(6) The Secretary of
State is satisfied that it is requisite that the provisions of regulation 40(2) should apply,
as from the date on which these Regulations come into operation, to track-laying
vehicles registered before the expiration of one year from the making of these
Regulations; and that, notwithstanding that those provisions will then apply
to these vehicles, no undue hardship or inconvenience will be caused thereby.

(7) The exemption provided by item 11 in the Table in paragraph (4) shall only apply to the extent that the vehicle examiner using the vehicle in question reasonably believes that any defects in that vehicle do not give rise to a danger of injury to any person while it is being used by that person for a purpose mentioned in that item.
(8) In item 11 in the Table in paragraph (4) and paragraph (7), “vehicle examiner” means an examiner appointed under section 66A of the Road Traffic Act 1988.
5 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6 

(1) For the purpose of
any regulation which requires or permits a vehicle to comply with the requirements
of a Community Directive or an ECE Regulation, a vehicle shall be deemed so
to have complied at the date of its first use only if—
(a) one of the certificates
referred to in paragraph (2) has been issued in relation to it; or
(b) the marking referred
to in paragraph (3) has been applied; or
(c) it was, before
it was used on a road, subject to a relevant type approval requirement as
specified in paragraph (4).
(2) The certificates
mentioned in paragraph (1) are—
(b) a certificate
of conformity issued by the manufacturer of the vehicle under regulation 6 of either of those
Regulations; ...
(c) a certificate
issued under a provision of the law of any member state of the European Economic
Community which corresponds to the said regulations 5 or 6 ; or
(d) a sound level measurement certificate issued by the Secretary of State under regulation 4 of the Motorcycles (Sound Level Measurement Certificates) Regulations 1980;being in each case a certificate issued by reason of the vehicle's
conforming to the requirements of the Community Directive in question.
(a) a type approval
certificate issued by the Secretary of State under regulation 5 of the Type Approval
Regulations or of the Type Approval for Agricultural Vehicles Regulations;

(3) The marking mentioned
in paragraph (1) is a marking designated as an approval mark by regulation 4 of the Approval Marks
Regulations, being in each case a mark shown in column 2 of an item in Schedule 2 to those Regulations
which refers, in column 5, to the ECE Regulation in question, applied as indicated
in column 4 in that item.
(4) A relevant type approval
requirement is a requirement of the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations
or the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations which appears—
(a) in column 4 of Table I in Schedule 2
in the item in which the Community Directive in question appears in column
3, or
(b) in column 4 of Table II in Schedule 2
in the item in which the ECE Regulation in question appears in column3.
PART II
A
7 

(1) Subject
to paragraphs (2) to (6), the overall length of a vehicle or combination of
vehicles of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table shall not
exceed the maximum length specified in that item in column 3 of the Table,
the overall length in the case of a combination of vehicles being calculated
in accordance with regulation 81(g) and (h).


TABLE(regulation 7(1))

1 
2 3
Item Class of vehicle Maximum length (metres)
 Vehicle Combinations
1 A motor vehicle (other than a motor vehicle such as is mentioned in item 1A) drawing one trailer which is not a semi-trailer. 18.75
1A Subject to paragraph (3C), a motor vehicle manufactured before 1st June 1998 and drawing one trailer, where the combination does not meet the requirements of paragraph (5A) and the trailer is not a semi-trailer. 18
2 An articulated bus.
 18.75
2A A bus drawing a trailer 18.75
3 An articulated vehicle the semi-trailer of which does not meet the requirements of  para-graph (6) paragraph (6) and is not a low loader. 15.5
 
Motor vehicles
3A An articulated vehicle, the semi-trailer of which meets the requirements of paragraph (6) and is not a low loader. 16.5
3B An articulated vehicle, the semi-trailer of which is a low loader. 18
3C An articulated vehicle, the semi-trailer of which meets the requirements of paragraph (6), is not a low loader and is carrying one or more containers or swap bodies up to a total maximum length of 45 feet as part of an intermodal transport operation. 16.65

4 A wheeled motor vehicle other than a bus. 12
4A A bus with two axles 13.5
4B A bus with more than two axles 15

5 A track-laying motor vehicle. 9.2
 Trailers
6 
An agricultural trailed appliance manufactured on or after 1st December 1985.
 15
7 A semi-trailer
manufactured on or after 1st May 1983 which does not meet the requirements of paragraph (6) and is not a low loader. 12.2
7A A composite trailer drawn by–(a) a goods vehicle being a motor vehicle having a maximum gross weight exceeding 3500 kg; or(b) an agricultural motor vehicle 14.04
8 A trailer (not being a semi-trailer or composite trailer)  with at least 4 wheels which is—
(a) drawn by a goods
vehicle being a motor vehicle having a maximum gross weight exceeding 3500
kg; or(b) an agricultural
trailer. 12
9 
Any other trailer not being an agricultural trailed appliance or a semi-trailer.
 7
(2) In the
case of a motor vehicle drawing one trailer where—
(a) the
motor vehicle is a showman's vehicle as defined in paragraph 7 of Schedule 3 to the
1971 Act; and
(b) the
trailer is used primarily as living accommodation by one or more persons and
is not also used for the carriage of goods or burden which are not needed
for the purpose of such residence in the vehicle,item 1 in the Table applies with the substitution of 22 m for 18
m and item 1A in the Table does not apply.
(3) Items 1 ,1A, 3, 3A and 3B of the Table do not apply to–
(a) a vehicle combination which includes a trailer which is constructed and normally used for the conveyance of indivisible loads of exceptional length, or
(b) a vehicle combination consisting of a broken down vehicle (including an articulated vehicle) being drawn by a motor vehicle in consequence of a breakdown, ...
(c) an articulated vehicle, the semi-trailer of which is a low loader manufactured before 1st April 1991, or
(d) a vehicle combination which includes—
(i) a motor vehicle of category N2, or
(ii) a motor vehicle of category N3,
with an elongated cab.
(3A) Items 6, 7, 7A, 8 and 9 of the Table do not apply to–
(a) a trailer which is constructed and normally used for the conveyance of indivisible loads of exceptional length,
(b) a broken down vehicle (including an articulated vehicle) which is being drawn by a motor vehicle in consequence of a breakdown, or
(c) a trailer being a drying or mixing plant designed for the production of asphalt or of bituminous or tar macadam and used mainly for the construction, repair or maintenance of roads, or a road planing machine so used.
(3B) Furthermore item 7 does not apply to–
(a) a semi-trailer which is a car transporter,
(b) a semi-trailer which is normally used on international journeys any part of which takes place outside the United Kingdom.
(3C) Item 1A and the words “(other than a motor vehicle such as is mentioned in item 1A)” in item 1 of the Table shall cease to have effect after 31st December 2006.
(3D) Item 4 of the Table does not apply to—
(a) a motor vehicle of category N2, or
(b) a motor vehicle of category N3,
with an elongated cab type approved in accordance with point 1.4 of Part C of Annex I of The Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations, point 1.4 of Part C of Annex I of The Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations (Northern Ireland), or point 1.4 of Part C of Annex I of The (European Union) Type Approval Masses and Dimensions Regulations.
(4) Where a
motor vehicle is drawing—
(a) two
trailers, then only one of those trailers may exceed an overall length of
7 m;
(b) three
trailers, then none of those trailers shall exceed an overall length of 7
m.
(5) Where a
motor vehicle is drawing—
(a) two
or more trailers; or
(b) one
trailer constructed and normally used for the conveyance of indivisible loads
of exceptional length—then—
(i) the
overall length of that motor vehicle shall not exceed 9.2 m; and
(ii) 
the overall length of the combination of vehicles, calculated in accordance
with regulation 81(g) and (h),
shall not exceed 25.9 m, unless the conditions specified in 
paragraphs 1 and 2 of Schedule 12 have been
complied with.
(5XA) A motor vehicle drawing a trailer which is not a semi-trailer shall (unless it is a vehicle such as is mentioned in item 1A of the Table in paragraph (1)) comply with the requirements of paragraph (5A).The words in parenthesis in this paragraph shall cease to have effect after 31st December 2006.
(5A) The requirements of this paragraph, in relation to a combination of vehicles, are that at least one of the vehicles in the combination is not a goods vehicle or, if both vehicles in the combination are goods vehicles that—
(a) the maximum distance measured parallel to the longitudinal axis of the combination of vehicles from the foremost point of the loading area behind the driver’s cab to the rear of the trailer, less the distance between the rear of the motor vehicle and the front of the trailer, does not exceed 15.65m; and
(b) the maximum distance measured parallel to the longitudinal axis of the combination of vehicles from the foremost point of the loading area behind the driver’s cab to the rear of the trailer does not exceed  16.4 m;
but sub-paragraph (a) shall not apply if both vehicles in the combination are car transporters.
(6) The requirements of this paragraph, in relation to a semi-trailer, are that–
(a) the longitudinal distance from the axis of the king pin ... to the rear of the semi-trailer does not exceed–
(i) 12.5m in the case of a car transporter, ...
(ia) 12.15m when carrying one or more containers or swap bodies up to a total maximum length of 45 feet as part of an intermodal transport operation, or
(ii) 12m in any other case; and
(b) no point in the semi-trailer forward of the transverse plane passing through the axis of the king pin ... is more than–
(i) 4.19m from the axis of the king pin, in the case of a car transporter, or
(ii) 2.04m from the axis of the king pin, in any other case.
(6A) For the purposes of paragraph (5A)—
(a) where the forward end of the loading area of a motor vehicle is bounded by a wall, the thickness of the wall shall be regarded as part of the loading area; and
(b) any part of a vehicle designed primarily for use as a means of attaching another vehicle to it and any fitting designed for use in connection with any such part shall be disregarded in determining the distance between the rear of a motor vehicle and the front of a trailer being drawn by it.
(7) For the purpose of paragraph (6) the longitudinal distance from the axis of the king pin to the rear of a semi-trailer is the distance between a transverse plane passing through the axis of the king pin and  the rear of the semi-trailer.
(7A) Where a semi-trailer has more than one king-pin or is constructed so that it can be used with a king-pin in different positions, references in this regulation to a distance from the king-pin shall be construed
(a) in relation to a vehicle which was manufactured after  1st January 1999, as a reference to the foremost king-pin or, as the case may be, the foremost king-pin position; and
(b) in relation to any other vehicle, as a reference to the rearmost king-pin or, as the case may be, the rearmost king-pin position.
(7B) For the purposes of paragraphs (5A), (6) and (7)—
(a) a reference to the front of a vehicle is a reference to the transverse plane passing through the extreme forward projecting points of the vehicle; and
(b) a reference to the rear of a vehicle is a reference to the transverse plane passing through the extreme rearward projecting points of the vehicle,
inclusive (in each case) of all parts of the vehicle, of any receptacle which is of a permanent character and accordingly strong enough for repeated use, and any fitting on, or attached to the vehicle but exclusive of—
(i) the things set out in sub-paragraph (i) of the definition of “overall length” in the Table in regulation 3(2), and
(ii) in the case of a semi-trailer, the things set out in sub-paragraph (ii)(a) of that definition.
(8) Where a broken down articulated vehicle is being towed by a motor vehicle in consequence of a breakdown–
(a) paragraph (5) shall have effect in relation to the combination of vehicles as if sub-paragraph (b) were omitted, and
(b) for the purposes of paragraph (4) and of paragraph (5) as so modified, the articulated vehicle shall be regarded as a single trailer.
(9) No person shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road, a trailer with an overall length exceeding 18.65m unless the requirements of paragraphs 1 and 2 of Schedule 12 are complied with.
(10) For the purposes of this regulation—
(a) “a motor vehicle of category N2” means a vehicle of the type described in point (b)(ii) of Article 4(1) of Regulation (EU) 2018/858 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 30 May 2018 on the approval and market surveillance of motor vehicles and their trailers, and of systems, components and separate technical units intended for such vehicles, amending Regulations (EC) No 715/2007 and (EC) No 595/2009 and repealing Directive 2007/46/EC,
(b) “a motor vehicle of category N3” means a vehicle of the type described in point (b)(iii) of Article 4(1) of Regulation (EU) 2018/858 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 30 May 2018 on the approval and market surveillance of motor vehicles and their trailers, and of systems, components and separate technical units intended for such vehicles, amending Regulations (EC) No 715/2007 and (EC) No 595/2009 and repealing Directive 2007/46/EC.
8 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), the overall width of a vehicle of a class specified
in an item in column 2 of the Table shall not exceed the maximum width specified
in column 3 in that item.

TABLE(regulation 8(1))

1 
2 3
Item Class of vehicle Maximum width (metres)
1 A locomotive, other than an agricultural motor vehicle.
 2.75
2 A refrigerated vehicle, conditioned container or swap body 2·60
3 Any other motor
vehicle. 2.55
4 A trailer drawn by a motor vehicle other than a motor cycle. 2.55
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
8 
A trailer drawn by a motor cycle. 1.5

(2) Paragraph
(1) does not apply to a broken down vehicle which is being drawn in consequence
of the breakdown.
(3) No person
shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road a wheeled agricultural motor
vehicle drawing a wheeled trailer if, when the longitudinal axes of the vehicles
are parallel but in different vertical planes, the overall width of the two
vehicles, measured as if they were one vehicle, exceeds  2.55  metres.
(4) In this regulation—
 “refrigerated vehicle” means any vehicle which is specially designed for the carriage of goods at low temperature and of which the thickness of each of the side walls inclusive of insulation, is at least 45 mm; and
 “conditioned container or swap body” means a container or swap body used to carry goods at controlled temperatures on different modes of transport.
9 

(1) The overall
height of a bus shall not exceed 4.57 m.
(2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(2A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10 

(1) Subject to the provisions of this regulation, no person shall drive or cause or permit to be driven on a road a motor vehicle with an overall travelling height exceeding 3m unless a notice is displayed in the cab, in such a manner that it can easily be read by the driver, and the notice meets the requirements of paragraph (3).
(2) Subject to the provisions of this regulation, no person shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road a motor vehicle with an overall travelling height exceeding 3m if any letters or numbers are displayed in the cab, otherwise than in a notice which meets the requirements of paragraph (3)—
(a) where they could be read by the driver; and
(b) which could be understood as indicating a height associated with the vehicle or any trailer drawn by it.
(3) The requirements of this paragraph in respect of a notice are that—
(a) the notice gives an indication of vehicle height expressed in feet and inches, or in both feet and inches and in metres;
(b) the numbers giving the indication in feet and inches are at least 40mm tall;
(c) the height expressed in feet and inches and (where applicable) the height expressed in metres are—
(i) if the vehicle is a vehicle to which regulation 10A applies, not less than the predetermined height mentioned in regulation 10A (2)(a) or the overall travelling height (whichever is the greater), or
(ii) if the vehicle is not a vehicle to which regulation 10A applies, not less than the overall travelling height;
(d) if the vehicle is not a relevant vehicle, the height expressed in feet and inches does not exceed the overall travelling height by more than 150mm;
(e) if the vehicle is a relevant vehicle, the height expressed in feet and inches does not exceed the overall travelling height by more than 1m;
(f) if the height is expressed in both feet and inches and in metres, the height expressed in feet and inches and the height expressed in metres do not differ by more than 50mm; and
(g) no other letters or numbers which could be understood as being an indication of any height associated with the vehicle or any trailer drawn by it are displayed in the notice.
(4) Paragraph (1) shall not apply if, having regard to the lengths of road which the driver might drive along in the course of fulfilling the purpose of the journey taking into account any possibility of unforeseen diversions and the driver having difficulty in finding his way, it is highly unlikely that the driver would during the course of the journey encounter any bridge or other overhead structure which does not exceed by at least 1m—
(a) in the case of a vehicle to which regulation 10A applies, the maximum travelling height.; or
(b) in any other case, the overall travelling height.
(5) Paragraph (1) shall not apply to a vehicle on a particular journey and at a particular time if—
(a) one or more documents are being carried in the vehicle which are within the easy reach of the driver and that or those documents describe a route or a choice of routes which the driver must take in order to fulfil the purpose of the journey without risk of the vehicle, its load or equipment or any trailer drawn by the vehicle, its load or equipment, colliding with any bridge or other overhead structure; and
(b) the vehicle is on such a route which is so described or is off that route by reason of a diversion that could not reasonably have been foreseen at the beginning of the journey.
(6) Paragraph (1) shall not apply to a vehicle on a particular journey if—
(a) one or more documents are being carried in the vehicle which are within the easy reach of the driver and that or those documents contain information as to—
(i) the height of bridges and other overhead structures under which the vehicle and any trailer drawn by it could pass, and
(ii) the height of bridges and other overhead structures under which the vehicle and any trailer drawn by it could not pass,
without the vehicle, its load or equipment or any such trailer, its load or equipment, colliding with any bridge or other overhead structure; and
(b) the information is such that, having regard in particular to the matters referred to in paragraph (7), it would enable any driver to fulfil the purpose of the journey without there being any risk of the vehicle, its load or equipment or any trailer, its load or equipment, colliding with any bridge or other overhead structure while on the journey.
(7) The matters referred to in paragraph (6) are—
(a) the roads which the driver might drive along in the course of fulfilling the purpose of the journey taking into account any possibility of unforeseen diversions and of the driver having difficulty in finding his way;
(b) the height of bridges and other overhead structures that would be encountered were the vehicle to proceed along any of those roads; and
(c) the setting of any device of a description specified in regulation 10A(2).
(8) Paragraphs (1) and (2) shall not apply to motor vehicle if it has an overall travelling height of not more than 4m and—
(a) it is a vehicle registered or put into circulation in an EEA State and is being used in international traffic; or
(b) it is a motor vehicle drawing a trailer registered or put into circulation in an EEA State and that trailer is being used in international traffic.
(9) For the purposes of this regulation—
(a) “EEA State”, and “high level equipment” and “maximum travelling height” have the meanings given in regulation 10C;
(b) “overall travelling height” in relation to a motor vehicle means—
(i) if it is not drawing a trailer, the overall height for the time being of the vehicle, its equipment and load, or
(ii) if it is drawing one or more trailers, the overall height for the time being of the combination of vehicles, their equipment and loads.
(c) a motor vehicle is a “relevant vehicle” if at any particular time—
(i) the vehicle or any trailer drawn by it is fitted with high level equipment with a maximum, height of more than 3m; and
(ii) the overall travelling height is less than the maximum travelling height.
(10) In paragraph (8), “international traffic” and “registered or put into circulation” have the same meanings as in article 3 of Community Directive 85/3.
10A 

(1) Subject to the provisions of this regulation and regulations 10B and 10C, no person shall drive or cause or permit to be driven on a road a vehicle to which this regulation applies unless the vehicle is fitted with a warning device and the requirements specified in paragraph (2) are satisfied in respect of the device, the vehicle and any relevant trailer drawn by the vehicle.
(2) The requirements are—
(a) that the device, the vehicle and any relevant trailer drawn by it shall be so constructed, maintained and adjusted, and the connections between the vehicle and those trailers are such, that the device would give a visible warning to the driver if, whilst the vehicle was being driven, the height of the highest point of any high level equipment fitted to the vehicle or any of those trailers were to exceed a predetermined height; and
(b) the predetermined height referred to in sub-paragraph (a) shall not exceed the overall travelling height by more than 1m.
(3) No person shall be taken to have failed to comply with paragraph (1) on the ground that a motor vehicle or a relevant trailer was not fitted with a warning device and the requirements in paragraph (2) were not being satisfied as mentioned in paragraph (1)—
(a) before 1st October 1998—
(i) if the motor vehicle was first used before 1st April 1998; or
(ii) the relevant trailer was manufactured before that date; or
(b) before 1st April 1998 in relation to any other motor vehicle or relevant trailer.
(4) Paragraph (1) shall not apply in relation to a particular journey if, having regard to the lengths of road which the driver might drive along in the course of fulfilling the purpose of the journey and taking into account any possibility of unforeseen diversions and the driver having difficulty in finding his way, it is highly unlikely that the driver would during the course of the journey be confronted with any bridge or other overhead structure which does not exceed the maximum travelling height by at least 1m.
10B 

(1) Subject to the provisions of this regulation, regulation 10A applies to—
(a) a motor vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1993, if the vehicle or any relevant trailer drawn by it, is fitted with high level equipment with a maximum height of more than 3m; and
(b) a motor vehicle first used before 1st April 1993, if any relevant trailer drawn by it is fitted with such equipment.
(2) Regulation 10A does not apply to a motor vehicle if it has an overall travelling height of not more than 4m and—
(a) it is a vehicle registered or put into circulation in an EEA State and is being used in international traffic; or
(b) it is a motor vehicle drawing a trailer registered or put into circulation in an EEA State and that trailer is being used in international traffic, and
in this paragraph, “international traffic” and “registered or put into circulation” have the same meanings as in article 3 of Community Directive 85/3.
(3) Regulation 10A does not apply to—
(a) an agricultural motor vehicle;
(a) an industrial tractor;
(c) a works truck;
(d) a motor vehicle owned by the Secretary of State for Defence and used for naval, military or air force purposes or a motor vehicle so used while being driven by a person for the time being subject to orders of a member of the armed forces of the Crown;
(e) a motor vehicle drawing a trailer owned by the Secretary of State for Defence and used for naval, military or air force purposes or a motor vehicle drawing such a trailer while being driven by a person for the tine being subject to orders of a member of the armed forces of the Crown;
(f) a motor vehicle used by a fire brigade maintained under the Fire Services Act 1947a motor vehicle used by employees of the Scottish Fire and Rescue Service for the purposes of that Serviceor, in England or Wales, a motor vehicle used by employees of a fire and rescue authority for the purposes of that authority under the Fire and Rescue Services Act 2004or, in England, a motor vehicle used by employees of a fire and rescue authority for the purposes of that authority under the Fire and Rescue Services Act 2004;
(g) a motor vehicle that is constructed and normally used for the purpose of carrying at least two other vehicles;
(h) a motor vehicle drawing a car transporter; or
(i) a motor vehicle whose maximum travelling height does not exceed its overall travelling height.
10C 

(1) The following provisions of this regulation apply for the interpretation of this regulation and regulations 10A and 10B.
(2) Subject to paragraphs (4) and (5), a reference to high level equipment, in relation to a motor vehicle, is a reference to equipment which is so fitted to the vehicle that—
(a) the equipment can be raised by means of a power operated device, and
(b) the raising or lowering of the equipment is capable of altering the overall travelling height of the motor vehicle when the vehicle and every trailer drawn by it is unladen.
(3) Subject to paragraph (4) and (5), a reference to high level equipment, in relation to a trailer drawn by a motor vehicle, is a reference to equipment which is so fitted to the trailer that—
(a) the equipment can be raised by means of a power operated device, and
(b) the raising or lowering of the equipment is capable of altering the overall travelling height of the motor vehicle when the vehicle and every trailer drawn by it is unladen.
(4) A reference to high level equipment in relation to a tipper which is—
(a) a motor vehicle first used before 1st April 1998, or
(b) a trailer manufactured before that date,
shall be construed as not including the relevant part of the tipper.
(5) Where equipment fitted to a vehicle would otherwise be high level equipment, that equipment shall not be regarded as high level equipment if—
(a) the equipment is so designed and constructed that—
(i) it can be fixed in a stowed position by a locking device when travelling; and
(ii) it is not possible for a person in the cab to interfere with the locking device; and
(b) the equipment is fixed in that position by the locking device.
(6) The following expressions shall bear the following meanings—
(a) “EEA State” means a state which is a contracting party to the EEA Agreement; and
(b) “EEA Agreement” means the Agreement on the European Economic Area signed at Oporto on 2 May 1992 as adjusted by the Protocol signed at Brussels on 17 March 1993;
(c) “maximum height”, in relation to any high level equipment fitted to a vehicle, means the height of the highest point of that equipment above the ground when it is raised as far as possible by means of that device and the vehicle is unladen;
(d) “maximum travelling height”, in relation to a motor vehicle to which regulation 10A applies, means—
(i) if the overall travelling height could be increased by raising any high level equipment fitted to the vehicle or to any relevant trailer drawn by it  that is not for the time being at its maximum height, the greatest overall travelling height that could be achieved by raising such equipment (without making any other changes to the vehicle, its load or equipment or to any trailer drawn by it, its load or equipment); or
(ii) in any other case, the overall travelling height;
(e) “overall travelling height” has the meaning given by regulation 10(9)(b);
(f) “relevant part”, in relation to a tipper, shall be construed in accordance with sub-paragraph (g);
(g) “tipper” means a vehicle that is so constructed that it can be unloaded by part of the vehicle (in this regulation referred to as the “relevant part”) being tipped sideways or rearwards, and
a reference to equipment fitted to a vehicle includes part of the vehicle.
(7) “Relevant trailer” means a trailer manufactured on or after 1st April 1993 not being—
(a) an agricultural trailer;
(b) an agricultural trailed appliance;
(c) a works trailer;
(d) a trailer used by a fire brigade maintained under the Fire Services Act 1947employees of the Scottish Fire and Rescue Service for the purposes of that Serviceor, in England or Wales, a trailer used by employees of a fire and rescue authority for the purposes of that authority under the Fire and Rescue Services Act 2004or, in England, a trailer used by employees of a fire and rescue authority for the purposes of that authority under the Fire and Rescue Services Act 2004;
(e) a broken down vehicle (including an articulated vehicle) being drawn by a motor vehicle in consequence of a breakdown.
11 

(1) The overhang
of a wheeled vehicle of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table
shall not, subject to any exemption specified in that item in column 4, exceed
the distance specified in that item in column 3.

TABLE(regulation 11(1))

1
 2 3 4
Item
 Class of vehicle Maximum overhang Exemptions
1 
Motor tractor 1.83 m. (a) a track-laying vehicle
(b) an agricultural
motor vehicle
2 Heavy motor car and motor car 60% of the distance between the transverse plane which passes
through the centre or centres of the foremost wheel or wheels and the transverse
plane which passes through the foremost point from which the overhang is to
be measured as provided in regulation 3(2).
 
(a) a bus
(b) a refuse vehicle
(c) a works truck
(d) a track-laying vehicle
(e) an agricultural motor vehicle
(f) a motor car which is an ambulance
(g) a vehicle designed to dispose of its
load to the rear, if the overhang does not exceed 1.15 m
(h) a vehicle first used before 2nd January
1933
(i) a vehicle first used before 1st January
1966 if— 
(i) the distance between the centres of the
rearmost and foremost axles does not exceed 2.29 m, and
(ii) the distance specified in column 3 is
not exceeded by more than 76 mm
(j) heating plant on a vehicle designed and
mainly used to heat the surface of a road or other similar surface in the
process of construction, repair or maintenance shall be disregarded.
(2) In the
case of an agricultural motor vehicle the distance measured horizontally and
parallel to the longitudinal axis of the rear portion of the vehicle between
the transverse planes passing through the rearmost point of the vehicle and
through the centre of the rear or the rearmost axle shall not exceed 3 m.

(3) A heavy motor car shall be taken to comply with the requirements of paragraph (1) if it meets the requirements of paragraph 7.6.2 of Annex I of Community Directive 97/27.
12 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), a wheeled trailer which is—
(a) a
goods vehicle; and
(b) manufactured
on or after 1st April 1984,shall have a minimum ground clearance of not less than 160 mm if
the trailer has an axle interspace of more than 6 m but less than 11.5 m,
and a minimum ground clearance of not less than 190 mm if the trailer has
an axle interspace of 11.5 m or more.
(2) Paragraph
(1) shall not apply in the case of a trailer—
(a) which
is fitted with a suspension system with which, by the operation of a control,
the trailer may be lowered or raised, while that system is being operated
to enable the trailer to pass under a bridge or other obstruction over a road
provided that at such times the system is operated so that no part of the
trailer (excluding any wheel) touches the ground or is likely to do so; or

(b) while
it is being loaded or unloaded.
(3) In this
regulation—
 “axle interspace”
means— 
(a) in the case of a semi-trailer, the distance
between the point of support of the semi-trailer at its forward end and, if
it has only one axle, the centre of that axle or, if it has more than one
axle, the point halfway between the centres of the foremost and rearmost of
those axles; and
(b) in the case of any other trailer, the distance between
the centre of its front axle or, if it has more than one axle at the front,
the point halfway between the centres of the foremost and rearmost of those
axles, and the centre of its rear axle or, if it has more than one axle at
the rear, the point halfway between the centre of the foremost and rearmost
of those axles; and
 “ground clearance”
means the shortest distance between the ground and the
lowest part of that portion of the trailer (excluding any part of a suspension,
steering or braking system attached to any axle, any wheel and any air skirt)
which lies within the area formed by the overall width of the trailer and
the middle 70% of the axle interspace, such distance being ascertained when
the trailer— 
(a) is fitted with suitable tyres which are inflated
to a pressure recommended by the manufacturer, and
(b) is reasonably horizontal and standing on ground which
is reasonably flat.
13 

(1) This regulation
applies to a bus first used on or after 1st April 1982.
(2) Every
vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be able to move on either lock
so that , both with and without all its wheels in contact with the ground,  no part of it projects outside the area contained between concentric
circles with radii of  12.5 m  and 5.3 m.
(2A) In relation to a vehicle manufactured before 1st June 1998 paragraph (2) shall have effect as if the words “, both with and without all its wheels in contact with the ground,” were omitted.
(3) When a
vehicle to which this regulation applies moves forward from rest, on either
lock, so that its outermost point describes a circle of  12.5 m  radius, no part
of the vehicle shall project beyond the longitudinal plane which, at the beginning
of the manoeuvre, defines the overall width of the vehicle on the side opposite
to the direction in which it is turning by more than—
(a) 0.8
m if it is a rigid vehicle of 12m or less in overall length; or
(b) 1.2
m if it is  a rigid bus of over 12m in overall length or an articulated bus.
(4) For the
purpose of paragraph (3) the two rigid portions of an articulated bus shall
be in line at the beginning of the manoeuvre.
13A 

(1) Every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be able to move on either lock so that, both with and without all its wheels in contact with the surface of the road and disregarding the things set out in paragraphs (a) to (m) in the definition of “overall width” and in paragraph (i)(a) to (o) in the definition of “overall length” in the Table in regulation 3, no part of it projects outside the area contained between concentric circles with radii of 12.5m and 5.3m.
(2) This regulation applies to all articulated vehicles except the following:
(a) an articulated vehicle, the semi-trailer of which—
(i) was manufactured before 1st April 1990 and has an overall length that does not exceed the overall length it had on that date,
(ii) is a car transporter,
(iii) is a low loader,
(iv) is a stepframe low loader, or
(v) is constructed and normally used for the conveyance of indivisible loads of exceptional length;
(b) an articulated vehicle having an overall length not exceeding 15.5m and of which the drawing vehicle was first used before 1st June 1998 or the trailer was first used before that date; or
(c) an articulated vehicle when an axle of the trailer is raised to aid traction.
(3) In relation to a vehicle manufactured before 1st June 1998, paragraph (1) shall have effect as if the words “both with and without all its wheels in contact with the surface of the road and” were omitted.
(4) An articulated vehicle shall be taken to comply with paragraph (1) if the semi-trailer comprised in it is, by virture of paragraph 7.6.1.2 of Annex 1 of Community Directive 97/27/EC, deemed to comply with paragraph 7.6.1 of that Annex.
13B 

(1) Subject to paragraphs (2) and (3) this regulation applies to an articulated vehicle having an overall length exceeding 15.
5m, the semi-trailer of which is a car transporter.
(2) This regulation does not apply to an articulated vehicle, the semi-trailer of which satisfied the following conditions–
(a) it was manufactured before the 1st April 1990, and
(b) the distance from the front of the trailer to the rearmost axle is no greater than it was on that date.
(3) This regulation does not apply to an articulated vehicle the semi-trailer of which is–
(a) a low loader, or
(b) a stepframe low loader.
(4) Every articulated vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be able to move on either lock so that, both with and without all its wheels in contact with the surface of the road and  disregarding the things set out in paragraphs (a) to (m) in the definition of “overall width” and in paragraph (i)(a) to (o) in the definition of “overall length”  in the Table in regulation 3(2), no part of–
(a) the motor vehicle drawing the car transporter, or
(b) the car transporter to the rear of the transverse plane passing through the king pin,
projects outside the area between concentric circles with radii of 12.5m and 5.3m.
(5) In relation to a vehicle manufactured before 1st June 1998 paragraph (4) shall have effect as if the words “both with and without all its wheels in contact with the surface of the road” were omitted.
(6) An articulated vehicle shall be taken to comply with paragraph (4) if the semi-trailer comprised in it is, by virtue of paragraph 7.6.1.2 of Annex 1 of Community Directive 97/27/EC, deemed to comply with paragraph 7.6.1 of that Annex.
13C 

(1) This regulation applies to a vehicle which—
(a) is a heavy motor car or a vehicle combination which consists of a heavy motor car drawing one trailer which is not a semi-trailer;
(b) was manufactured or, in the case of a vehicle combination, the part consisting of a heavy motor car, was manufactured after 31st May 1998; and
(c) is not a vehicle falling within any of the descriptions specified in paragraph (2).
(2) The descriptions of vehicle referred to in paragraph (1)(c) are—
(a) a vehicle having 4 or more axles where the distance between the foremost and rearmost axles exceeds 6.4 metres;
(b) a vehicle or a vehicle combination to which regulation 13, 13A or 13B applies;
(c) a vehicle constructed and normally used for the carriage of indivisible loads of abnormal length.
(3) Every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be able to move on either lock so that, both with and without all its wheels in contact with the surface of the road and disregarding the things set out in paragraphs (a) to (m) in the definition of “overall width” and in paragraph (i)(a) to (o) in the definition of “overall length” in the Table in regulation 3(2), no part of it projects outside the area contained between concentric circles with radii of 12.5 m and 5.3 m.
14 

(1) This regulation
applies to every articulated bus first used on or after 1st April 1982.
(2) The connecting
section of the two parts of every articulated bus to which this regulation
applies shall be constructed so as to comply with the provisions relating
to such a section specified in paragraph 5.9
in ECE Regulation
36 as regards vehicles within the scope of
that Regulation.
(3) Every
articulated bus to which this regulation applies shall be constructed so that
when the vehicle is moving in a straight line the longitudinal median planes
of its two parts coincide and form a continuous plane without any deflection.

B
15 

(1) Save as provided in paragraphs (2), (3) and (4), the braking system of every wheeled vehicle of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table which, in the case of a motor vehicle, is first used on or after 1st April 1983 or which, in the case of a trailer, is manufactured on or after 1st October 1982 shall comply with the construction, fitting and performance requirements specified in Annexes I, II and VII to Community Directive 79/489, and if relevant, Annexes III, IV, V, VI and VIII to that Directive in relation to the category of vehicles specified in that item in column 3.Provided that it shall be lawful for any vehicle of such a class which, in the case of a motor vehicle, was first used before 1st April 1983 or which, in the case of a trailer, was manufactured before 1st October 1982 to comply with the said requirements instead of complying with regulations 16 and 17.
(1A) Save as provided in paragraphs (2),(3), (3A) and (5), the braking system of every wheeled vehicle of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table which, in the case of a motor vehicle, is first used on or after the relevant date or which, in the case of a trailer, is manufactured on or after the relevant date shall comply with the construction, fitting and performance requirements specified in Annexes I, II and VII to Community Directive 85/647, and if relevant, Annexes III, IV, V, VI, VIII, X, XI and XII to that Directive in relation to the category of vehicles specified in that item in column 3.Provided that it shall be lawful for any vehicle of such a class which, in the case of a motor vehicle, was first used before the relevant date or which, in the case of a trailer, was manufactured before the relevant date to comply with the said requirements instead of complying with paragraph (1) or with regulations 16 and 17.
(1B) In paragraph (1A), the relevant date in relation to a vehicle of a class specified in item 1 or 2 of the Table is 1st April 1990, in relation to a vehicle specified in item 4 of that Table is 1st April 1992, in relation to a vehicle in items 7, 8, 9 or 10 of that Table is 1st October 1988 and in relation to a vehicle of any other class is 1st April 1989.
(1C) Save as provided in paragraphs (2), (3), (3A) and (5A), the braking system of every wheeled vehicle of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table which, in the case of a motor vehicle, is first used on or after 1st April 1992 or which, in the case of a trailer, is manufactured on or after 1st October 1991 shall comply with the construction, fitting and performance requirements specified in Annexes I, II and VII to Community Directive 88/194, and if relevant, Annexes III, IV, V, VI, VIII, X, XI and XII to that Directive in relation to the category of vehicles specified in that item in column 3.Provided that it shall be lawful for any vehicle of such a class which, in the case of a motor vehicle, was first used before 1st April 1992 or which, in the case of a trailer, was manufactured before 1st October 1991 to comply with the said requirements instead of complying with paragraph (1) or (1A) or with regulations 16 and 17.
(1D) Save as provided in paragraphs (2), (3), (3A) and (5A), the braking system of every wheeled vehicle of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table which, in the case of a motor vehicle, is first used on or after 1st April 1995 or which, in the case of a trailer, is manufactured on or after that date shall comply with the construction, fitting and performance requirements specified in Annexes I, II, and VII to Community Directive 91/422, and if relevant, Annexes III, IV, V, VI, VIII, X, XI and XII to that Directive in relation to the category of vehicles specified in that item in column 3.Provided that it shall be lawful for any vehicle of such a class which, in the case of a motor vehicle, was first used before 1st April 1995 or which, in the case of a trailer, was manufactured before that date to comply with the said requirements instead of complying with paragraph (1), (1A) or (1C) or with regulations 16 and 17.
(1E) Save as provided in paragraphs (2), (3), (3A), (5A) and (5B) the braking system of every wheeled vehicle of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table which, in the case of a motor vehicle, is first used on or after 1st May 2002 or which, in the case of a trailer, is manufactured on or after 1st May 2002 shall comply with the construction, fitting and performance requirements of Annexes I, II and VII to Community Directive 98/12/EC and if relevant, Annexes III, IV, V, VI, VIII, X, XI, XII, XIII and XIV to that Directive in relation to the category of vehicles specified in that item in column 3.Provided that it shall be lawful for any vehicle of such a class which, in the case of a motor vehicle, was first used before 1st May 2002 or which, in the case of a trailer, was manufactured before 1st May 2002 to comply with the said requirements instead of complying with paragraphs (1), (1A), (1C) or (1D) or with regulations 16 and 17.
(2) The requirements specified in paragraphs (1), (1A), (1C), (1D) and (1E) do not apply to—
(a) an agricultural trailer that is not drawn at a speed exceeding 40 km/h;
(aa) an agricultural trailed appliance that is not drawn at a speed exceeding 20 mph;
(b) a locomotive;
(c) a motor tractor;
(d) an agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor, unless it is first used after 1st June 1986 and is driven at more than 20 mph;
(da) a category T tractor unless it is first used after 1st June 1986 and is driven at more than 40 km/h;
(e) a vehicle which has a maximum speed not exceeding 25 km/h;
(f) a works trailer;
(g) a works truck;
(h) a public works vehicle;
(i) a trailer designed and constructed, or adapted, to be drawn exclusively by a vehicle to which sub–paragraph (b), (c), (e), (g) or (h) of this paragraph applies;
(j) a trailer falling within regulation 16(3)(b), (bb), (bc), (d), (e), (f) or (g);
(ja) a trailer which is manufactured before 1st January 1997 and has a maximum total design axle weight that does not exceed 750 kg; or
(k) a vehicle manufactured by Leyland Vehicles Limited and known as the Atlantean Bus, if first used before 1st October 1984.
(3) The requirements specified in paragraphs (1), (1A), (1C), (1D) and (1E) shall apply to the classes of vehicles specified in the Table so that—
(a) in item 3, the testing requirement specified in paragraph 1.5.1 and 1.5.2 of Annex II to Community Directives 79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 and 98/12 shall apply to every vehicle specified in that item other than—
(i) a double–decked vehicle first used before 1st October 1983, or
(ii) a vehicle of a type in respect of which a member state of the European Economic Community has issued a type approval certificate in accordance with Community Directive 79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 or 98/12;
(b) in items 2 and 3—
(i) the requirements specified in paragraph 1.1.4.2 of Annex II to Community Directive 79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 and 98/12 shall not apply in relation to any vehicle first used before 1st April 1996;
(ii) those requirements shall not apply in relation to any relevant bus first used on or after that date;
(iii) sub–note (2) to paragraph 1.17.2 of Annex I to Community Directive 85/647,  88/194, 91/422 and 98/12  shall not apply in relation to any vehicle,
and for the purposes of this sub-paragraph “relevant bus” means a bus that is not a coach;
(c) in items 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6, in the case of vehicles constructed or adapted for use by physically handicapped drivers, the requirement in paragraph 2.1.2.1 of Annex I to Community Directive 79/489 that the driver must be able to achieve the braking action mentioned in that paragraph from his driving seat without removing his hands from the steering control shall be modified so as to require that the driver is able to achieve that action while continuing to steer the vehicle; and
(d) in items 1, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 and 10, the requirement specified in paragraph 1.1.4.2 of Annex II to Community Directive 79/489 shall not apply to a vehicle first used (in the case of a motor vehicle) or manufactured (in the case of a trailer) before the relevant date as defined in paragraph (1B) if either—
(i) following a test in respect of which the fee numbered 26024/26250 to 26257, prescribed in Schedule 1 to the Motor Vehicles (Type Approval and Approval Marks) (Fees) Regulations 1990, or the corresponding fee prescribed under any corresponding previous enactment is payable, a document is issued by the Secretary of State indicating that, at the date of manufacture of the vehicle, the type to which it belonged complied with the requirements specified in Annex 13 to ECE Regulation 13.03, 13.04, 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09; or
(ii) as a result of a notifiable alteration to the vehicle within the meaning of regulation 3 of the Plating and Testing Regulations, a fitment has been approved as complying with the requirements mentioned in sub–paragraph (i).
(3A) The requirements specified in paragraphs (1A), (1C), (1D) and (1E) shall apply to a road tanker subject to the exclusion of paragraph 4.3 of Annex X to Community Directive 85/647.
(3B) No motor vehicle to which paragraph (1D) or (1E) applies and which is first used on or after 1st April 1996 shall be fitted with an integrated retarder unless either—
(a) the motor vehicle is fitted with an anti–lock device which acts on the retarder and which complies with the requirements specified in Annex X to Community Directive 91/422 or Community Directive 98/12; or
(b) the retarder is fitted with a cut–out device which allows the combined control to apply the service braking system alone and which can be operated by the driver from the driving seat;
and expressions (other than the word “vehicle”) used in this paragraph which are also used in Annex I to Community Directive 85/647 shall, for the purposes of this paragraph, have the same meanings as in that Annex save that “retarder” shall not in any circumstances include a regenerative braking system.
(4) Instead of complying with paragraph (1) of this regulation, a vehicle to which this regulation applies may comply with ECE Regulation 13.03, 13.04, 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09.
(5) Instead of complying with paragraph (1A) of this regulation, a vehicle to which this regulation applies may comply with ECE Regulation 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09.
(5A) Instead of complying with paragraph (1C) or (1D) of this regulation, a vehicle to which this regulation applies may comply—
(a) in the case of a trailer manufactured before 1st April 1992, with ECE Regulation 13.05 or 13.06; or
(b) in the case of any vehicle not falling within sub–paragraph (a), with ECE Regulation 13.06 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09.
(5B) Instead of complying with paragraph (1E) of this regulation, a vehicle to which this regulation applies may comply with ECE Regulation 13.09.
(6) In paragraph (3A), the expression “road tanker” means any vehicle or trailer which carries liquid fuel in a tank forming part of the vehicle or trailer other than that containing the fuel which is used to propel the vehicle, and also includes any tank with a capacity exceeding 3m3 carried on a vehicle.
(7) In this regulation, and in relation to the application to any vehicle of any provision of Community Directive 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 or 98/12, the definitions of “semi–trailer”, “full trailer” and “centre–axle trailer” set out in that Directive shall apply and the meaning of “semi–trailer” in column 2 of the Table in regulation 3(2) shall not apply.
(8) For the purposes of the preceding provisions of this regulation the date on which a trailer was manufactured shall be taken to be the date on which its manufacture was completed except that, in the case of a trailer whose manufacture has been completed for more than 8 years and which has been the subject of a notifiable alteration under regulation 30 of the Goods Vehicles (Plating and Testing) Regulations 1988, it shall be taken to be the date on which the notifiable alteration was completed.
(9) A trailer, whose manufacture has been completed for more than eight years and which has been the subject of a notifiable alteration under regulation 30 of the Goods Vehicles (Plating and Testing) Regulations 1988, shall comply with all requirements of Community Directives relating to braking systems which applied to the trailer at the date when the notifiable alteration was completed.

TABLE
1 2 3
Item Class of Vehicle Vehicle Category in the Community Directive
1 Passenger vehicles and dual–purpose vehicles which have 3 or more wheels except—
(a) dual–purpose vehicles constructed or adapted to carry not more than 2 passengers exclusive of the driver;
(b) motor cycles with sidecar attached;
(c) vehicles with three wheels, an unladen weight not exceeding 410kg, a maximum design speed not exceeding 50 km/h and an engine capacity not exceeding 50 cc;
(d) buses. M1
2 Buses having a maximum gross weight which does not exceed 5000 kg. M2
3 Buses having a maximum gross weight which exceeds 5000 kg. M3
4 Dual–purpose vehicles not within item 1; and goods vehicles, having a maximum gross weight which does not exceed 3500 kg, and not being motor cycles with a sidecar attached. N1
 Goods vehicles with a maximum gross weight which—
5 exceeds 3500 kg but does not exceed 12,000 kg; N2
6 exceeds 12,000 kg. N3
 Trailers with a maximum total design axle weight which—
7 does not exceed 750 kg; 01
8 exceeds 750 kg but does not exceed 3500 kg; 02
9 exceeds 3500 kg but does not exceed 10,000 kg; 03
10 exceeds 10,000 kg. 04
16 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraphs (2) and (3), this regulation applies to every vehicle
to which regulation 15
does not apply.
(2) Paragraph (4) of this regulation does not apply to a vehicle which complies with regulation 15 by virtue of the proviso to regulation 15(1), (1A), (1C), (1D) or (1E), or which complies with Community Directive 79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 or 98/12 or ECE Regulation 13.03, 13.04, 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09.
(3) This regulation
does not apply to the following vehicles, except in the case of a vehicle
referred to in (a) insofar as the regulation
concerns parking brakes (requirements 16 to 18 in Schedule
3)—
(a) a
locomotive first used before 2nd January 1933, propelled by steam, and with
an engine which is capable of being reversed;
(b) a trailer which is designed for use and used for street cleansing and does not carry any load other than its necessary gear and equipment;
(ba) a trailer which has a maximum total design axle weight that does not exceed 750 kg;
(bb) a trailer which—
(i) is an agricultural trailer manufactured before 1st July 1947;
(ii) is being drawn by a motor tractor or an agricultural motor vehicle at a speed not exceeding 10 mph;
(iii) has a laden weight not exceeding 4070 kg; and
(iv) is the only trailer being drawn;
(bc) a trailer which is being drawn by a motor cycle in accordance with regulation 84;
(c) an
agricultural trailed appliance;
(d) an
agricultural trailed appliance conveyor;
(e) a
broken down vehicle;
(f) before
1st October 1986—
(i) 
a trailer with an unladen weight not exceeding 102 kg which was manufactured
before 1st October 1982; and
(ii) 
a gritting trailer; or
(g) on
or after 1st October 1986, a gritting trailer with a maximum gross weight
not exceeding 2000 kg.
(4) Save as
provided in paragraph (7), a vehicle of a class specified in an item in column
2 of the Table shall comply with the requirements shown in column 3 in that
item, subject to any exemptions or modifications shown in column 4 in that
item, reference to numbers in column 3 being references to the requirements
so numbered in Schedule 3.


TABLE(regulation 16(4))


1 2 3 4
Item
 Class of vehicle Requirements in Schedule 3   Exemptions or modifications
 Motor cars
1 First used before 1st January
1915. 3, 6, 7, 13, 16 Requirements 13 and 16 do not apply to a motor car with
less than 4 wheels.
2 First used on or after 1st January 1915 but before
1st April 1938. 1, 4, 6, 7, 9, 16 A works truck within items 1 to 11 is not subject
to requirements 1, 2, 3 or 4 if it is equipped with one braking system with
one means of operation.
3
 First used on or after 1st April 1938
and being either a track-laying vehicle or a vehicle first used before 1st
January 1968. 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 16
4 Wheeled vehicles first used on or after 1st January
1968. 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 15,  18

 Heavy motor cars
5 
First used before 15th August 1928. 
1, 6, 16
6 First used on or after 15th August 1928 but before 1st April
1938. 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 16
7 First
used on or after 1st April 1938 and being either a track-laying vehicle or
a vehicle first used before 1st January 1968. 
1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 16

8 Wheeled vehicles first used
on or after 1st January 1968. 
1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9,  15, 18
 Motor cycles
9 
First used before 1st January 1927. 
3, and, in the case of three-wheeled vehicles, 16
10 First used
on or after 1st January 1927 but before 1st January 1968. 2, 7, and, in the case of three-wheeled vehicles, 16
11 First used on or after 1st January 1968 and not being a motor cycle
to which paragraph (5)
applies. 2, 7, and, in the case of three-wheeled
vehicles, 18
 Locomotives
12 
Wheeled vehicles first used before 1st June 1955. 3, 6, 12, 16
13
 Wheeled vehicles first used on or after
1st June 1955 but before 1st January 1968. 
3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 18
14 Wheeled vehicles first used on or after 1st January
1968. 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 18
15 Track-laying vehicles. 3,
6, 16
 Motor tractors
16 
Wheeled vehicles first used before 14th January 1931 and track-laying vehicles
first used before 1st April 1938. 3,
4, 6, 7, 16 Industrial tractors within
items 16 to 19 are subject to requirement 5 instead of requirement 4.
17 
Wheeled vehicles first used on or after 14th January 1931 but before 1st April
1938. 3, 4, 6, 7, 9, 16
18 Wheeled
vehicles first used on or after 1st April 1938 but before 1st January 1968.
 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 16
19 Wheeled
vehicles first used on or after 1st January 1968. 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 18
20 Track-laying vehicles
first used on or after 1st April 1938. 
3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 16
 Wheeled agricultural motor
vehicles  (other than category T tractors) not driven at more than 20 mph
21 First used
before 1st January 1968. 3, 4, 6, 7,
8, 16
22 First used on or after 1st January 1968 but before 9th February
1980. 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 18
23 
First used on or after 9th February 1980. 
3, 5, 6, 7, 8, 18
 Invalid carriages
24 Whenever first used. 3, 13

 Trailers
25 Manufactured
before 1st April 1938. 3, 10, 14, 17

26 Manufactured on or after 1st April 1938 and being either a track-laying
vehicle, an agricultural trailer or a vehicle manufactured before 1st January
1968. 3, 8, 10, 14, 17 Agricultural trailers are not subject to requirement 8.

27 Wheeled vehicles manufactured on or after 1st January 1968, not
being an agricultural trailer. 3, 4,
8, 11, 15, 18 Trailers equipped with
brakes which come into operation on the overrun of the vehicle are not subject
to requirement 15.
 Category T tractors not driven at more than 40 km/h  
28 First used before 1st January 1968. 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 16 
29 First used on or after 1st January 1968 but before 9th February 1980. 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 18 
30 First used on or after 9th February 1980. 3, 5, 6, 7, 8, 18 Provided that
wheeled agricultural motor vehicles  , not being category T tractors, not driven at more than 20 mph are excluded
from all items other than items 21 to 23  and provided further that category T tractors not driven at more than 40 km/h are excluded from all items other than items 28 to 30.
(5) Subject to paragraphs (5B) and (6), the braking system of a motor cycle to which this regulation applies and which is—
(a) of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table below; and
(b) first used on or after 1st April 1987 and before 22nd May 1995;
shall comply with ECE Regulation 13.05, 78 or 78.01 or Community Directive 93/14  in relation to the category of vehicles specified in that item in column 3.
(5A) Subject to paragraph (6), the braking system of a motor cycle to which this regulation applies and which is—
(a) of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table below; and
(b) first used on or after 22nd May 1995;
shall comply with ECE Regulation 78.01 or Community Directive 93/14  in relation to the category of vehicles specified in that item in column 3.

TABLE
1 2 3
Item Class of Vehicle Vehicle Category in ECE Regulations or Community Directive 93/14 (as the case may be)
1 Vehicles (without a sidecar attached) with two wheels, an engine capacity not exceeding 50 cc and a maximum design speed not exceeding 50 km/h. L1
2 Vehicles with three wheels (including two-wheeled vehicles with a sidecar attached) and with an engine capacity not exceeding 50 cc and a maximum design speed not exceeding 50 km/h. L2
3 Vehicles with two wheels (without a sidecar attached) and with—
(a) an engine capacity exceeding 50 cc, or
(b) a maximum design speed exceeding 50 km/h. L3
4 Vehicles with two wheels, a sidecar attached and—
(a) an engine capacity exceeding 50 cc, or
(b) a maximum design speed exceeding 50 km/h. L4
5  Vehicles with three wheels (excluding two-wheeled vehicles with a sidecar attached) and with—
(a) an engine capacity exceeding 50cc, or
(b) a maximum design speed exceeding 50km/h. 
                            L5
                          
(5B) In relation to a motor cycle with two wheels manufactured by Piaggio Veicoli Europei Societa per Azione and known as the Cosa 125, the Cosa 125E, the Cosa L125, the Cosa LX125, the Cosa 200, the Cosa 200E, the Cosa L200 or the Cosa LX200, paragraph (5) shall have effect as if ECE Regulation 13.05 were modified by–
(a) the omission of paragraph 4.4 (approval marks), and
(b) in paragraph 5.3.1.1, (independent braking devices and controls), the omission of the word “independent” in the first place where it appears,
but this paragraph shall not apply to a motor cycle first used on or after 1st July 1991.
(6) Paragraph
(5) does not apply to a works truck or to a vehicle constructed or assembled
by a person not ordinarily engaged in the business of manufacturing vehicles
of that description.
(6A) Paragraph (5A) does not apply to—
(a) a vehicle with a maximum speed not exceeding 25 km/h; or
(b) a vehicle fitted for an invalid driver.
(7) Instead
of complying with the provisions of paragraph (4) of this Regulation an agricultural
motor vehicle may comply with Community Directive 76/432 or 96/63.

17 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), every motor vehicle which is equipped with a braking
system which embodies a vacuum or pressure reservoir or reservoirs shall be
equipped with a device so placed as to be readily visible to the driver of
the vehicle and which is capable of indicating any impending failure of, or
deficiency in, the vacuum or pressure system.
(2) The requirement
specified in paragraph (1) does not apply in respect of—
(a) a vehicle to which paragraph (1), (1A), (1C), (1D) or (1E) of regulation 15 applies, or which complies with the requirements of that regulation, of Community Directives 79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 or 98/12 or of ECE Regulation 13.03, 13.04, 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09;
(b) an
agricultural motor vehicle which complies with Community Directive 76/432 or 96/63;

(c) a
vehicle with an unladen weight not exceeding 3050 kg propelled by an internal
combustion engine, if the vacuum in the reservoir or reservoirs is derived
directly from the induction system of the engine, and if, in the event of
a failure of, or deficiency in, the vacuum system, the brakes of that braking
system are sufficient under the most adverse conditions to bring the vehicle
to rest within a reasonable distance; or
(d) a
vehicle first used before 1st October 1937.
17A 

(1) In this regulation—
 “BS coupling” means a coupling which—
(a) is of the type, shown in figure 1, 4 or 5 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138a: 1980 or figure 1, 2 or 3 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138b: 2000; and
(b) complies with the dimensions shown in figure 1, 4 or 5 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138a: 1980 or figure 1, 2 or 3 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138b:2000;
 “the British Standard specification” means the British Standard specification for dimensions of ‘contact’ type couplings for air pressure braking systems on trailers and semi-trailers and their towing vehicles, and the arrangements of these couplings on articulated and drawbar combinations, published by the British Standards Institution under reference number BS AU 138a: 1980 or BS AU 138b: 2000;
 “coupling”, “emergency line”, “secondary line” and “service line” have the same meanings as in the British Standard specification;
 “EEA Agreement” means the Agreement on the European Economic Area signed at Oporto on the 2nd May 1992 as adjusted by the Protocol signed at Brussels on 17th March 1993; and
 “EEA State” means a state which is a Contracting Party to the EEA Agreement.
(2) For the purposes of this regulation, a relevant coupling is a coupling that is physically capable of being connected to a BS coupling.
(3) Subject to paragraphs (6) and (7), no service line comprised in a pneumatic braking system fitted to a trailer shall be equipped with a relevant coupling unless that coupling—
(a) is of the type showin in figure 2 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138a:1980 or figure 4 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138b:2000;
(b) complies with the dimensions shown in that figure; and
(c) complies with paragraph 3.4.3 of that specification (except so far as it requires it to be of a type shown in that figure).
(4) Subject to paragraphs (6), (7) and (8) no emergency line comprised in a pneumatic braking system fitted to a trailer shall be equipped with a relevant coupling unless that coupling—
(a) is of the type shown in figure 3 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138a:1980 or figure 5 of the British Standard specification 138b:2000; and
(b) complies with the dimensions shown in that figure.
(5) Subject to paragraphs (6), (7) and (8) no secondary line comprised in a pneumatic braking system fitted to a trailer shall be equipped with a relevant coupling unless that coupling—
(a) is of the type shown in figure 6 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138a:1980 or figure 6 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138b:2000; and
(b) complies with the dimensions shown in that figure.
(6) For the purposes of paragraphs (3), (4) and (5), a reference to the dimensions shown in a figure in the British Standard specification does not include any dimension marked “M22×1.5”.
(7) Paragraph (3) does not prevent a line being equipped with a relevant coupling which fulfils the requirements of—
(a) a standard or code of practice of a national standards body or equivalent body of any EEA State;
(b) any international standard recognised for use as a standard by any EEA State; or
(c) a technical specification or code of practice which, whether mandatory or not, is recognised for use as a standard by a public authority of any EEA State,
where the standard, code of practice, international standard or technical specification provides, in relation to couplings, a level of safety and compatibility with BS couplings of the type shown in figure 1 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138a:1980 or figure 1 of the British Standard specification BS AU 138b:2000 equivalent to that provided by those specifications as modified in accordance with paragraph (6).
(8) Paragraph (7) shall have effect—
(a) in relation to paragraph (4), as if for the words “paragraph (3)” there were substituted the words “paragraph (4)” and for the words “figure 1” in the first and second places in which they occur there were substituted the words “figure 4” and “figure 2” respectively; and
(b) in relation to paragraph (5), as if for the words “paragraph (3)” there were substituted the words “paragraph (5)” and for the words “figure 1” in the first and second places in which they occur there were substituted the words “figure 5” and “figure 3” respectively.
18 

(1) Every
part of every braking system and of the means of operation thereof fitted
to a vehicle shall be maintained in good and efficient working order and be
properly adjusted.
(1A) Without prejudice to paragraph (3), where a vehicle is fitted with an anti-lock braking system (“the ABS”), then while the condition specified in paragraph (1B) is fulfilled, any fault in the ABS shall be disregarded for the purposes of paragraph (1).
(1B) The condition is fulfilled while the vehicle is completing a journey at the beginning of which the ABS was operating correctly or is being driven to a place where the ABS is to undergo repairs.
(1C) Where a goods vehicle of category N2 or N3 is being used to tow a trailer of category O3 or O4 and both vehicles are fitted with an ISO 7638 connector to provide a dedicated power supply to the ABS, then these connectors shall be used regardless of any alternative method available on the vehicles to provide such power.
(2) Paragraph
(3) applies to every wheeled motor vehicle except—
(a) an
agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor, which is not driven at more than 20 mph;
(aa) a category T tractor which is not driven at more than 40 km/h;
(b) a
works truck; ...
(c) a
pedestrian-controlled vehicle; and
(d) an industrial tractor.
(3) Every
vehicle to which this paragraph applies and which is of a class specified
in an item in column 2 of Table I shall, subject to any exemption shown for
that item in column 4, be so maintained that—
(a) its
service braking system has a total braking efficiency not less than that shown
in column 3(a) for that item; and
(b) if
the vehicle is a heavy motor car, a motor car first used on or after 1st January
1915 or a motor-cycle first used on or after 1st January 1927, its secondary
braking system has a total braking efficiency not less than that shown in
column 3(b) for those items.Provided that
a reference in Table I to a trailer is a reference to a trailer required by regulation 15 or 16 to be equipped
with brakes.

TABLE I(regulation 18(3))


1 2 3 4

Item Class of vehicle Efficiencies (%) 
Exemptions
  (a)  (b) 
1 A vehicle , not included in item 1A, to which regulation 15
applies or which complies in all respects other than its braking efficiency
with the requirements of that regulation or with   Community Directives 79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 or 98/12 or with ECE Regulation 13.03, 13.04, 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09—   A motor cycle.
1A A vehicle of a class specified in item 1 of the Table in regulation 15 and first used on or after 25th July 2010. 58  29 
 (a) when not drawing a trailer; 50  25 
 (b) when drawing
a trailer 45  25 
2 A vehicle, not
included in item 1 and not being a motor cycle, which is first used on or
after 1st January 1968—   
 (a) when not
drawing a trailer; 50  25 
 (b) when not drawing a trailer manufactured on or
after 1st January 1968; 
50  25 
 (c) when drawing
a trailer manufactured before 1st January 1968 40  15 
3  Goods vehicles and buses (in each case)  first used on or after 15th August
1928 but before 1st January 1968 having an unladen weight exceeding 1525 kg
being—   
 (a) rigid vehicles
with 2 axles not constructed to form part of an articulated vehicle—
   
 (i) when not drawing a trailer 
45  20 
 (ii) when drawing a trailer 
40  15 
 (b) other vehicles,
including vehicles constructed to form part of an articulated vehicle, whether
or not drawing a trailer 
40  15 
3A A category T tractor which is driven at more than 40 km/h—   
 (a) when not drawing a trailer 50  25 
 (b) when drawing a non-agricultural trailer 45  25 
4 Vehicles not included in items 1 to 3A—   (a) a bus;
 
(a) having at least one means of operation applying to at least
4 wheels; 50  25 (b) an articulated
vehicle;
 (b) having 3 wheels and
at least one means of operation applying to all 3 wheels and not being a motor
cycle with sidecar attached—   (c) a vehicle
constructed or adapted to form part of an articulated vehicle;
 
(i) when not drawing a trailer 40  25 
(d) a heavy motor car which is a goods vehicle first used before
15th August 1928.
 (ii) in the case of a motor cycle when drawing a
trailer 40  25 
 (c) other   
 (i) when not drawing a trailer 30  25 
 (ii) in the case of a motor
cycle when drawing a trailer. 
30  25 
(3A) For a category T tractor which is driven at more than 40 km/h, when drawing an agricultural trailer each component of the combination shall comply with the requirements of that component specified in item 3A(a) of Table I and with paragraph (5)(c).
(4) A goods
vehicle shall not be deemed to comply with the requirements of paragraph (3)
unless it is capable of complying with those requirements both at the laden
weight at which it is operating at any time and when its laden weight is equal
to—
(a) if
a plating certificate has been issued and is in force for the vehicle, the
design gross weight shown in column (3) of that certificate or, if no such
weight is so shown, the gross weight shown in column (2) of that certificate;
and
(b) in
any other case, the design gross weight of the vehicle.Provided that
in the case of a goods vehicle drawing a trailer, references in this paragraph
to laden weight refer to the combined laden weight of the drawing vehicle
and the trailer and references to gross weight and design gross weight are
to be taken as references to train weight and design train weight respectively.

(4A) A bus shall be deemed not to comply with the requirements of paragraph (3) unless it is capable of complying with those requirements both at its laden weight for the time being and at its relevant weight.
(4B) For the purposes of paragraph (4A), the relevant weight,—
(a) in relation to a bus first used on or after 1st April 1982, is its maximum gross weight; and
(b) in relation to a bus first used before that date, is the weight specified in paragraph (4C).
(4C) The weight referred to in paragraph (4B)(b) is—X+63.5(Y+Z)kgwhere—
 X is the unladen weight of that bus in kilograms;
 Y is the number of passengers that the bus is constructed or adapted to carry seated in addition to the driver; and
 Z is—
(a) in the case of a PSV which is not an articulated bus and has a standing capacity exceeding 8 persons, the standing capacity minus 8;
(b) in the case of a PSV which is an articulated bus, the standing capacity; or
(c) in any other case, nil.
(5) The brakes of—
(a) an agricultural motor vehicle, not being a category T tractor, which is first used on or after 1st June 1986 and is not driven at more than 20 mph;
(b) a category T tractor which is first used on or after 1st June 1986 and is not driven at more than 40 km/h; and
(c) an agricultural trailer manufactured on or after 1st December 1985,
shall be capable of achieving a braking efficiency of not less than 25% when the weight of the vehicle is equal to the total maximum axle weights which the vehicle is designed to have.
(6) Every
vehicle or combination of vehicles specified in an item in column 2 of Table
II shall be so maintained that its brakes are capable, without the assistance
of stored energy, of holding it stationary on a gradient of at least the percentage
specified in column 3 in that item.

TABLE II(regulation 18(6))

1 2
 3
Item Class
of vehicle or combination Percentage
gradient

1 A vehicle specified in item 1 of Table
I—
 (a) when not
drawing a trailer 16
 (b) when drawing a trailer 12
2 A vehicle to which requirement 18 in Schedule 3 applies by virtue of regulation 16. 16
3 A vehicle, not included
in item 1, drawing a trailer manufactured on or after 1st January 1968 and
required, by regulation 15 or 16,
to be fitted with brakes. 
16
(7) For the
purpose of this regulation the date of manufacture of a trailer which is a
composite trailer shall be deemed to be the same as the date of manufacture
of the semi-trailer which forms part of the composite trailer.
(8) A vehicle
which is subject to, and which complies with the requirements in, item 1 in
Tables I and II shall not be treated as failing, by reason of its braking
efficiency, to comply with regulation 15
or with   Community Directives 79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 or 98/12 or with ECE Regulation 13.03, 13.04, 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09.
(9) In this regulation—
 “PSV” means a public service vehicle within the meaning of section 1 of the Public Passenger Vehicles Act 1981;
 “standing capacity”, in relation to a PSV, means the number of persons that can be carried standing without an offence being committed under section 26 of the Public Passenger Vehicles Act 1981.
18A. 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19 
Where a trailer is drawn by a motor vehicle the driver (or in the
case of a locomotive one of the persons employed in driving or tending the
locomotive) shall be in a position readily to operate any brakes required
by these Regulations to be fitted to the trailer as well as the brakes of
the motor vehicle unless a person other than the driver (or in the case of a locomotive a person other than one of the persons employed in driving or tending the locomotive)  is in a position and
competent efficiently to apply the brakes of the trailer.
Provided that this
regulation shall not apply to a trailer which—
(a) 
in compliance with these Regulations, is fitted with brakes which automatically
come into operation on the overrun of the trailer; or
(b) ... is a broken down vehicle being drawn, whether or not in consequence
of a breakdown, in such a manner that it cannot be steered by its own steering
gear.
C
20 
Every motor cycle and invalid carriage shall be a wheeled vehicle,
and every other motor vehicle and every trailer shall be either a wheeled
vehicle or a track-laying vehicle.
21 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraphs (3) and (4), every motor vehicle and every trailer
shall be equipped with suitable and sufficient springs between each wheel
and the frame of the vehicle.
(2) Save as
provided in paragraphs (3) and (4)in the case of a track-laying vehicle—

(a) resilient
material shall be interposed between the rims of the weight-carrying rollers
and the road surface so that the weight of the vehicle, other than that borne
by any wheel, is supported by the resilient material; and
(b) where
the vehicle is a heavy motor car, motor car, or trailer it shall have suitable
springs between the frame of the vehicle and the weight-carrying rollers.

(3) This regulation
does not apply to—
(a) a
wheeled vehicle with an unladen weight not exceeding 4070 kg and which is—

(i) 
a motor tractor any unsprung wheel of which is fitted with a pneumatic tyre;

(ii) 
a motor tractor used in connection with railway shunting and which is used
on a road only when passing from one railway track to another in connection
with such use;
(iii) 
a vehicle specially designed, and mainly used, for work on rough ground or
unmade roads and every wheel of which is fitted with a pneumatic tyre and
which is not driven at more than 20 mph;
(iv) 
a vehicle constructed or adapted for, and being used for, road sweeping and
every wheel of which is fitted with either a pneumatic tyre or a resilient
tyre and which is not driven at more than 20 mph;
(b) an
agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor, which is not driven at more than 20 mph;
(ba) a category T tractor which is not driven at more than 40 km/h;
(c) an
agricultural trailer, or an agricultural trailed appliance;
(d) a
trailer used solely for the haulage of felled trees;
(e) a
motor cycle;
(f) a
mobile crane;
(g) a
pedestrian-controlled vehicle all the wheels of which are equipped with pneumatic
tyres;
(h) a
road roller;
(i) a
broken down vehicle; or
(j) a
vehicle first used on or before 1st January 1932.
(4) Paragraphs
(1) and (2)(b) do not apply to a works
truck or a works trailer.
23 

(1) Subject
to paragraph (2) this regulation applies to—
(a) a
semi-trailer with more than 2 wheels;
(b) a
track-laying vehicle with more than 2 wheels; and
(c) any
other vehicle with more than 4 wheels.
(2) This regulation
does not apply to a road roller.
(3) Save as
provided in paragraphs (4) and (5), every vehicle to which this regulation
applies shall be fitted with a compensating arrangement which will ensure
that under the most adverse conditions every wheel will remain in contact
with the road and will not be subject to abnormal variations of load.
(4) Paragraph
(3) does not apply in respect of a steerable wheel on which the load does
not exceed—
(a) if
it is a wheeled vehicle,  4250 kg; and
(b) if
it is a track-laying vehicle, 2540 kg.
(5) In the
application of paragraph (3) to an agricultural motor vehicle, wheels which
are in line transversely on one side of the longitudinal axis of the vehicle
shall be regarded as one wheel.
24 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), every wheel of a vehicle of a class specified in
an item in column 2 of the Table shall be fitted with a tyre of a type specified
in that item in column 3 which complies with any conditions specified in that
item in column 4.
(2) The requirements
referred to in paragraph (1) do not apply to a road roller and are subject,
in the case of any item in the Table, to the exemptions specified in that
item in column 5.

TABLE(regulation 24(1))

1 2 3 4 5
Item 
Class of vehicle Type
of tyre Conditions Exemptions
1 
Locomotives not falling in item 6 Pneumatic
or resilient
2 Motor tractors not falling in item 6 Pneumatic or resilient No re-cut pneumatic tyre shall be fitted to any wheel of a vehicle
with an unladen weight of less than 2540 kg unless the diameter of the rim
of the wheel is at least 405 mm

3 Heavy motor cars not falling in item
6 Pneumatic  The following, if every wheel
not fitted with a pneumatic tyre is fitted with a resilient tyre—(a) a vehicle mainly used for
work on rough ground;(b)
a tower wagon;(c)
a vehicle fitted with a turn-table fire escape;(d) a refuse vehicle;(e) a works truck;(f) a vehicle first used before 3rd January 1933.

4 Motor cars not falling in item 6 
Pneumatic No re-cut tyre shall be fitted
to any wheel of a vehicle unless it is—(a) an electrically propelled goods vehicle or,(b) a goods vehicle with an
unladen weight of at least 2540 kg and the diameter of the rim of the wheel
is at least 405 mm. The following, if
every wheel not fitted with a pneumatic tyre is fitted with a resilient tyre—

(a) a vehicle mainly used for work on rough
ground;
(b) a refuse vehicle;
(c) a works truck;
(d) a vehicle with an unladen weight not
exceeding— 
(i) 1270 kg if electrically propelled;
(ii) 1020 kg in any other case;
(e) a tower wagon;
(f) a vehicle fitted with a turn-table fire
escape;
(g) a vehicle first used before 3rd January
1933.
5 Motor cycles Pneumatic
 No re-cut tyre shall be fitted The following, if every wheel not fitted with a
pneumatic tyre is fitted with a resilient tyre—(a) a works truck;(b) a pedestrian-controlled vehicle
6 (a) agricultural motor vehicles, not being category T tractors, which are not driven at more than 20 mph; and(b) category T tractors which are not driven at more than 40 km/h Pneumatic or resilient 
The same as for item 2 The requirement
in column 3 does not apply to a vehicle of which—
(a) every steering wheel is fitted with a
smooth-soled tyre which is not less than 60 mm wide where it touches the road;
and
(b) in the case of a wheeled vehicle, every
driving wheel is fitted with a smooth-soled tyre which— 
(i) is not less than 150 mm wide if the unladen
weight of the vehicle exceeds 3050 kg, or 76 mm wide in any other case, and
either
(ii) is shod with diagonal cross-bars not
less than 76 mm wide or more than 20 mm thick extending the full breadth of
the tyre and so arranged that the space between adjacent bars is not more
than 76 mm; or
(iii) is shod with diagonal cross-bars of
resilient material not less than 60 mm wide extending the full breadth of
the tyre and so arranged that the space between adjacent bars is not more
than 76 mm.

7 Trailers Pneumatic Except in the case
of a trailer mentioned in paragraph (d)
of column 5, no re-cut tyre shall be fitted to any wheel of a trailer drawn
by a heavy motor car or a motor car if the trailer—
(a) has an unladen weight not exceeding— 
(i) if it is a living van, 2040 kg; or
(ii) in any other case, 1020 kg; or
(b) is not constructed or adapted to carry
any load, other than plant or other special appliance which is a permanent
or essentially permanent fixture and has a gross weight not exceeding 2290
kg 
(a) an agricultural trailer manufactured
before 1st December 1985;
(b) an agricultural trailed appliance;
(c) a trailer used to carry water for a road
roller being used in connection with road works;
(d) the following if every wheel which is
not fitted with a pneumatic tyre is fitted with a resilient tyre— 
(i) a works trailer;
(ii) a refuse vehicle;
(iii) a trailer drawn by a heavy motor car
every wheel of which is not required to be fitted with a pneumatic tyre;
(iv) a broken down vehicle; or
(v) a trailer drawn by a vehicle which is
not a heavy motor car or a motor car.
(3) Save as
provided in paragraph (4) a wheel of a vehicle may not be fitted with a temporary
use spare tyre unless either—
(a) the
vehicle is a passenger vehicle (not being a bus) first used before 1st April
1987; or
(b) the
vehicle complies at the time of its first use with ECE Regulation 64 or Community Directive 92/23.
(4) Paragraph
(3) does not apply to a vehicle constructed or assembled by a person not ordinarily
engaged in the trade or business of manufacturing vehicles of that description.

25 

(1) Save as provided in   paragraphs (3), (4), (7A) and (7B)   any tyre fitted to the axle of a vehicle–
(a) which is a class of vehicle specified in an item in column 2 of Table I; and
(b) in relation to which the date of first use is as specified in that item in column 3 of that Table;
shall comply with the requirements specified in that item in column 4 of that Table.

TABLE I
1 2 3 4
Item Class of vehicle Date of first use Requirements
1 Vehicles which are of one ormore of the following descriptions, namely–
(a) goods vehicles,
(b) trailers,
(c) buses,
(d) vehicles of a class mentioned in column 2 in Table III Before 1st April 1991 The requirements of paragraphs (5) and (6)
2 Vehicles which are of one ormore of the following descriptions–
(a) goods vehicles,
(b) trailers,
(c) buses,
(d) vehicles of a class mentioned in column 2 in Table III,and do not fall within item 3 below On or after1st April 1991 The requirements of paragraphs (5), (6) and (7)
3 
 Vehicles of a class mentioned in paragraph (2) On or after1st April 1991 The requirements of paragraph (5)
(2) The classes of vehicle referred to in item 3 in column 2 of Table I are–
(a) engineering plant;
(b) track-laying vehicles;
(c) vehicles equipped with tyres of speed category Q;
(d) works trucks; and
(e) motor vehicles with a maximum speed not exceeding 30 mph, not being vehicles of a class specified in–
(i) items 2 and 3 of Table II; or
(ii) paragraph (7A) or sub-paragraphs (a) to (d) of this paragraph;
 or trailers while being drawn by such vehicles.
(3) Paragraph (1) shall not apply to any tyre fitted to the axle of a vehicle if the vehicle is–
(a) broken down or proceeding to a place where it is to be broken up; and
(b) being drawn by a motor vehicle at a speed not exceeding 20 mph.
(4) Where in relation to any vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1991 a tyre supplied by a manufacturer for the purposes of tests or trials of that tyre is fitted to an axle of that vehicle,  paragraph (7) shall not apply to that tyre while it is being used for those purposes.
(5) The requirements of this paragraph are that the tyre, as respects strength, shall be designed and manufactured adequately to support the maximum permitted axle weight for the axle.
(6) The requirements of this paragraph are that the tyre shall be designed and  manufactured  adequately to support the maximum permitted axle weight for the axle when the vehicle is driven at the speed shown in column 3 in Table II in the item in which the vehicle is described in column 2 (the lowest relevant speed being applicable to a vehicle which is described in more than one item).

TABLE II
1 2 3 4
Item Class of vehicle Speed (mph) Variation to the  load-capacity index  expressed as a percentage
   Tyres marked in accordance with ECE Regulation 30, 30.01 or 30.02and relevant car tyres Tyres marked in accordance with ECE Regulation 54 and relevant commercial vehicle tyres
1 A vehicle of a class for which maximum speeds are prescribed by Schedule 6 to the 1984 Act other than an agricultural motor vehicle The highest speed so prescribed Single wheels: none None
   Dual wheels: 95.5%
2 An electrically propelled vehicle used as a multi-stop local collection and delivery vehicle and having a maximum speed of not more than 25 mph The maximum speed of the vehicle None 150%
3 An electrically propelled vehicle used as a multi-stop local collection and delivery vehicle and having a maximum speed of more than 25 mph and not more than 40 mph The maximum speed of the vehicle None 130%
4 An electrically propelled vehicle used only within a radius of 25 miles from the permanent base at which it is normally kept and having a maximum speed of more than 40 mph and not more than 50 mph The maximum speed of the vehicle None 115%
5 A local service bus 50 None 110%
6 A restricted speed vehicle 50 None The relevant % variation specified in Annex 8 to ECE Regulation 54 or Appendix 8 to Annex II to Community Directive 92/23
7 A low platform trailer , an agricultural motor vehicle, an agricultural trailer, an agricultural trailed appliance or an agricultural trailed appliance conveyor 40 None The relevant % variation specified in Annex 8 to ECE Regulation 54 or Appendix 8 to Annex II to Community Directive 92/23
8 A municipal vehicle 40 None 115%
9 A multi-stop local collection and delivery vehicle if not falling within the class of vehicle described in items 2 or 3 above 40 None 115%
10 A light trailer or any trailer equipped with tyres of speed category F or G 60 Single wheels: 110% The relevant variation specified in Annex 8 to ECE
   Dual wheels: 105% Regulation 54 or Appendix 8 to Annex II to Community Directive 92/23
11 A trailer not falling in items 6–10 60 Single wheels: none None
   Dual wheels: 95.5%
12 A  motor vehicle not falling in items 1–11 70 Single wheels: none None
   Dual wheels: 95.5%
(7) The requirement of this paragraph is that the tyre when first fitted to the vehicle was marked with a designated approval mark or  complied with the requirements of  ECE Regulation 30, 30.01, 30.02  or 54, or, in the case of a retreaded tyre, with the requirements of ECE Regulation 108 or 109.
(7A) The requirements of paragraphs (6) and (7) shall not apply to any tyre fitted to the axle of  a vehicle of a class specified in an item in column 2 of Table III while the vehicle  is being driven or drawn at a speed not exceeding that specified in that item in column 3 of that Table.

TABLE III
1 2 3
Item Class of vehicle Speed ...
1 Agricultural motor vehicles other than category T tractors 20 mph
2 Agricultural trailers 40 km/h
3 Agricultural trailed appliances 20 mph
4 Agricultural trailed appliance conveyors 20 mph
5 Works trailers 18 mph
6 Category T tractors 40 km/h
(7B) Paragraph (7C) applies where a tyre fitted to the axle of a vehicle—
(a) bears a speed category symbol and load–capacity index, being marks that were moulded on to or into the tyre at the time that it was manufactured;
(b) is designed and manufactured so as to be capable of operating safely at the speed and load indicated by those marks; and
(c) is designed so as to be capable of being fitted to the axle of a vehicle of a class specified in item 1, 2, 3 or 4 in column 2 of Table III above.
(7C) In the circumstances mentioned in paragraph (7B), paragraph (7) shall not apply to the tyre if—
(a) the vehicle is being driven or drawn at a speed that does not exceed the speed indicated by the speed category symbol or 50 mph (whichever is the less), and
(b) the load on the tyre does not exceed the load indicated by the load–capacity index.
(8) A vehicle of a class described in column 2 in Table II first used on or after 1st April 1991 shall not be used on a road–
(a) in the case where there is no entry in column 4 specifying a variation to the  load-capacity index  expressed as a percentage, if the load applied to any tyre fitted to the axle of the vehicle exceeds that indicated by the load-capacity index; or
(b) in the case where there is such an entry in column 4, if the load applied to any tyre fitted to the axle of the vehicle exceeds the variation to the load-capacity index expressed as a percentage.
(9) In this regulation–
 “designated approval mark” means the marking designated as an approval mark by regulation 5 of the Approval Marks Regulations and shown at item 33 in Schedule 4 to those Regulations (that item being a marking relating to Community Directive 92/23);
 “dual wheels” means two or more wheels which are to be regarded as one wheel by virtue of paragraph 7 of regulation 3 in the circumstances specified in that paragraph;
 “load-capacity index” has the same meaning as in paragraph 2.28 of Annex II to Community Directive 92/23 or  paragraph 2 of ECE Regulation 30.02 or ECE Regulation 54, or as “load index” in paragraph 2 of ECE Regulation 108 or ECE Regulation 109;
 “local service bus” means a bus being used in the provision of a local service as defined in section 2 of the Transport Act 1985;
 “municipal vehicle” means a motor vehicle or trailer limited at all times to use by a local authority, or a person acting in pursuance of a contract with a local authority, for road cleansing, road watering or the collection and disposal of refuse, night soil or the contents of cesspools, or the purposes of the enactments relating to weights and measures or the sale of food and drugs;
 “multi-stop local collection and delivery vehicle” means a motor vehicle or trailer used for multi-stop collection and delivery services to be used only within a radius of 25 miles from the permanent base at which it is normally kept;
 “single wheels” means wheels which are not dual wheels; and
 “speed category” has the same meaning as in   paragraph 2.29 of Annex II to Community Directive 92/23 orparagraph 2.28  of ECE Regulation 54.
(9A) For the purposes of this regulation, a tyre is a “relevant car tyre” if—
(a) it has been marked with a designated approval mark, and
(b) the first two digits of the approval number comprised in the mark are “02”.
(9B) For the purposes of this regulation, a tyre is a “relevant commercial vehicle tyre” if—
(a) it has been marked with a designated approval mark, and
(b) the first two digits of the approval number comprised in the mark are “00”.
(10) In this regulation any reference to the first use shall, in relation to a trailer, be construed as a reference to the date which is 6 months after the date of manufacture of the trailer.
25A. 

(1) Subject to paragraphs (2) and (3), any replacement tyre (not being a retreaded or part-worn tyre) must be marked with an S mark where it is to be fitted to an axle of—
(a) a passenger vehicle with 4 wheels or more,
(b) a goods vehicle,
(c) a dual-purpose vehicle, or
(d) a trailer constructed or adapted for use with a passenger vehicle, a goods vehicle or a dual-purpose vehicle.
(2) Paragraph (1) applies to—
(a) Class C1d tyres on or after 1st October 2010; and
(b) Class C1e tyres on or after 1st October 2011.
(3) Paragraph (1) does not apply to—
(a) tyres whose speed rating is less than 80 km/h;
(b) tyres whose nominal rim diameter does not exceed 254mm (code 10) or is 635mm (code 25) or more;
(c) T-type temporary-use spare tyres; or
(d) tyres designed only to be fitted to vehicles described in paragraph (1) that were registered for the first time before 1st October 1980.
(4) In this regulation—
 “Class C1d tyre” means a tyre designed for a passenger vehicle with a nominal section width greater than 185mm but less than or equal to 215mm;
 “Class C1e tyre” means a tyre designed for a passenger vehicle with a nominal section width greater than 215mm;
 “nominal rim diameter” has the same meaning as in section 2.18 of Annex II of Community Directive 92/23;
 “part-worn tyre” means a tyre that is not new when fitted;
 “replacement tyre” means—
(a) a Class C1d tyre sold, or intended to be sold, on or after 1st October 2010;
(b) a Class C1e tyre sold, or intended to be sold, on or after 1st October 2011; or
(c) any other tyre sold, or intended to be sold, on or after the date these Regulations come into force,where that tyre replaces, or is intended to replace, a tyre fitted to the axle of any vehicle to which paragraph (1) applies.
 “rim” has the same meaning as in section 2.19 of Annex II of Community Directive 92/23;
 “S mark” means a designated approval mark of a description specified in item 30B of Schedule 2 or item 33 of Schedule 4 of the Approval Marks Regulations including the relevant suffix indicating conformity with the requirements on tyre noise emissions;
 “section width” has the same meaning as in section 2.12 of Annex II of Community Directive 92/23; and
 “T-type temporary-use spare tyre” has the same meaning as in section 2.3.6 of Annex II of Community Directive 92/23, and “temporary-use spare tyre” has the same meaning as in section 2.3.5 if Annex II of Community Directive 92/23.
26 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (5) pneumatic tyres of different types of structure
shall not be fitted to the same axle of a wheeled vehicle.
(2) Save as
provided in paragraphs (3) or (5), a wheeled motor vehicle having only two
axles each of which is equipped with one or two single wheels shall not be
fitted with—
(a) a
diagonal-ply tyre or a bias-belted tyre on its rear axle if a radial-ply tyre
is fitted on its front axle; or
(b) a
diagonal-ply tyre on its rear axle if a bias-belted tyre is fitted on the
front axle.
(3) Paragraph
(2) does not apply to a vehicle to an axle of which there are fitted wide
tyres not specially constructed for use on engineering plant or to a vehicle
which has a maximum speed not exceeding 30 mph.
(4) Save as
provided in paragraph (5) pneumatic tyres fitted to—
(a) the
steerable axles of a wheeled vehicle;  or
(b) the
driven axles of a wheeled vehicle, not being steerable axles,shall all be of the same type of structure.
(5) Paragraphs
(1), (2), and (4) do not prohibit the fitting of a temporary use spare tyre
to a wheel of a passenger vehicle (not being a bus) unless it is driven at
a speed exceeding 50 mph.
(6) In this
regulation—
 “axle” 
includes— 
(i) two or more stub axles which are fitted on opposite
sides of the longitudinal axis of the vehicle so as to form—
(a) a pair in the case of two stub axles; and
(b) pairs in the case of more than two stub axles; and
(ii) a single stub axle which is not one of a pair;
 “a bias-belted tyre”
means a pneumatic tyre, the structure of which is such
that the ply cords extend to the bead so as to be laid at alternate angles
of substantially less than 90 degrees to the peripheral line of the tread,
and are constrained by a circumferential belt comprising two or more layers
of substantially inextensible cord material laid at alternate angles smaller
than those of the ply cord structure;
 “a diagonal-ply tyre”
means a pneumatic tyre, the structure of which is such
that the ply cords extend to the bead so as to be laid at alternate angles
of substantially less than 90 degrees to the peripheral line of the tread,
but not being a bias-belted tyre;
 “a driven axle”
means an axle through which power is transmitted from
the engine of a vehicle to the wheels on that axle;
 “a radial-ply tyre”
means a pneumatic tyre, the structure of which is such
that the ply cords extend to the bead so as to be laid at an angle of substantially
90 degrees to the peripheral line of the tread, the ply cord structure being
stabilised by a substantially inextensible circumferential belt;

 “stub axle” means an axle on which only one wheel is mounted; and
 “type of structure”,
in relation to a tyre, means a type of structure of
a tyre of a kind defined in the foregoing provisions of this paragraph.

27 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraphs (2), (3) and (4), and subject to paragraph (1A), a wheeled motor vehicle or trailer
a wheel of which is fitted with a pneumatic tyre shall not be used on a road,
if—
(a) the
tyre is unsuitable having regard to the use to which the motor vehicle or
trailer is being put or to the types of tyres fitted to its other wheels;

(b) the
tyre is not so inflated as to make it fit for the use to which the motor vehicle
or trailer is being put;
(c) the
tyre has a cut in excess of 25 mm or 10% of the section width of the tyre,
whichever is the greater, measured in any direction on the outside of the
tyre and deep enough to reach the ply or cord;
(d) the
tyre has any lump, bulge or tear caused by separation or partial failure of
its structure;
(e) the
tyre has any of the ply or cord exposed;
(f) the
base of any groove which showed in the original tread pattern of the tyre
is not clearly visible;
(g) either—

(i) 
the grooves of the tread pattern of the tyre do not have a depth of at least
1 mm throughout a continuous band measuring at least three-quarters of the
breadth of the tread and round the entire outer circumference of the tyre;
or
(ii) 
if the grooves of the original tread pattern of the tyre did not extend beyond
three-quarters of the breadth of the tread, any groove which showed in the
original tread pattern does not have a depth of at least 1 mm; ...
(h) the
tyre is not maintained in such condition as to be fit for the use to which
the vehicle or trailer is being put or has a defect which might in any way
cause damage to the surface of the road or damage to persons on or in the
vehicle or to other persons using the road;
(i) the tyre is not a retreaded tyre and—
(i) the week of manufacture marked on its sidewall in accordance with ECE Regulation 30 or 54 falls more than 10 years before the date on which the motor vehicle is used on the road; or
(ii) it does not have a week of manufacture marking which complies with ECE Regulation 30 or 54 (whether because it was manufactured before the ECE Regulations applied or otherwise);
(j) the tyre is a retreaded tyre and—
(i) the week of retreading marked on its sidewall in accordance with ECE Regulation 108 or 109 falls more than 10 years before the date on which the motor vehicle is used on the road; or
(ii) it does not have a week of retreading marking which complies with ECE Regulation 108 or 109 (whether because it was retreaded before the ECE Regulations applied or otherwise); or
(k) a date marked on the tyre sidewall in accordance with ECE Regulation 30, 54, 108 or 109 is illegible.
(1A) Subject to paragraph (4)(a) and (ca), and notwithstanding anything in regulation 25—
(a) paragraph (1)(i) and (j) only applies to tyres fitted—
(i) to a front axle of a bus other than a minibus;
(ii) in single configuration on any axle of a minibus;
(iii) to a front axle of a goods vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 3,500 kg;
(b) in sub-paragraph (a)—
(i) “front axle” means any axle, forward of the mid-point of the chassis on which the wheels are controlled by the steering system;
(ii) “single configuration” means where no more than one wheel and tyre assembly is mounted at the end of the axle concerned;
(c) paragraph (1)(k) only applies to—
(i) buses (including minibuses);
(ii) goods vehicles with a maximum gross weight exceeding 3,500 kg.
(2) Paragraph
(1) does not prohibit the use on a road of a motor vehicle or trailer by reason
only of the fact that a wheel of the vehicle or trailer is fitted with a tyre
which is deflated or not fully inflated and which has any of the defects described
in sub-paragraph (c), 
(d) or (e) of paragraph (1),
if the tyre and the wheel to which it is fitted are so constructed as to make
the tyre in that condition fit for the use to which the motor vehicle or trailer
is being put and the outer sides of the wall of the tyre are so marked as
to enable the tyre to be identified as having been constructed to comply with
the requirements of this paragraph.
(3) Paragraph
(1)(a) does not prohibit the use on a road
of a passenger vehicle (not being a bus) by reason only of the fact that a
wheel of the vehicle is fitted with a temporary use spare tyre, unless the
vehicle is driven at a speed exceeding 50 mph.
(4) 
(a) Nothing
in paragraph (1)(a) to 
(g)and (i) to (k) applies to—
(i) 
an agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor, that is not driven at more than 20 mph;
(ii) 
an agricultural trailer;
(iii) 
an agricultural trailed appliance; ...
(iv) 
a broken down vehicle or a vehicle proceeding to a place where it is to be
broken up, being drawn, in either case, by a motor vehicle at a speed not
exceeding 20 mph; or
(v) a category T tractor that is not driven at more than 40 km/h.
(b) Nothing
in paragraph (1)(f) and 
(g) applies to—
(i) 
a three-wheeled motor cycle the unladen weight of which does not exceed 102
kg and which has a maximum speed of 12 mph; or
(ii) 
a pedestrian-controlled works truck.
(c) Nothing
in paragraph (1)(g) applies to a motorcycle
with an engine capacity which does not exceed 50 cc.
(ca) Nothing in paragraph (1)(i) to (k) applies to a vehicle of historical interest used for non-commercial purposes, and for this purpose “vehicle of historical interest” means a vehicle which is considered to be of historical interest to Great Britain and which—
(i) was manufactured or registered for the first time at least 40 years previously;
(ii) is of a type no longer in production, where “type” in relation to a vehicle has the same meaning as “type of vehicle” in Article 3(32) of Regulation (EU) 2018/858 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 30 May 2018 on the approval and market surveillance of motor vehicles and their trailers, and of systems, components and separate technical units intended for such vehicles; and
(iii) has been historically preserved or maintained in its original state and has not undergone substantial changes in the technical characteristics of its main components.
(d) With effect from 1st January 1992, paragraph 1(f) and (g) shall not apply to the vehicles specified in sub-paragraph (e) of this paragraph but such vehicles shall comply with the requirements specified in sub-paragraph (f) of this paragraph.
(e) The vehicles mentioned in sub-paragraph (d) are–
(i) passenger vehicles other than motor cycles constructed or adapted to carry no more than 8 seated passengers in addition to the driver;
(ii) goods vehicles with a maximum gross weight which  does  not exceed 3500 kg; and
(iii) light trailers not falling within sub-paragraph (ii);
first used on or after 3rd January 1933.
(f) The requirements referred to in sub-paragraph (d) are that the grooves of the tread pattern of every tyre fitted to the wheels of a vehicle mentioned in sub-paragraph (e) shall be of a depth of at least 1.6 mm throughout a continuous band  comprising  the central three-quarters of the breadth of tread and round the entire outer circumference of the tyre.
(5) A recut
pneumatic tyre shall not be fitted to any wheel of a motor vehicle or trailer
if—
(a) its
ply or cord has been cut or exposed by the recutting process; or
(b) it
has been wholly or partially recut in a pattern other than the manufacturer's
recut tread pattern.
(6) 
(a) In
this regulation—
 “breadth of tread”
means the breadth of that part of the tyre which can
contact the road under normal conditions of use measured at 90 degrees to
the peripheral line of the tread;
 “original tread pattern”
 means in the case of— 
 a retreaded tyre, the tread pattern of the tyre immediately
after the tyre was retreaded;
 a wholly recut tyre, the manufacturer's recut tread pattern;

 a partially recut tyre, on that part of the tyre which has
been recut, the manufacturer's recut tread pattern, and on the other part,
the tread pattern of the tyre when new, and
 any other tyre, the tread pattern of the tyre when the tyre
was new.
 “tie-bar”
means any part of a tyre moulded in the tread pattern
of the tyre for the purpose of bracing two or more features of such tread
pattern;
 “tread pattern”
means the combination of plain surfaces and grooves
extending across the breadth of the tread and round the entire outer circumference
of the tyre but excludes any— 
(i) tie bars or tread wear indicators;
(ii) features which are designed to wear out substantially
before the rest of the pattern under normal conditions of use; and
(iii) other minor features; and
 “tread wear indicator”
 means any bar, not being a tie-bar,
projecting from the base of a groove of the tread pattern of a tyre and moulded
between two or more features of the tread pattern of a tyre for the purpose
of indicating the extent of the wear of such tread pattern.
(b) The
references in  this regulation  to grooves
are references—
 if a tyre has been recut, to the grooves of the manufacturer's
recut tread pattern; and
 if a tyre has not been recut, to the grooves which showed
when the tyre was new.
(c) A reference in this regulation to first use shall, in relation to a trailer, be construed as a reference to the date which is 6 months after the date of manufacture of the trailer.
28 

(1) Every
part of every track of a track-laying vehicle which comes into contact with
the road shall be flat and have a width of not less than 12.5 mm.
(2) The area
of the track which is in contact with the road shall not at any time be less
than 225 cm2 in respect of every 1000 kg of the
total weight which is transferred to the road by the tracks.
(3) The tracks
of a vehicle shall not have any defect which might damage the road or cause
danger to any person on or in the vehicle or using the road, and shall be
properly adjusted and maintained in good and efficient working order.
D
29 
All steering gear fitted to a motor vehicle shall at all times
while the vehicle is used on a road be maintained in good and efficient working
order and be properly adjusted.
E
30 

(1) 
Every motor vehicle shall be so designed and constructed that the driver thereof
while controlling the vehicle can at all times have a full view of the road
and traffic ahead of the motor vehicle.
(2) 
Instead of complying with the requirement of paragraph (1) a vehicle may comply
with Community Directive 77/649, 81/643 , 88/366, 90/630  or, in the case of an agricultural
motor vehicle, 79/1073.

(3) 
All glass or other transparent material fitted to a motor vehicle shall be
maintained in such condition that it does not obscure the vision of the driver
while the vehicle is being driven on a road.
31 

(1) 
This regulation applies to a motor vehicle which is—
(a) 
a wheeled vehicle, not being a caravan, first used before 1st June 1978;
(b) 
a caravan first used before 1st September 1978; or
(c) 
a track-laying vehicle.
(2) 
The glass fitted to any window specified in an item in column 3 of the Table
of a vehicle of a class specified in that item in column 2 shall be safety
glass.

TABLE(regulation 31(2))

1 2
 3
Item Class of vehicle 
Windows
1 Wheeled vehicles first used on or after 1st January
1959, being passenger vehicles or dual-purpose vehicles. Wind screens and all outside windows.
2 Wheeled
vehicles first used on or after 1st January 1959, being goods vehicles (other
than dual-purpose vehicles), locomotives or motor tractors. Windscreens and all windows in front of and on either side
of the driver's seat.
3 Wheeled vehicles not mentioned in item 1 or 2. Windscreens and windows facing to the front on the
outside, except glass fitted to the upper decks of a double-decked vehicle.

4 Track-laying vehicles. Windscreens
and windows facing to the front.
(3) 
For the purposes of this regulation any windscreen or window at the front
of the vehicle the inner surface of which is at an angle exceeding 30 degrees
to the longitudinal axis of the vehicle shall be deemed to face to the front.

(4) In this regulation and in regulation 32–
 “caravan” means a trailer which is constructed (and not merely adapted) for human habitation; and
 “designated approval mark” means the marking designated as an approval mark by Regulation 5 of the Approval Marks Regulations and shown at item 31 or 32 in Schedule 4 to those Regulations (those items being markings relating to Community Directive 92/22); and
 “safety glass” means glass so constructed or treated that if fractured it does not fly into fragments likely to cause severe cuts.
(5) Paragraph (2) does not apply to glass which is legibly and permanently marked with a designated approval mark.
32 

(1) 
This regulation applies to—
(a) 
a caravan first used on or after 1st September 1978, and
(b) 
a wheeled motor vehicle and a wheeled trailer, not being a caravan, first
used on or after 1st June 1978.
(2) 
Save as provided in paragraphs (3) to (9) the windows specified in column
2 of Table I in relation to a vehicle of a class specified in that column
shall be constructed of the material specified in column 3 of that Table.


TABLE I(regulation 32(2))

1 2
 3
Item Window Material

1 Windscreens and other windows wholly or partly on
either side of the driver's seat fitted to motor vehicles first used on or
after 1st April 1985. Specified safety
glass (1980).
2 Windscreens and other windows wholly or partly on
either side of the driver's seat fitted to a motor vehicles first used before
1st April 1985. Specified safety glass,
or specified safety glass (1980).

3 All other windows. Specified safety glass, specified safety glass (1980), or
safety glazing.
(3) 
The windscreens and all other windows of security vehicles or vehicles being
used for police purposes shall not be subject to the requirements specified
in paragraph (2), but shall be constructed of either safety glass or safety
glazing.
(4) 
The windscreens of motorcycles not equipped with an enclosed compartment for
the driver or for a passenger shall not be subject to the requirements specified
in paragraph (2), but shall be constructed of safety glazing.
(5) 
Any windscreens or other windows which are wholly or partly in front of or
on either side of the driver's seat, and which are temporarily fitted to motor
vehicles to replace any windscreens or other windows which have broken, shall—

(a) 
be constructed of safety glazing; and
(b) 
be fitted only while the vehicles are being driven or towed either to premises
where new windscreens or other windows are to be permanently fitted to replace
the windscreens or other windows which have broken, or to complete the journey
in the course of which the breakage occurred.
(6) 
Windows forming all or part of a screen or door in the interior of a bus first
used on or after 1st April 1988, shall be constructed either of safety glazing
or of specified safety glass (1980).
(7) 
Windows being—
(a) 
windows (other than windscreens) of motor vehicles being engineering plant,
industrial tractors, agricultural motor vehicles (save as provided in paragraph (7A)) which are wholly or partly in front of or on either side of the driver's
seat;
(b) 
windows of the upper deck of a double-decked bus; or
(c) 
windows in the roof of a vehicle,shall be constructed of either specified safety glass, specified
safety glass (1980) or safety glazing.
(7A) Paragraph (7)(a) does not apply to—
(a) category T tractors first used on or after 1st June 1986 and driven at more than 40 km/h; or
(b) agricultural motor vehicles, not being category T tractors, first used on or after 1st June 1986 and driven at more than 20 mph.
(8) 
In the case of motor vehicles and trailers which have not at any time been
fitted with permanent windows and which are being driven or towed to a place
where permanent windows are to be fitted, any temporary windscreens and any
other temporary windows shall be constructed of either specified safety glass,
specified safety glass (1980) or safety glazing.
(9) 
No requirement in this regulation that a windscreen or other window shall
be constructed of specified safety glass or of specified safety glass (1980)
shall apply to a windscreen or other window which is—
(a) 
manufactured in France;
(b) 
marked with a marking consisting of the letters “TP GS” or “TP
GS E”; and
(c) 
fitted to a vehicle first used before 1st October 1986.
(10) 
Save as provided in paragraph (11), the windscreens or other windows constructed
in accordance with the foregoing provisions of this regulation of specified
safety glass, specified safety glass (1980) or safety glazing and specified
in column 3 of Table II in relation to a vehicle of a class specified in column
2 of that Table shall have a visual transmission for light of not less than
the percentage specified in relation to those windows in column 4 when measured
perpendicular to the surface in accordance with the procedure specified in
a document specified in relation to those windows in column 5.

TABLE II(regulation 32(10))

1 2 3 4 5

Item Class of Vehicles
 Windows Percentage 
Documents specifying procedure
1 Motor vehicles first
used before 1st April 1985 All windows
 70 
British Standard Specification No. 857 or No. 5282
2 
Motor vehicles first used on or after 1st April 1985 and trailers (a) Windscreens
 75 
The documents mentioned in sub-paragraph (i), (ii) or (iii)
of the definition in paragraph (13)
of “specified safety glass (1980).”
  (b) All other
windows 70
(11) 
Paragraph (10) does not apply to—
(a) 
any part of any windscreen which is outside the vision reference zone;
(b) 
windows through which the driver when in the driver's seat is unable at any
time to see any part of the road on which the vehicle is waiting or proceeding;

(c) 
windows in any motor ambulance which are not wholly or partly in front of
or on either side of any part of the driver's seat; or
(d) 
windows in any bus, goods vehicle, locomotive, or motor tractor other than
windows which—
(i) 
are wholly or partly in front of or on either side of any part of the driver's
seat;
(ii) face the rear of the vehicle; or
(iii) form the whole or part of a door giving access to or from the exterior
of the vehicle.
(11A) Paragraphs (10) and (11) have effect in relation to any tint, film or other substance or material applied to a windscreen or window as they have effect in relation to the windscreen or window itself.
(12) 
For the purposes of this regulation any window at the rear of the vehicle
is deemed to face the rear of the vehicle if the inner surface of such window
is at an angle exceeding 30 degrees to the longitudinal axis of the vehicle.

(12A) Paragraphs (2), (6), (7) and (8) do not apply to a window which is legibly and permanently marked with a designated approval mark.
(12B) Paragraph (10) does not apply to a window if—
(a) it is a window to which paragraph 12C applies and is legibly and permanently marked with a designated approval mark which does not comprise the Roman numeral “V” (other than as part of the combination “VI”); or
(b) it is not a window to which paragraph 12C applies and is legibly and permanently marked with a designated approval mark.
(12C) This paragraph applies to a side or rear window if—
(a) any part of it is on either side of or forward of the driver’s seat; or
(b) any part of it is within the driver’s indirect field of view obtained by means of the mirror or mirrors which are required to be fitted by regulation 33 when such mirrors are properly adjusted;
and for the purposes of this paragraph a mirror shall not be regarded as being required to be fitted by regulation 33 if, were it to be removed, the vehicle would nevertheless meet the requirements of regulation 33.
(13) 
In this regulation, unless the context otherwise requires—
 “British Standard Specification
No. 857” means the British Standard
Specification for Safety Glass for Land Transport published on 30th June 1967
under the number BS 857 as amended by Amendment Slip No. 1 published on 15th
January 1973 under the number AMD 1088;
 “British Standard Specification
No. 5282” means the British Standard
Specification for Road Vehicle Safety Glass published in December 1975 under
the number BS 5282 as amended by Amendment Slip No. 1 published on 31st March
1976 under the number AMD 1927, and as amended by Amendment Slip No. 2 published
on 31st January 1977 under the number AMD 2185;
 “British Standard Specification
BS AU 178” means the British Standard
Specification for Road Vehicle Safety Glass published on 28th November 1980
under the number BS AU 178;
 ...
 ...
 “designated approval mark” means—
(a) in relation to a windscreen, the marking designated as an approval mark by regulation 5 of the Approval Marks Regulations and shown at item 31 in Schedule 4 to those Regulations, and
(b) in relation to a window other than a windscreen, the markings designated as approval marks by regulation 5 of those Regulations and shown at item 32 in Schedule 4 to those Regulations.
 “safety glazing”
means material (other than glass) which is so constructed
or treated that if fractured it does not fly into fragments likely to cause
severe cuts;
 “security vehicle”
means a motor vehicle which is constructed (and not
merely adapted) for the carriage of either— 
(i) persons who are likely to require protection
from any criminal offence involving violence; or
(ii) dangerous substances, bullion, money, jewellery,
documents or other goods or burden which, by reason of their nature or value,
are likely to require protection from any criminal offence;
 “specified safety glass”
 means glass complying with the requirements
of either— 
(i) British Standard Specification No. 857 (including
the requirements as to marking); or
(ii) British Standard Specification No. 5282 (including
the requirements as to marking);
 “specified safety glass (1980)”
 means glass complying with the requirements
of either— 
(i) the British Standard Specification for Safety
Glass for Land Transport published on 30th June 1967 under the number BS 857
as amended by Amendment Slip No. 1 published on 15th January 1973 under the
number AMD 1088, Amendment Slip No. 2 published on 30th September 1980 under
the number AMD 3402, and Amendment Slip No. 4 published on 15th February 1981
under the number AMD 3548 (including the requirements as to marking); or
(ii) British Standard Specification BS AU 178 (including
the requirements as to marking); or
(iii) ECE Regulation 43
(including the requirements as to marking).
 “vision reference zone”
 means either— 
(i) the primary vision area as defined in British
Standard Specification No. 857;
(ii) Zone 1, as defined in British Standard Specification
No. 5282;
(iii) Zone B (as regards passenger vehicles other
than buses) and Zone 1 (as regards all other vehicles) as defined in British
Standard Specification BS AU 178 and in ECE Regulation 43;
and
 “windscreen” includes a windshield;
33 

(1) Save as provided in paragraphs (5) to (6H)and (10), a motor vehicle (not being a road roller) which is of a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table shall be fitted with such mirror or mirrors or other device for indirect vision, if any, as are specified in that item in column 3; and any mirror or other device for indirect vision which is fitted to such a vehicle shall, whether or not it is required to be fitted, comply with the requirements, if any, specified in that item in columns 4 and 5.
(2) Save as provided in paragraph (5), each exterior mirror with which a vehicle is required to be fitted in accordance with item 2 or 8 of the Table shall, if the vehicle has a technically permissible maximum weight (as mentioned in Annex 1 to Community Directive 71/127) exceeding 3500 kg, be a Class II mirror (as described in that Annex) and shall in any other case be a Class II or a Class III mirror (as described in that Annex).
(3) Save as provided in paragraph (5), in the case of a wheeled motor vehicle described in item 1, 2, 10 or 11 of the Table which is first used on or after 1st April 1969 the edges of any interior mirror shall be surrounded by some material such as will render it unlikely that severe cuts would be caused if the mirror or that material were struck by any occupant of the vehicle.
(4) Save as provided in paragraph (5), in the case of a motor vehicle falling within paragraph (a) in column 4 of items 1 and 7, or within item 8, of the Table—
(a) each mirror shall be fixed to the vehicle in such a way that it remains steady under normal driving conditions;
(b) each exterior mirror on a vehicle fitted with windows and a windscreen shall be visible to the driver, when in his driving position, through a side window or through the portion of the windscreen which is swept by the windscreen wiper;
(c) where the bottom edge of an exterior mirror is less than 2 m above the road surface when the vehicle is laden, that mirror shall not project more than 20 cm beyond the overall width of the vehicle or, in a case where the vehicle is drawing a trailer which has an overall width greater than that of the drawing vehicle, more than 20 cm beyond the overall width of the trailer;
(d) where the bottom edge of an exterior mirror, which complies with the requirements of Community Directive 2003/97 or 2005/27 or ECE Regulation 46.02, is less than 2 m above the road surface when the vehicle is laden, that mirror shall not project more than 25 cm beyond the overall width of the vehicle or, in the case where the vehicle is drawing a trailer which has an overall width greater than that of the drawing vehicle, more than 25 cm beyond the overall width of the trailer;
(e) each interior mirror shall be capable of being adjusted by the driver when in his driving position; and
(f) except in the case of a mirror which, if knocked out of its alignment, can be returned to its former position without needing to be adjusted, each exterior mirror on the driver’s side of the vehicle shall be capable of being adjusted by the driver when in his driving position, but this requirement shall not prevent such a mirror from being locked into position from the outside of the vehicle.
(5) Instead of complying with paragraphs (1) to (4) a vehicle may comply—
(a) if it is a goods vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 3500 kg first used on or after 1st April 1985 and before 1st August 1989, with Community Directive 79/795, 85/205, 86/562 or 88/321 or ECE Regulation 46.01;
(b) if it is a goods vehicle first used on or after 1st August 1989 and before 26th January 2007—
(i) in the case of a vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 3500 kg but not exceeding 12,000 kg, with Community Directive 79/795, 85/205, 86/562 or 88/321 or ECE Regulation 46.01; and
(ii) in the case of a vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 12,000 kg, with Community Directive 85/205, 86/562 or 88/321 or ECE Regulation 46.01;
(c) if it is an agricultural motor vehicle, with Community Directive 71/127, 74/346, 79/795, 85/205, 86/562 or 88/321 or ECE Regulation 46.01;
(d) if it is a two-wheeled motor cycle with or without a side-car, with Community Directive 71/127, 79/795, 80/780, 85/205, 86/562 or 88/321 or ECE Regulation 46.01; and
(e) if it is any other vehicle, with Community Directive 71/127, 79/795, 85/205, 86/562 or 88/321 or ECE Regulation 46.01.
(6) Instead of complying with the provisions of column 4 in items 3, 4, 7 or 8 of the Table a mirror may comply with the requirements as to construction and testing set out in—
(a) Annex I to Community Directive 71/127, excluding paragraphs 2.3.4 and 2.6;
(b) Annex I to Community Directive 79/795, excluding paragraphs 2.3.3 and 2.6;
(c) Annex II to Community Directive 2003/97, excluding paragraph 3.4; or
(d) Annex II to Community Directive 2005/27, excluding paragraph 3.4.
(6A) The requirements set out in paragraph (1) and the Table are modified as set out in paragraphs (6C) and (6D) in so far as those requirements relate to a relevant vehicle and to the fitting of class IV and class V mirrors on the passenger’s side of that vehicle.
(6B) The alternative requirements set out in paragraph (5) do not apply in so far as those requirements relate to a relevant vehicle and to the fitting of class IV and class V mirrors on the passenger’s side of the vehicle.
(6C) Subject to paragraph (6F), a relevant vehicle which would otherwise be required to meet the requirements set out in item 3 of the Table shall instead meet the requirements set out in item 4 which are applicable to a vehicle of the same maximum gross weight.
(6D) Subject to paragraph (6F), a relevant vehicle which would otherwise be required to meet the requirements set out in item 5 of the Table shall instead meet the requirements set out in item 6.
(6E) For the purposes of paragraphs (6C) and (6D)—
(a) the words “and other devices for indirect vision” are omitted from item 4; and
(b) the words “or other devices for indirect vision” are omitted from items 4 and 6.
(6F) A relevant vehicle does not have to comply with paragraph (6C) or (6D) (whichever is applicable to the vehicle) in the circumstances set out in paragraph (6G) or (6H).
(6G) The first set of circumstances is where the vehicle is equipped in the manner described in article 3(2) of Community Directive 2007/38.
(6H) The second set of circumstances is where the vehicle cannot, for want of available, economically viable, technical solutions—
(a) comply with paragraph (6C) or (6D) (whichever is applicable to the vehicle); or
(b) be equipped in the manner described in article 3(2) of Community Directive 2007/38,
but is equipped in the manner described in article 3(3) of Community Directive 2007/38.
(7) In this regulation—
(a) “devices for indirect vision” mean devices to observe the traffic area adjacent to the vehicle which cannot be observed by direct vision and may include conventional mirrors, camera-monitors or other devices able to present information about the indirect field of vision to the driver;
(b) “mirror” means any device with a reflecting surface, excluding devices such as periscopes, intended to give a clear view to the rear, side or front of the vehicle;
(c) “interior mirror” means a device defined in sub-paragraph (a), which can be fitted in the passenger compartment of a vehicle;
(d) “exterior mirror” means a device defined in sub-paragraph (a), which can be fitted on the external surface of a vehicle;
(e) “class IV” and “class V”, in relation to mirrors, have the meanings given in point 1.1.1.14 of Annex I to Community Directive 2003/97; and
(f) “a relevant vehicle” means a vehicle which—
(i) would be a goods vehicle of a class referred to in column 2 of item 4 or 6 of the Table if “1st January 2000” were substituted for “26th January 2007”; and
(ii) is not outside the scope of Community Directive 2007/38 by virtue of article 2(2)(b) or (c) of that Directive.
(8) In the case of—
(a) an agricultural motor vehicle, or
(b) a vehicle described in items 2 or 8 in the Table,
when drawing a trailer the references to a vehicle in the definitions in paragraph (7) shall be construed as including references to that trailer.
(9) Where a provision is applied by paragraph (6C) or (6D) to a vehicle which was first used on or after 1st January 2000, that provision applies to the vehicle whatever the date of manufacture of the vehicle, and regulation 4(2) is disapplied accordingly.
(10) A vehicle within scope of paragraph (1) will be deemed compliant with the requirements of this regulation if it has a camera-monitor system where the requirements in ECE Regulation 46.04, other than those at paragraphs 13, 14, and 17 to 21 of that Regulation, are met.
(regulation 33(1))
1 2 3 4 5
Item Class of vehicle Mirrors or other devices for indirect vision to be fitted Requirements to be complied with by any mirrors fitted Requirements to be complied with by any other devices for indirect vision where fitted
1 A motor vehicle which is—
(a) drawing a trailer, if a person is carried on the trailer so that he has an uninterrupted view to the rear and has an efficient means of communicating to the driver the effect of signals given by the drivers of other vehicles to the rear;
(b) 
(i) a works truck;
(ii) a track-laying agricultural motor vehicle; and
(iii) a wheeled agricultural motor vehicle first used before 1st June 1978, if, in each case, the driver can easily obtain a view to the rear;
(c) a pedestrian-controlled vehicle;
(d) a chassis being driven from the place where it has been manufactured to the place where it is to receive a vehicle body; or
(e) an agricultural motor vehicle which has an unladen weight exceeding 7370 kg and which—
(i) is a track-laying vehicle or
(ii) is a wheeled vehicle first used before 1st June 1978. No requirement. 
(a) If the vehicle is a wheeled vehicle first used on or after 1st June 1978, Item 2 of Annex I to Community Directive 71/127 or 79/795 or Annex II to Community Directive 86/562 or 88/321 or paragraphs 4 to 8 of ECE Regulation 46.01 and paragraph (4) of this regulation.
(b) In other cases, none, except as specified in paragraph (3). None
2. A motor vehicle not included in item 1, which is—
(a) a wheeled locomotive or a wheeled motor tractor first used in either case on or after 1st June 1978;
(b) an agricultural motor vehicle, not being—
(i) a track laying vehicle with an unladen weight not exceeding 7370 kg (which falls in item 11);
(ii) a category T tractor first used after 1st June 1986 which is driven at more than 40 km/h (which falls in item 8);
(iii) a wheeled agricultural vehicle, other than a category T tractor, first used after 1st June 1986 which is driven at more than 20 mph (which falls in item 8); or
(c) a works truck. At least one exterior mirror fitted on the offside. None, except as specified in paragraphs (2) and (3). None.
3. A wheeled motor vehicle not included in items 1 or 4 first used on or after 1st April 1983 which is—
(a) a bus; or
(b) a goods vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 3500 kg (not being an agricultural motor vehicle or one which is not driven at more than 20 mph) other than a vehicle described in item 5. Mirrors complying with item 3 of Annex I to Community Directive 79/795 or with paragraph 2.1 of Annex III to Community Directive 86/562 or 88/321 or paragraph 16.2.1 of ECE Regulation 46.01 or, except in the case of a goods vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1985, mirrors as required in the entry in this column in item 8. Item 2 of Annex I to Community Directive 71/127 or 79/795 or Annex II to Community Directive 86/562 or 88/321 or paragraphs 4 to 8 of ECE Regulation 46.01. None.
4. 
A wheeled motor vehicle not included in item 1 first used on or after 26th January 2007 which is—

(a) a bus;
(b) a goods vehicle with a maximum gross weight—
(i) exceeding 3500 kg but not exceeding 7500 kg; or
(ii) exceeding 7500 kg but not exceeding 12,000 kg;(not being an agricultural motor vehicle or one which is not driven at more than 20 mph). (a) and (b)(ii) Mirrors and other devices for indirect vision complying with Annex III to Community Directive 2003/97 or 2005/27 or paragraph 15 of ECE Regulation 46.02.(b)(i) Mirrors or
other devices for
indirect vision
complying with
Community
Directive 2005/27. Paragraph 6 of Annex I and Annex II to Community Directive 2003/97 or 2005/27 or paragraphs 4, 5 and 6.1 of ECE Regulation 46.02. Part B of Annex II to Community Directive 2003/97 or paragraph 4, 5 and 6.2 of ECE Regulation 46.02.
5. A goods vehicle not being an agricultural motor vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 12,000 kg which is first used on or after 1st October 1988 and before 26th January 2007. Mirrors complying with paragraph 2.1 of Annex III to Community Directive 86/562 or 88/321 or paragraph 16.2.1 of ECE Regulation 46.01. Annex II to Community Directive 86/562 or 88/321 or paragraphs 4 to 8 of ECE Regulation 46.01. None
6. A goods vehicle not being an agricultural motor vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 12,000 kg which is first used on or after 26th January 2007. Mirrors or other devices for indirect vision complying with Annex III to Community Directive 2003/97 or 2005/27 or paragraph 15 of ECE Regulation 46.02. Paragraph 6 of Annex I and Annex II to Community Directive 2003/97 or 2005/27 or paragraphs 4, 5 and 6.1 of ECE Regulation 46.02. Part B of Annex II to Community Directive 2003/97 or paragraph 4, 5 and 6.2 of ECE Regulation 46.02.
7. A two-wheeled motor cycle with or without a sidecar attached. No requirement. 
(a) If the vehicle is first used on or after 1st October 1978, Item 2 of Annex I to Community Directive 71/127, 79/795 or 80/780 or Annex II to Community Directive 86/562 or 88/321 or paragraphs 4 to 8 of ECE Regulation 46.01 and paragraph (4) of this regulation.
(b) In other cases, none. None.
8. A wheeled motor vehicle not in items 1 to 7, which is first used on or after 1st June 1978 (or, in the case of a Ford Transit motor car, 10th July 1978) and before 26th January 2010. 
(i) At least one exterior mirror fitted on the offside of the vehicle; and
(ii) at least one interior mirror, unless a mirror so fitted would give the driver no view to the rear of the vehicle; and
(iii) at least one exterior mirror fitted on the nearside of the vehicle unless an interior mirror gives the driver an adequate view to the rear. Item 2 of Annex I to Community Directive 71/127 or 79/795 or Annex II to Community Directive 86/562 or 88/321 or paragraphs 4 to 8 of ECE Regulation 46.01 and paragraphs (2) and (4) of this regulation. None.
9. A wheeled motor vehicle not in items 1 to 7, which is first used on or after 26th January 2010. Mirrors complying with Annex III to Community Directive 2003/97 or 2005/27 or paragraph 15 of ECE Regulation 46.02. Paragraph 6 of Annex I and Annex II to Community Directive 2003/97 or 2005/27 or paragraphs 4, 5 and 6.1 of ECE Regulation 46.02. If fitted to comply with Part B of Annex II to Community Directive 2003/97 or paragraphs 4, 5 and 6.2 of ECE Regulation 46.02.
10. A wheeled motor vehicle, not in items 1 to 7, first used before 1st June 1978 (or in the case of a Ford Transit motor car, 10th July 1978) and a track-laying motor vehicle which is not an agricultural motor vehicle first used on or after 1st January 1958, which in either case is—
(a) a bus;
(b) a dual-purpose vehicle; or
(c) a goods vehicle. At least one exterior mirror fitted on the offside of the vehicle and either one interior mirror or one exterior mirror fitted on the near-side of the vehicle. None, except as specified in paragraph (3). None.
11. A motor vehicle, whether wheeled or track-laying, not in items 1 to 10. At least one interior or exterior mirror. None, except as specified in paragraph (3). None.
34 

(1) 
Subject to paragraphs (4) and (5), every vehicle fitted with a windscreen
shall, unless the driver can obtain an adequate view to the front of the vehicle
without looking through the windscreen, be fitted with one or more efficient
automatic windscreen wipers capable of clearing the windscreen so that the
driver has an adequate view of the road in front of both sides of the vehicle
and to the front of the vehicle.
(2) 
Save as provided in paragraphs (3), (4) and (5), every wheeled vehicle required
by paragraph (1) to be fitted with a wiper or wipers shall also be fitted
with a windscreen washer capable of cleaning, in conjunction with the windscreen
wiper, the area of the windscreen swept by the wiper of mud or similar deposit.

(3) 
The requirement specified in paragraph (2) does not apply in respect of—

(a) an agricultural motor vehicle, not being a category T tractor, unless it is first used on or after 1st June 1986 and is driven at more than 20 mph;
(aa) a category T tractor unless it is first used on or after 1st June 1986 and is driven at more than 40 km/h;
(b) 
a track-laying vehicle;
(c) 
a vehicle having a maximum speed not exceeding 20 mph; or
(d) 
a vehicle being used to provide a local service, as defined in the Transport Act 1985.

(4) 
Instead of complying with paragraphs (1) and (2), a vehicle may comply with Community Directive 78/318.
(5) 
Instead of complying with paragraph (1) an agricultural motor vehicle may
comply with Community Directive 79/1073.

(6) 
Every wiper and washer fitted in accordance with this regulation shall at
all times while a vehicle is being used on a road be maintained in efficient
working order and be properly adjusted.
F
35 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraphs (2) and (3), every motor vehicle shall be fitted with
a speedometer which, if the vehicle is first used on or after 1st April 1984,
shall be capable of indicating speed in both miles per hour and kilometres
per hour, either simultaneously or, by the operation of a switch, separately.

(2) Paragraph
(1) does not apply to—
(a) a
vehicle having a maximum speed not exceeding 25 mph;
(b) a
vehicle which it is at all times unlawful to drive at more than 25 mph;
(c) an
agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor, which is not driven at more than 20 mph;
(ca) a category T tractor which is not driven at more than 40 km/h;
(d) a
motor cycle first used before 1st April 1984 the engine of which has a cylinder
capacity not exceeding 100 cc;
(e) an
invalid carriage first used before 1st April 1984;
(f) a
works truck first used before 1st April 1984;
(g) a
vehicle first used before 1st October 1937; or
(h) a
vehicle equipped with recording equipment marked with a marking designated
as an approval mark by regulation 5
of the Approval Marks Regulations and shown at item 3 in Schedule 4
to those Regulations (whether or not the vehicle is required to be equipped
with that equipment) and which, as regards the visual indications given by
that equipment of the speed of the vehicle, complies with the requirements
relating to the said indications and installations specified in the EU Tachographs Regulation.
(3) Instead
of complying with paragraph (1) a vehicle may comply with  Community Directive 97/39  or
with ECE Regulation 39.

36 

(1) Every
instrument for indicating speed fitted to a motor vehicle—
(a) in
compliance with the requirements of regulation 35(1)
or (3);
or
(b) to
which regulation 35(2)(h)
relates and which is not, under the EU Tachographs Regulation,
required to be equipped with the recording equipment mentioned in that paragraph,
shall be kept free from any obstruction which might prevent its
being easily read and shall at all material times be maintained in good working
order.
(2) In this
regulation “all material times” means all times when the motor vehicle is in use on a road except when— 
(a) the vehicle
is being used on a journey during which, as a result of a defect, the instrument
ceased to be in good working order; or
(b) 
as a result of a defect, the instrument has ceased to be in good working order
and steps have been taken to have the vehicle equipped with all reasonable
expedition, by means of repairs or replacement, with an instrument which is
in good working order.
36A 

(1) Subject to paragraph (13), this regulation applies to every coach which—
(a) was first used on or after 1st April 1974 and before 1st January 1988; and
(b) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a maximum speed exceeding  112.65 km/h; and a reference to this regulation to a paragraph (1) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(2) Subject to paragraph (13), this regulation also applies to every bus which—
(a) is first used on or after 1st January 1988;
(b) has a maximum gross weight exceeding 7.5 tonnes; and
(c) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a maximum speed exceeding  100 km/h; and a reference in this regulation to a paragraph (2) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(2A) Subject to paragraph (13), this regulation also applies to every bus, not being a bus to which paragraph (2) applies, which—
(a) is first used on or after 1st January 2005;
(b) has a maximum gross weight exceeding 5 tonnes but not exceeding 10 tonnes; and
(c) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a maximum speed exceeding 100 km/h;
and a reference in this regulation to a paragraph (2A) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(2B) Subject to paragraph (13), this regulation also applies to every bus which—
(a) is first used on or after 1st January 2005;
(b) has a maximum gross weight not exceeding 5 tonnes; and
(c) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a maximum speed exceeding 100 km/h;
and a reference in this regulation to a paragraph (2B) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(2C) Subject to paragraph (13), this regulation also applies to every bus, not being a bus to which paragraph (2) applies, which—
(a) was first used on or after 1st October 2001 and before 1st January 2005;
(b) complies with the limit values in respect of Euro III emission standards set out in Council Directive 88/77/EEC, as amended by amendments up to and including those effected by Commission Directive 2001/27/EC;
(c) has a maximum gross weight not exceeding 10 tonnes; and
(d) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a maximum speed exceeding 100 km/h;
and a reference in this regulation to a paragraph (2C) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(2D) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(2E) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(4) Every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be fitted with a speed limiter in respect of which such of the requirements of paragraphs (5) to (9) are met as apply to that speed limiter.
(5) Subject to paragraph (10), the requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter fitted to any vehicle must—
(a) be sealed by an authorised sealer in such a manner as to protect the limiter against any improper interference or adjustment and against any interruption of its power supply; and
(b) be maintained in good and efficient working order.
(6) The requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter fitted to a paragraph (1) vehicle must be calibrated to a set speed not exceeding  112.65 km/h.
(7) Subject to paragraph (7A), the requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter fitted to a paragraph (2) vehicle, a paragraph (2A) vehicle, a paragraph (2B) vehicle or a paragraph 2(C) vehicle, must be set so that the speed of the vehicle cannot exceed 100 km/h.
(7A) A speed limiter fitted to a paragraph (2) vehicle which—
(a) was first used before 1st January 2005 and has a maximum gross weight exceeding 10 tonnes; or
(b) was first used before 1st October 2001 and has a maximum gross weight exceeding 7.5 tonnes but not exceeding 10 tonnes;
may be set at a maximum speed of 100 km/h.
(8) Subject to paragraphs (11) and (12), the requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter fitted at any time to any paragraph (1) vehicle or a speed limiter fitted before 1st October 1994 to a paragraph (2) vehicle first used before that date must comply with—
(a) Part 1 of the British Standard; or
(b) the Annexes to Community Directive 92/24 as amended by Directive 2004/11/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council.
(9) The requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter (not being a speed limiter to which paragraph (8) applies) fitted to a paragraph (2) vehicle , a paragraph (2A) vehicle, a paragraph (2B) vehicle and a paragraph (2C) vehicle must comply with the Annexes to Community Directive 92/24 as amended by Directive 2004/11/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council.
(9A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(10) Paragraph (5)(a) shall have effect in relation to—
(a) a speed limiter fitted before 1st August 1992 to a vehicle first used before that date; or
(b) a speed limiter sealed outside the United Kingdom, as if the words “by an authorised sealer” were omitted.
(11) Paragraph (8) does not apply to a speed limiter fitted before 1st October 1988.
(12) Paragraph (8) does not apply to a speed limiter fitted to a vehicle if the speed limiter complies with an equivalent standard.
(13) This regulation does not apply to a vehicle—
(a) being taken to a place where a speed limiter is to be installed, calibrated, repaired or replaced; ...
(b) completing a journey in the course of which the speed limiter has accidentally ceased to function;
(c) which is owned by the Secretary of State for Defence and used for naval, military or air force purposes;
(d) which is used for naval, military or air force purposes while being driven by a person for the time being subject to the orders of a member of the armed forces of the Crown; ...
(e) while it is being used for fire and rescue authority purposes or for or in connection with the exercise of any function of the Scottish Fire and Rescue Service, for ambulance purposes or police purposes; or
(f) which is operated by or on behalf of Her Majesty’s Prison Service and used primarily for the purpose of moving Category A prisoners.
(14) In this regulation
 “authorised sealer” has the meaning given in Schedule 3B; 
 “Category A prisoners” means that prison security category which is applied to prisoners whose escape would be highly dangerous to the public or the police or to the security of the state, no matter how unlikely that escape might be, and for whom the aim must be to make escape impossible;
 “equivalent standard” means—
(a) a standard or code of practice of a national standards body or equivalent body of any member State;
(b) any international standard recognised for use as a standard by any member State; or
(c) a technical specification or code of practice which, whether mandatory or not, is recognised for use as a standard by a public authority of any member State, where the standard, code of practice, international standard or technical specification provides, in relation to speed limiters, a level of speed control equivalent to that provided by Part 1 of the British Standard;
 “Euro III emission standards” means the emission limits given in rows A of the tables in section 6.2.1 of Annex 1 to Directive 1999/96/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council (amending Council Directive 88/77/EEC);
 “international transport operations” means transport operations outside the United Kingdom;
 “national transport operations” means transport operations within the United Kingdom;
 “Part 1 of the British Standard” means the British Standard for Maximum Road Speed Limiters for Motor Vehicles which was published by the British Standards Institution under the number BS AU 217: Part 1: 1987 and which came into effect on 29th May 1987; as amended by Amendment Slip No.1 under the number AMD 5969 which was published and came into effect on 30th June 1988; 
 “set speed”, in relation to a calibrated speed limiter fitted to a vehicle, means the speed intended by the person who calibrated the speed limiter to be the mean speed of the vehicle when operating in a stabilised condition;
  “speed limiter” means a device designed to limit the maximum speed of a motor vehicle by controlling the power output from the engine of the vehicle
 ...
 “transport operations” means the transportation of passengers in vehicles designed for such a purpose and to which this regulation applies.
36B 

(1) Subject to paragraph (14), this regulation applies to every motor vehicle , not being a motor vehicle to which paragraph (1B) applies, which—
(a) is a goods vehicle;
(b) has a maximum gross weight exceeding 7,500 kg but not exceeding 12,000 kg;
(c) is first used on or after 1st August 1992 and before 1st January 2005; and
(d) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a relevant speed exceeding 60 mph; and a reference in this regulation to a paragraph (1) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(1A) Subject to paragraph (14), this regulation also applies to every motor vehicle which—
(a) is a goods vehicle;
(b) has a maximum gross weight exceeding 3,500 kg but not exceeding 12,000 kg;
(c) is first used on or after 1st January 2005; and
(d) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a relevant speed exceeding 90 km/h;
and a reference in this regulation to a paragraph (1A) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(1B) Subject to paragraph (14), this regulation also applies to every motor vehicle, ... which—
(a) is a goods vehicle;
(b) has a maximum gross weight exceeding 3,500 kg but not exceeding 12,000 kg;
(c) was first used on or after 1st October 2001 and before 1st January 2005;
(d) complies with the limit values in respect of Euro III emission standards set out in Council Directive 88/77/EEC, as amended by amendments up to and including those effected by Commission Directive 2001/27/EC; and
(e) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a relevant speed exceeding 90km/h;
and a reference in this regulation to a paragraph (1B) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(1C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(1D) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(2) Subject to paragraph (14), this regulation also applies to every vehicle which—
(a) is a goods vehicle;
(b) has a maximum gross weight exceeding 12,000 kg;
(c) is first used on or after 1st January 1988; and
(d) has, or if a speed limiter were not fitted to it would have, a relevant speed exceeding 90 km/h; and a reference in this regulation to a paragraph (2) vehicle is a reference to a vehicle to which this regulation applies by virtue of this paragraph.
(3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(6) Every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be fitted with a speed limiter in respect of which such of the requirements of paragraphs (7) to (11) are met as apply to that speed limiter.
(7) Subject to paragraph (12), the requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter fitted to any vehicle must—
(a) be sealed by an authorised sealer in such a manner as to protect the limiter against any improper interference or adjustment or against any interruption of its power supply; and
(b) be maintained in good and efficient working order.
(8) The requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter fitted to a paragraph (1) vehicle ... must be calibrated to a set speed not exceeding 60 mph.
(9) ... the requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter fitted to a paragraph (1A) vehicle, a paragraph (1B) vehicle or a paragraph (2) vehicle must be set so that the stabilised speed of the vehicle must not exceed 90 km/h.
(10) Subject to paragraph (13), the requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter fitted at any time to a paragraph (1) vehicle, a speed limiter fitted before 1st October 1994 to a paragraph (2) vehicle first used before that date ... must comply with—
(a) Part 1 of the British Standard; or
(b) the Annexes to Community Directive 92/24 as amended by Directive 2004/11/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council.
(11) The requirements of this paragraph are that a speed limiter (not being a speed limiter to which paragraph (10) applies) fitted to a paragraph (1A) vehicle, a paragraph (1B) vehicle and a paragraph (2) vehicle must comply with the Annexes to Community Directive 92/24 as amended by Directive 2004/11/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council.
(11A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(12) Paragraph (7)(a) shall have effect in relation to—
(a) a speed limiter fitted before 1st August 1992 to a vehicle first used before that date; or
(b) a speed limiter sealed outside the United Kingdom, as if the words “by an authorised sealer” were omitted.
(12A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(13) Paragraph (10) does not apply to a speed limiter fitted to a vehicle if the speed limiter complies with an equivalent standard. 
(14) This regulation does not apply to a vehicle—
(a) which is being taken to a place where a speed limiter is to be installed, calibrated, repaired or replaced;
(b) which is completing a journey in the course of which the speed limiter has accidentally ceased to function;
(c) is owned by the Secretary of State for Defence and used for naval, military or air force purposes;
(d) is used for naval, military or air force purposes while being driven by a person for the time being subject to the orders of a member of the armed forces of the Crown;
(e) while it is being used for fire brigadeScottish Fire and Rescue Serviceor, in England or Wales, fire and rescue authorityor, in England, fire and rescue authority, ambulance or police purposes; ...
(f) at a time when it is being used on a public road during any calendar week if—
(i) it is being used only in passing from land in the occupation of the person keeping the vehicle to other land in his occupation, and
(ii) it has not been used on public roads for distances exceeding an aggregate of six miles in that calendar week,
and for the purposes of this paragraph “public road” has the meaning given in section 62(1) the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994; or
(g) which is an emergency tactical response vehicle operated by or on behalf of Her Majesty’s Prison Service and used primarily for the purpose of transporting people or equipment (or both) to restore order within Her Majesty’s prisons or immigration detention centres.
(15) In this regulation 
 “equivalent standard”, “Part 1 of the British Standard”, ... “speed limiter” and “stabilised speed” have the same meanings as in regulation 36A; 
 “Euro III emission standards” means the emission limits given in rows A of the tables in section 6.2.1 of Annex 1 to Directive 1999/96/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council (amending Council Directive 88/77/EEC);
 “international transport operations” means transport operations outside the United Kingdom;
 “national transport operations” means transport operations within the United Kingdom;
 ... “relevant speed” means a speed which a vehicle is incapable, by means of its construction, of exceeding on the level under its own power when unladen 
 “set speed”, in relation to a paragraph (1) vehicle, has the same meaning as in regulation 36A; and 
 ... “set” in relation to a speed limiter fitted to a paragraph (1A) vehicle, a paragraph (1B) vehicle and a paragraph (2) vehicle, has the same meaning as in Community Directive 92/6; and references to the speed at which a speed limiter is set shall be construed accordingly;
 “transport operations” means the transportation of goods in vehicles designed for such a purpose and to which this regulation applies.
(16) For the purposes of this regulation, a motor vehicle has a maximum gross trailer weight exceeding 5,000 kg if—
(a) in the case of a vehicle equipped with a Ministry plate in accordance with regulation 70, the difference between its maximum gross weight and the relevant train weight exceeds 5,000 kg;
(b) in the case of a vehicle not equipped with a Ministry plate, but which is equipped with a plate in accordance with regulation 66, the difference between its maximum gross weight and the weight shown on the plate in respect of item 8 of Part I of Schedule 8 exceeds 5,000 kg; and
(c) in the case of any other vehicle, the vehicle is designed or adapted to be capable of drawing a trailer with a laden weight exceeding 5,000 kg when travelling on a road; and in sub-paragraph (a) “the relevant train weight” is the train weight shown in column (3) of the plate or, if no such weight is shown, the train weight shown in column (2) of the plate (where the plate is in the form required by  Schedule 10 or 10B) or in column (4) of the plate (where the plate is in the form required by  Schedule 10A or 10C).
36C 
Schedule 3B (authorised sealers) shall have effect.
37 

(1) 
(a) Subject
to sub-paragraph (b), every motor vehicle
which has a maximum speed of more than 20 mph shall be fitted with a horn,
not being a reversing alarm or a two-tone horn.
(b) Sub-paragraph (a) shall not apply to an agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor,
unless it is being driven at more than 20 mph.
(c) Sub-paragraph (a) shall not apply to a category T tractor unless it is being driven at more than 40 km/h.
(2) Subject
to paragraph (6), the sound emitted by any horn, other than a reversing alarm
or a two-tone horn, fitted to a wheeled vehicle first used on or after 1st
August 1973 shall be continuous and uniform and not strident.
(3) A reversing
alarm fitted to a wheeled vehicle shall not be strident.
(4) Subject
to paragraphs (5), (6) and (7) no motor vehicle shall be fitted with a bell,
gong, siren or two-tone horn.
(5) The provisions
of paragraph (4) shall not apply to motor vehicles—
(a) used
for fire brigadeScottish Fire and Rescue Serviceor, in England or Wales, fire and rescue authorityor, in England, fire and rescue authority... or police purposes;
(aza) used for ambulance purposes or for the purpose of providing a response to an emergency at the request of an NHS ambulance service;
(aa) as regards England and Wales, and so far as relating to the functions of the Serious Organised Crime Agency which are exercisable in or as regards Scotland and which relate to reserved matters (within the meaning of the Scotland Act 1998), used for Serious Organised Crime Agency purposes;
(ab) so far as relating to the functions of the Serious Organised Crime Agency which are exercisable in or as regards Scotland and which do not (within the meaning of the Scotland Act 1998) relate to reserved matters, used for Serious Organised Crime Agency purposes;
(b) owned
by a body formed primarily for the purposes of fire salvage and used for those
or similar purposes;
(c) owned
by the Forestry Commission or by local authorities and used from time to time
for the purposes of fighting fires;
(ca) owned by the Scottish Ministers for the purposes of their functions under the Forestry and Land Management (Scotland) Act 2018 and used from time to time for the purposes of fighting fires,
(d) owned
by the Secretary of State for Defence and used for the purposes of the disposal
of bombs or explosives;
(e) used
for the purposes of the Blood Transfusion Service provided under the National Health Service Act 1977
 or under the National Health Service (Scotland) Act 1947;

(f) used
by Her Majesty's Coastguard or the Coastguard Auxiliary Service to aid persons
in danger or vessels in distress on or near the coast;
(g) used for the purposes of rescue operations at mines;
(h) owned
by the Secretary of State for Defence and used by the Royal Air Force Mountain
Rescue Service for the purposes of rescue operations in connection with crashed
aircraft or any other emergencies; ...
(i) owned
by the Royal National Lifeboat Institution and used for the purposes of launching
lifeboats;
(j) a vehicle under the lawful control of the Commissioners for Her Majesty’s Revenue and Customs and used from time to time for the purposes of investigation of serious crime (which, save for the omission of the words “and, where the authorising officer is within subsection (5)(h), it relates to an assigned matter within the meaning of section 1(1) of the Customs and Excise Management Act 1979”, has the meaning given by section 93(4) of the Police Act 1997); ...
(k) owned or operated by the Secretary of State for Defence and used—
(i) for the purpose of any activity—(aa) which prevents or decreases the exposure of persons to radiation arising from a ... radiation emergency; or(bb) in connection with an event which could lead to a ... radiation emergency; or
(ii) for special forces purposes; or
(l) used for mountain rescue purposes.
(6) The provisions
of paragraphs (2) and (4) shall not apply so as to make it unlawful for a
motor vehicle to be fitted with an instrument or apparatus (not being a two-tone
horn) designed to emit a sound for the purpose of informing members of the
public that goods are on the vehicle for sale.
(7) Subject
to paragraph (8), the provisions of paragraph (4) shall not apply so as to
make it unlawful for a vehicle to be fitted with a bell, gong or siren—

(a) if
the purpose thereof is to prevent theft or attempted theft of the vehicle
or its contents; or
(b) in
the case of a bus, if the purpose thereof is to summon help for the driver,
the conductor or an inspector.
(8) Every
bell, gong or siren fitted to a vehicle by virtue of paragraph (7)(a), and every device fitted to a motor vehicle first
used on or after 1st October 1982 so as to cause a horn to sound for the purpose
mentioned in paragraph (7)(a), shall be
fitted with a device designed to stop the bell, gong, siren or horn emitting
noise for a continuous period of more than five minutes; and every such device
shall at all times be maintained in good working order.
(9) Instead
of complying with paragraphs (1), (2) and (4) to (8), a vehicle may comply
with Community Directive 70/388
or ECE Regulation 28
or, if the vehicle is an agricultural motor vehicle, with Community Directive 74/151.
(9A) In this regulation—
 “radiation emergency” has the same meaning as in the Radiation (Emergency Preparedness and Public Information) Regulations 2019;
 “special forces” means those units of the home forces the maintenance of whose capabilities is the responsibility of the Director of Special Forces or which are for the time being subject to the operational command of that Director; and
 “special forces purposes” means, in relation to the use of a vehicle, the use of a vehicle by the special forces in response, or for training or practice in responding, to a national security emergency.
(10) In this
regulation and in regulation 99—

(a) “horn”
means an instrument, not being a bell, gong or siren,
capable of giving audible and sufficient warning of the approach or position
of the vehicle to which it is fitted;
(b) 
references to a bell, gong or siren include references to any instrument or
apparatus capable of emitting a sound similar to that emitted by a bell, gong
or siren;
(c) “reversing
alarm” means a device fitted to
a motor vehicle and designed to warn persons that the vehicle is reversing
or is about to reverse; and
(d) “two-tone horn”
 means an instrument which, when operated,
automatically produces a sound which alternates at regular intervals between
two fixed notes.
38 

(1) No motor
cycle first used on or after 1st April 1986 shall be fitted with any sidestand
which is capable of—
(a) disturbing
the stability or direction of the motor cycle when it is in motion under its
own power; or
(b) closing
automatically if the angle of the inclination of the motor cycle is inadvertently
altered when it is stationary.
(2) In this
regulation 
“sidestand” means a device
fitted to a motor cycle which, when fully extended or pivoted to its open
position, supports the vehicle from one side only and so that both the wheels
of the motor cycle are on the ground.
G
39 

(1) This regulation applies to every fuel tank which is fitted to a wheeled vehicle for the purpose of supplying fuel to the propulsion unit or to an ancillary engine or to any other equipment forming part of the vehicle.
(2) Subject to paragraphs (3) , (3A)  and (4), every fuel tank to which this regulation applies—
(a) shall be constructed and maintained so that the leakage of any liquid from the tank is adequately prevented;
(b) shall be constructed and maintained so that the leakage of vapour from the tank is adequately prevented; and
(c) if it contains petroleum spirit (as defined in section 23 of the Petroleum (Consolidation) Act 1928) and is fitted to a vehicle first used on or after 1st July 1973, shall be—
(i) made only of metal; and
(ii) fixed in such a position and so maintained as to be reasonably secure from damage.
(3) Notwithstanding the requirement of paragraph (2)(b), the fuel tank may be fitted with a device which, by the intake of air or the emission of vapour, relieves changes of pressure in the tank.
(3A) Sub-paragraph (i) of paragraph 2(c) shall not have effect in relation to a two-wheeled motor cycle (with or without a side-car) first used on or after 1st February 1993.
(4) Instead
of complying with the requirements of  paragraphs (2) and (3)  as to construction, a
vehicle may comply with the requirements of Community Directive 70/221
(insofar as they relate to fuel tanks) or ECE Regulation 34
or 34.01 or, if
the vehicle is an agricultural motor vehicle, of Community Directive 74/151.

39A 

(1) Every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be designed and constructed for running on unleaded petrol.
(2) No person shall use or cause or permit to be used a vehicle to which this regulation applies on a road if it —
(a) has been deliberately altered or adjusted for running on leaded petrol, and
(b) as a direct result of such alteration or adjustment it is incapable of running on unleaded petrol.
(3) Subject to paragraph (4) this regulation applies to every motor vehicle which is —
(a) propelled by a spark ignition engine which is capable of running on petrol, and
(b) is first used on or after the 1st April 1991.
(4) Part I of Schedule 3A shall have effect for the purpose of excluding certain vehicles first used before specified dates from the application of this regulation.
(5) In this regulation “petrol”, “leaded petrol” and “unleaded petrol” have the same meaning as in Community Directive 85/210.
(6) A vehicle shall be regarded for the purposes of this regulation as incapable of running on unleaded petrol at any particular time if and only if in its state of adjustment at that time prolonged continuous running on such petrol would damage the engine.
39B 

(1) Subject to paragraph (2), every fuel tank fitted to a vehicle to which regulation 39A applies shall be so constructed and fitted that it cannot readily be filled from a petrol pump delivery nozzle which has an external diameter of 23.6mm or greater without the aid of a device (such as a funnel) not fitted to the vehicle.
(2) Paragraph (1) does not apply to a vehicle in respect of which both of the following conditions are satisfied, that is to say —
(a) that at the time of its first use the vehicle is so designed and constructed that prolonged continuous running on leaded petrol would not cause any device designed to control the emission of carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons or nitrogen oxides to malfunction, and
(b) that it is conspicuously and legibly marked in a position immediately visible to a person filling the fuel tank with —
(i) the word “UNLEADED”, or
(ii) the symbol shown in Part II of Schedule 3A.
(3) In this regulation “fuel tank”, in relation to a vehicle, means a fuel tank used in connection with the propulsion of the vehicle.
40 

(1) A vehicle
which is—
(a) a
motor vehicle which first used gas as a fuel for its propulsion before 19th
November 1982; or
(b) a
trailer manufactured before 19th November 1982 to which there is fitted a
gas container,shall be so constructed that it complies either with the provisions
of Schedule 4 or
with the provisions of Schedule 5.

(2) Subject to paragraph (2A), a vehicle which is—
(a) a
motor vehicle which first used liquefied petroleum gas as a fuel for its propulsion on or after
19th November 1982; or
(b) a
motor vehicle first used on or after 1st May 1984 or a trailer manufactured
on or after 19th November 1982 which is in either case equipped with a gas
container or a gas-fired appliance,shall comply with the provisions of Schedule 5 or with ECE Regulation 67 or 67.01.

(2A) A vehicle which first used liquefied petroleum gas as a fuel for its propulsion on or after 13th November 1999 shall comply with the provisions of Schedule 5 or ECE Regulation 67.01.
(3) The requirements
of this regulation are in addition to, and not in derogation from, the requirements
of any regulations made under powers conferred by the petroleum (Consolidation) Act 1928,
the Health and Safety at Work etc.
Act 1974, the Control of Pollution Act 1974
or any other Act or of any codes of practice issued under the Health and Safety at Work etc. Act 1974.

(4) In this
regulation “gas container” 
has the meaning given in Schedule 4
where compliance with the provisions of that Schedule is concerned and otherwise
has the meaning given in Schedule 5.

H
41 
The requirements specified in Schedule 6
shall apply to every minibus first used on or after 1st April 1988 except
a vehicle—
(a) manufactured
by Land Rover U.K. Limited and known as the Land Rover; or
(b) constructed
or adapted for the secure transport of prisoners.
41A. 

(1) A minibus which is required by regulation 41 to meet the requirements specified in Schedule 6 need not meet them if it meets the requirements of such of the Annexes to Directive 2001/85/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council of 20 November 2001, relating to special provisions for vehicles used for the carriage of passengers comprising more than eight seats in addition to the driver’s seat, and amending Directives 70/156/EEC and 97/27/EC, as apply to that minibus.
(2) A minibus which is required by regulation 41 to meet the requirements specified in Schedule 6 need not meet the requirements set out in items 2 to 4 and 7 to 12 of that Schedule if it meets such requirements of ECE Regulation 52.01 or 107.01 or 107.02 as apply to that minibus.
42 

(1) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a minibus first used on
or after 1st April 1988 unless it carries suitable and efficient apparatus
for extinguishing fire which is of a type specified in Part I of Schedule 7.
(2) The apparatus
referred to in paragraph (1) above shall be—
(a) readily
available for use;
(b) clearly
marked with the appropriate British Standards Institution specification number;
and
(c) maintained
in good and efficient working order.
(3) This regulation
does not apply to a vehicle manufactured by Land Rover U.K. Limited and known
as the Land Rover.
43 

(1) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a minibus first used on
or after 1st April 1988 unless it carries a receptacle which contains the
items specified in Part II of Schedule 7.

(2) The receptacle
referred to in paragraph (1) above shall be—
(a) maintained
in a good condition;
(b) suitable
for the purpose of keeping the items referred to in the said paragraph in
good condition;
(c) readily
available for use; and
(d) prominently
marked as a first aid receptacle.
(3) The items
referred to in paragraph (1) above shall be maintained in good condition and
shall be of a good and reliable quality and of a suitable design.
(4) This regulation
does not apply to a vehicle manufactured by Land Rover U.K. Limited and known
as the Land Rover.
44 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), no person shall use or cause or permit to be used
on a road a minibus by which any highly inflammable or otherwise dangerous
substance is carried unless that substance is carried in containers so designed
and constructed, and unless the substance is so packed, that, notwithstanding
an accident to the vehicle, it is unlikely that damage to the vehicle or injury
to passengers in the vehicle will be caused by the substance.
(2) Paragraph
(1) shall not apply in relation to the electrolyte of a battery installed
in an electric wheelchair provided that the wheelchair is securely fixed to
the vehicle.
(3) This regulation
does not apply to a vehicle manufactured by Land Rover U.K. Limited and known
as the Land Rover.
I
45 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J
46 

(1) This regulation applies to a motor vehicle which is not an excepted vehicle and is—
(a) a bus first used on or after 1st April 1982;
(b) a wheeled motor car first used on or after 1st January 1965;
(c) a three-wheeled motor cycle which has an unladen weight exceeding 255 kg and which was first used on or after 1st September 1970; or
(d) a heavy motor car first used on or after 1st October 1988.
(2) Each of the following is an excepted vehicle—
(a) a goods vehicle (other than a dual-purpose vehicle)—
(i) first used before 1st April 1967;
(ii) first used on or after 1st April 1980 and before 1st October 1988 and having a maximum gross weight exceeding 3500 kg; or
(iii) first used before 1st April 1980 or, if the vehicle is of a model manufactured before 1st October 1979, first used before 1st April 1982 and, in either case, having an unladen weight exceeding 1525 kg;
(b) an agricultural motor vehicle;
(c) a motor tractor;
(d) a works truck;
(e) an electrically propelled goods vehicle first used before 1st October 1988;
(f) a pedestrian-controlled vehicle;
(g) a vehicle which has been used on roads outside Great Britain, whilst it is being driven from the place at which it arrived in Great Britain to a place of residence of the owner or driver of the vehicle, or from any such place to a place where, by previous arrangement, it will be provided with such anchorage points as are required by this regulation and with such seat belts as are required by regulation 47;
(h) a vehicle having a maximum speed not exceeding 16 mph;
(i) a motor cycle equipped with a driver’s seat of a type requiring the driver to sit astride it, and which is constructed or assembled by a person not ordinarily engaged in the trade or business of manufacturing vehicles of that description;
(j) a locomotive.
(3) A vehicle which falls within a description specified in column (2) of an item in the Table below shall be equipped with anchorage points for seat belts for the use of persons sitting in the seats specified in column (3) of that item and those anchorage points (“mandatory anchorage points”) shall comply with the requirements specified in column (4).

TABLE
(1) (2) (3) (4)
Item Description of vehicle Seats for which mandatory anchorage points are to be provided Technical and installation requirements
1. Any vehicle first used before 1st April 1982 The driver’s seat and specified passenger seat (if any) Anchorage points must be designed to hold seat belts securely in position on the vehicle
2. Minibus constructed or adapted to carry not more than 12 seated passengers in addition to the driver, motor ambulance or motor caravan which, in any such case, was first used on or after 1st April 1982 but before 1st October 1988 The driver’s seat and specified passenger seat (if any) The technical and installation (but not the testing) requirements of Community Directive 76/115, 81/575, 82/318, 90/629 or 96/38 or ECE Regulation 14, 14.01, 14.02, 14.03, 14.04 or 14.05 whether or not those instruments apply to the vehicle
3. Minibus (not being a vehicle falling within item 7 or 8) having a gross weight not exceeding 3500 kg, motor ambulance or motor caravan which, in any such case, was first used on or after 1st October 1988 The driver’s seat and each forward-facing front seat The requirements specified in column (4) of item 2
4. Goods vehicle first used on or after 1st October 1988 but before 1st October 2001 and having a maximum gross weight exceeding 3500 kg The driver’s seat and each forward-facing front seat 2 or 3 anchorage points designed to hold seat belts securely in position
5. Goods vehicle first used on or after 1st October 2001 and having a maximum gross weight exceeding 3500 kg All forward-facing front seats The technical and installation requirements of Community Directive 96/38 or ECE Regulation 14.04 or 14.05
6. Coach first used on or after 1st October 1988 but before 1st October 2001 All exposed forward-facing seats The requirements specified in column (4) of item 2 or, if the anchorage points were fitted before 1st October 2001 and form part of a seat, a requirement that they do not, when a forward horizontal force is applied to them, become detached from the seat before the seat becomes detached from the vehicle
7. Bus (other than an urban bus) having a gross vehicle weight exceeding 3500 kg and first used on or after 1st October 2001 Anchorage points for every forward-facing and every rearward-facing seat The requirements specified in column (4) of item 5
8. Bus (other than an urban bus) having a gross vehicle weight not exceeding 3500 kg and first used on or after 1st October 2001 Every forward-facing and every rearward-facing seat The requirements specified in column (4) of item 5
9. Passenger or dual-purpose vehicle (other than a bus) first used on or after 1st April 1982 and not falling within any of items 2 to 8 Every forward-facing seat constructed or adapted to accommodate no more than one adult The requirements specified in column (4) of item 2
10. Vehicle (other than a bus) first used on or after 1st April 1982 and not falling within any of items 2 to 9 Every forward-facing front seat and every non-protected seat The requirements specified in column (4) of item 2
(4) Any anchorage fitted after 1st October 2001 to a bus not falling within item 7 or 8 of the Table in paragraph (3) must comply with the technical and installation (but not the testing) requirements of Community Directive 76/115, 81/575, 82/318, 90/629 or 96/38 or ECE Regulation 14, 14.01, 14.02, 14.03, 14.04 or 14.05 whether or not those instruments apply to the vehicle.
(5) Subject to paragraph (6), where a vehicle to which this regulation applies and which falls within a class specified in an item of the Table in paragraph (3) is fitted with non-mandatory anchorage points, those anchorage points shall comply with the requirements applicable to the mandatory anchorage points specified for that item.
(6) Paragraph (5) does not apply to non-mandatory anchorage points fitted to—
(a) a minibus before 1st April 1986; or
(b) any other vehicle before 1st October 1988.
(7) For the purposes of this regulation—
(a) the expressions “exposed forward-facing seat”, “forward-facing front seat”, “lap belt”, “seat belt” and “specified passenger’s seat” have the same meaning as in regulation 47(8);
(b) “mandatory anchorage points” has the meaning given in paragraph (3) and “non-mandatory anchorage points” means anchorage points which are not mandatory anchorage points;
(c) a seat is a “non-protected seat” if it is not a front seat and the screen zones within the protected area have a combined surface of less than 800 cm2;
(d) “screen zone” and “protected area” in relation to a seat shall be construed in accordance with paragraph 4.3.3 of Annex I to Community Directive 81/575; and
(e) “urban bus” means a bus designed for urban use with standing passengers and includes a vehicle which is—
(i) a Class I vehicle as defined by paragraph 2.1.2.1.3.1.1 of Annex I of Community Directive 97/27/EC;
(ii) a Class II vehicle as defined by paragraph 2.1.2.1.3.1.2 of that Annex; or
(iii) a Class A vehicle as defined by paragraph 2.1.2.1.3.2.1 of that Annex.
(8) A vehicle which is not required by this regulation to comply with the technical and installation requirements of Community Directive 76/115, 81/575, 82/318, 90/629 or 96/38 or ECE Regulation 14, 14.01, 14.02, 14.03, 14.04 or 14.05 shall nevertheless be taken to comply with the provisions of this regulation if it does comply with those requirements.
47 

(1) This regulation
applies to every vehicle to which regulation 46
applies.
(2) Save as
provided in paragraph (4) a vehicle to which—
(a) this
regulation applies which was first used before 1st April 1981 shall be provided
with—
(i) 
a body-restraining ... belt, designed for use by an adult, for the driver's
seat; and
(ii) 
a body-restraining ... belt for the specified passenger's seat (if any);

(b) this
regulation applies which is first used on or after 1st April 1981 shall be
provided with three-point ... belts for the driver's seat and for the specified
passenger's seat (if any);
(c) item 9 or 10 of the Table in regulation 46(3) applies
which is first used on or after 1st April 1987 shall be fitted with seat belts
additional to those required by sub-paragraph (b)
 as follows—
(i) 
for any forward-facing front seat alongside the driver's seat, not being a
specified passenger's seat, a seat belt which is a three-point belt, or a
lap belt installed in accordance with paragraph 3.1.2.1 of Annex 1
to Community
Directive 77/541 or a disabled person's belt;

(ii) 
in the case of a passenger or dual-purpose vehicle having not more than two
forward-facing seats behind the driver's seat with either—(A) 
an inertia reel belt for at least one of those seats, or(B) 
a three-point belt, a lap belt, a disabled person's belt or a child restraint
for each of those seats;
(iii) 
in the case of a passenger or dual-purpose vehicle having more than two forward-facing
seats behind the driver's seat, with either—(A) 
an inertia reel belt for one of those seats being an outboard seat and a three-point
belt, a lap belt, a disabled person's belt or a child restraint for at least
one other of those seats;(B) 
a three-point belt for one of those seats and either a child restraint or
a disabled person's belt for at least one other of those seats; or(C) 
a three-point belt, a lap belt, a disabled person's belt or a child restraint
for each of those seats.
(d) item 3 of the Table in regulation 46(3) applies shall be fitted with seat belts as follows—
(i) for the driver’s seat and the specified passenger’s seat (if any) a three-point belt; and
(ii) for any forward-facing front seat which is not a specified passenger’s seat, a three-point belt or a lap belt installed in accordance with the provisions of sub-paragraph (c)(i);
(e) item 4 of the Table in regulation 46(3) applies shall be equipped with seat belts which shall be three-point belts, lap belts or disabled person’s belts; 
(f) item 5 of the Table in regulation 46(3) applies shall be fitted—
(i) as respects the driver’s seat with a three-point belt or a lap belt; and
(ii) as respects every other forward-facing front seat with a three-point belt, a lap belt installed in accordance with paragraph 3.1.2.1 of Annex I to Community Directive 77/541 or a disabled person’s belt;
(g) item 7 of the Table in regulation 46(3) applies shall be fitted, as respects every forward-facing seat, with—
(i) an inertia reel belt;
(ii) a retractable lap belt installed in compliance with paragraph 3.1.10 of Annex I to Community Directive 96/36 or 2000/3;
(iii) a disabled person’s belt; or
(iv) a child restraint;
(h) item 7 of the Table in regulation 46(3) applies shall be fitted, as respects every rearward-facing seat, with—
(i) an inertia reel belt;
(ii) a retractable lap belt;
(iii) a disabled person’s belt; or
(iv) a child restraint;
(i) item 8 of the Table in regulation 46(3), as respects every forward-facing seat, with—
(i) an inertia reel belt;
(ii) a disabled person’s belt; or
(iii) a child restraint;
(j) item 8 of the Table in regulation 46(3), as respects every rearward-facing seat, with—
(i) an inertia reel belt;
(ii) a retractable lap belt;
(iii) a disabled person’s belt; or
(iv) a child restraint.
Where a lap belt is fitted to a forward-facing front seat of a minibus, a motor ambulance or a motor caravan, or to an exposed forward-facing seat  (other than the driver’s seat or any crew seat) of a coach either—
(i) there shall be provided padding to a depth of not less than 50mm, on that part of the surface or edge of any bar, or the top or edge of any screen or partition, which would be likely to be struck by the head of a passenger wearing the lap belt in the event of an accident; or
(ii) the technical and installation requirements of Annex 4 to ECE Regulation 21 shall be met, in respect of any such bar, screen or partition,but nothing in sub-paragraph (i) above shall require padding to be provided on any surface more than 1m from the centre of the line of intersection of the seat cushion and the back rest or more than 150mm on either side of the longitudinal vertical plane which passes through the centre of that line, nor shall it require padding to be provided on any instrument panel of a minibus.
(3) Every
seat belt for an adult, other than a disabled person's belt, provided for
a vehicle in accordance with  any of paragraphs (2)(b) to (j)  shall, except as provided in paragraph
(6), comply with the installation requirements specified in 
paragraph 3.2.2 to 3.3.4 of Annex I to Community Directive 77/541  , 82/319, 90/628, 96/36 or 2000/3   
whether or not  those Directives apply  to the vehicle.
(4) The requirements
specified in paragraph (2) do not apply—
(a) to
a vehicle while it is being used under a trade licence within the meaning
of section 11 of the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994;
(b) to
a vehicle, not being a vehicle to which the Type Approval (Great Britain)
Regulations apply, while it is being driven from premises of the manufacturer
by whom it was made, or of a distributor of vehicles or dealer in vehicles—

(i) 
to premises of a distributor of or dealer in vehicles or of the purchaser
of the vehicle, or
(ii) 
to premises of a person obtaining possession of the vehicle under a hiring
agreement or hire-purchase agreement;
(c) in
relation to any seat for which there is provided—
(i) 
a seat belt which bears a mark including the specification number of the British
Standard for Passive Belt Systems, namely BS AU 183:1983 and including the
registered certification trade mark of the British Standards Institution;
...
(ii) 
a seat belt designed for use by an adult which is a harness belt comprising
a lap belt and shoulder straps which bears a British Standard mark or a mark
including the specification number for the British Standard for Seat Belt
Assemblies for Motor Vehicles, namely BS 3254:1960 or  BS 3254: Part 1: 1988   and including the registered
certification trade mark of the British Standards Institution, or  the marking designated as an approval mark by regulation 4 of the Approval Marks Regulations and shown at item 16 ot 16A in Schedule 2 to those Regulations;
(iii) a seat belt which satisfies the requirements of a standard corresponding to the British Standard referred to in sub-paragraph (i); or
(iv) a seat belt designed for use by an adult which is a harness belt comprising a lap belt and shoulder straps and which satisfies the requirements of a standard corresponding to any of the British Standards referred to in sub-paragraph (ii).
(d) in
relation to the driver's seat or the specified passenger's seat (if any) of
a vehicle which has been specially designed and constructed, or specially
adapted, for the use of a person suffering from some physical defect or disability,
in a case where a disabled person's belt for an adult person is provided for
use for that seat.
(e) to a vehicle to which item 4 of the Table in regulation 46(3) applies.
(4A) Vehicles constructed or adapted for the secure transport of prisoners shall not be required to comply with the requirements of paragraph (2) in relation to seats for persons other than the driver and any front seat passenger provided that those seats shall have seat belt anchorage points provided for them in accordance with regulation 46.
(5) Every
seat belt provided in pursuance of paragraph (2) shall be properly secured
to the anchorage points provided for it in accordance with regulation 46; or, in the case
of a child restraint, to anchorages specially provided for it or, in the case
of a disabled person's belt first fitted before 1st October 2001, secured to the vehicle or to the seat which is
being occupied by the person wearing the belt.
(6) Paragraph
(3), in so far as it relates to the second paragraph of paragraph 3.3.2 of the Annex there
mentioned (which concerns the locking or releasing of a seat belt by a single
movement) does not apply in respect of a seat belt fitted for—
(a) a
seat which is treated as a specified passenger's seat by virtue of the provisions
of sub-paragraph (ii) in the definition of “specified passenger's seat”
in paragraph (8); or
(b) any
forward-facing seat for a passenger alongside the driver's seat of a goods
vehicle which has an unladen weight of more than 915 kg and has more than
one such seat, any such seats for passengers being joined together in a single
structure.
(c) any seat (other than the driver’s seat) fitted to a coach.
(7) Every
seat belt, other than a disabled person's belt or a seat belt of a kind mentioned
in paragraph  (4)(c)  above, provided
for any person in a vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be legibly
and permanently marked—
(a) ... with a British Standard mark or a designated approval mark ; or
(b) with an EC Component Type-Approval Mark complying with Annex III to Community Directive 2000/3.Provided this
paragraph shall not operate so as to invalidate the exception permitted in
paragraph (6).
(7A) Paragraph (7) does not apply to—
(a) a seat belt for an adult ... that satisfies the requirements of a standard corresponding to either of the British Standards referred to in sub-paragraph (i)(a) of the definition of “British Standard mark” in paragraph (8); or
(b) a child restraint that satisfies the requirements of a standard corresponding to any of the British Standards referred to in sub-paragraph (i)(b) of that definition.
(7B) For the purposes of this regulation a reference to a standard corresponding to a specified British Standard is a reference to—
(a) a standard or code of practice of a national standards body or equivalent body of any EEA State;
(b) any international standard recognised for use as a standard by any EEA State; or
(c) a technical specification recognised for use as a standard by a public authority of any EEA State,
where the standard, code of practice, international standard or technical specification provides in relation to seat belts, a level of safety equivalent to that provided by the British Standard and contains a requirement as respects the marking of seat belts equivalent to that provided by the British Standard.
(7C) For the purposes of paragraph (7B)—
(a) “EEA State” means a State which is a contracting Party to the EEA Agreement but, until the EEA Agreement comes into force in relation to Liechtenstein, does not include the state of Liechtenstein; and
(b) “EEA Agreement” means the Agreement on the European Economic Area signed at Oporto on 2nd May 1992 as adjusted by the Protocol signed at Brussels on 17th March 1993.
(8) In this
regulation—
 “body-restraining ... belt”
 means a seat belt designed to provide
restraint for both the upper and lower parts of the trunk of the wearer in
the event of an accident to the vehicle;
 “British Standard mark”
 means a mark consisting of— 
(i) the specification number of one of the following British Standards
for Seat Belt Assemblies for Motor Vehicles, namely—
(a) if it is a seat belt for an adult, BS
3254; 1960    or BS 3254: Part 1: 1988; or
(b) if it is a child restraint, BS 3254:1960 or BS 3254: 1960 as amended by Amendment No. 16 published on 31st July 1986 under the number AMD 5210,
 BS 3254: Part 2: 1988or BS 3254: Part 2: 1991, BS AU 185, BS AU 186 or 186a, BS AU 202  , BS AU 202a or BS AU 202b; and, in either
case,
(ii) the registered certification trade mark of
the British Standards Institution;
 “child restraint”
means a seat belt for the use of a young person which
is designed either to be fitted directly to a suitable anchorage or to be
used in conjunction with a seat belt for an adult and held in place by the
restraining action of that belt:  Provided that for the purposes of paragraph (2)
(c)(ii)(B) and (2)(c)(iii) it
means only such seat belts fitted directly to a suitable anchorage and excludes
belts marked with the specification numbers BS AU 185 and BS AU 186 or 186a.

 “crew seat” has the same meaning as in regulation 3(1) of the Public Service Vehicles (Conditions of Fitness, Equipment, Use and Certification) Regulations 1981;
 “designated approval mark”
 means
(a) if it is a seat belt other than a child restraint,
the marking designated as an approval mark by regulation 4
of the Approval Marks Regulations and shown at  items 16 and 16A  of Schedule 2
to those Regulations or the marking designated as an approval mark by regulation 5 of those Regulations
and shown at item 23 , 23A and 23B  in Schedule 4
to those Regulations, and
(b) if it is a child restraint,  any  of the markings
designated as approval marks by regulation 4
of those Regulations and shown at  items 44, 44A , 44B and 44C     in Schedule 2
to those Regulations.
 “disabled person's belt”
 means a seat belt which has been specially
designed or adapted for use by an adult or young person suffering from some
physical defect or disability and which is intended for use solely by such
a person;
 “exposed forward-facing seat” means—
(i) a forward-facing front seat (including any crew seat) and the driver’s seat; and
(ii) any other forward-facing seat which is not immediately behind and on the same horizontal plane as a forward-facing high-backed seat;
 “forward-facing front seat” means—
(i) any forward-facing seat alongside the driver’s seat; or
(ii) if the vehicle normally has no seat which is a forward-facing front seat under sub-paragraph (i) of this definition, each forward-facing seat for a passenger which is foremost in the vehicle;
 “forward-facing seat”
means a seat which is attached to a vehicle so that
it faces towards the front of the vehicle in such a manner that a line passing
through the centre of both the front and the back of the seat is at an angle
of 30° or less to the longitudinal axis of the vehicle;
 “forward-facing high-backed seat” means a forward-facing seat which is also a high-backed seat;
 “high-backed seat” means a seat the highest part of which is at least 1 metre above the deck of the vehicle.
 “inertia reel belt”
means a three-point belt of either of the types required
for a front outboard seating position by paragraph 3.1.1. of Annex 1
to Community
Directive 77/541;
 “lap belt” means a seat belt which passes across the front of the wearer's pelvic
regionand which is designed for use by an adult;
 “retractable lap belt” means a lap belt with either an automatically locking retractor (as defined in paragraph 1.8.3 of Annex I to Community Directive 77/541) or an emergency locking retractor (as defined in paragraph 1.8.4 of Annex I to Community Directive 77/541);
 “seat” 
includes any part designed for the accommodation of one adult of a continuous
seat designed for the accommodation of more than one adult;
 “seat belt” means a belt intended to be worn by a person in a vehicle and designed
to prevent or lessen injury to its wearer in the event of an accident to the
vehicle and includes, in the case of a child restraint, any special chair
to which the belt is attached;
 “specified passenger's seat”
 means— 
(i) in the case of a vehicle which has one forward-facing
front seat alongside the driver's seat, that seat, and in the case of a vehicle
which has more than one such seat, the one furthest from the driver's seat;
or
(ii) if the vehicle normally has no seat which
is the specified passenger's seat under sub-paragraph (i) of this definition
the forward-facing front seat for a passenger which is foremost in the vehicle
and furthest from the driver's seat, unless there is a fixed partition separating
that seat from the space in front of it alongside the driver's seat; and
 “three-point belt”
means a seat belt which— 
(i) restrains the upper and lower parts of the
torso;
(ii) includes a lap belt;
(iii) is anchored at not less than three points; and
(iv) is designed for use by an adult.
48 

(1) This regulation
applies to every seat belt with which a motor vehicle is required to be provided
in accordance with regulation 47
and to the anchorages, fastenings, adjusting device and retracting mechanism
(if any) of every such seat belt and also to every anchorage with which a goods vehicle is required to be provided in accordance with regulation 46(3) and item 4 in the Table in that regulation.
(2) For the
purposes of this regulation the anchorages and anchorage points of a seat
belt shall, in the case of a seat which incorporates integral seat belt anchorages,
include the system by which the seat assembly itself is secured to the vehicle
structure.
(3) The anchorage
points provided for seat belts shall be used only as anchorages for the seat
belts for which they are intended to be used or capable of being used.
(4) Save as
provided in paragraph (5) below—
(a) all
load-bearing members of the vehicle structure or panelling within 30 cms of
each anchorage point shall be maintained in a sound condition and free from
serious corrosion, distortion or fracture;
(b) the
adjusting device and (if fitted) the retracting mechanism of the seat belt
shall be so maintained that the belt may be readily adjusted to the body of
the wearer, either automatically or manually, according to the design of the
device and (if fitted) the retracting mechanism;
(c) the
seat belt and its anchorages, fastenings and adjusting device shall be maintained
free from any obvious defect which would be likely to affect adversely the
performance by the seat belt of the function of restraining the body of the
wearer in the event of an accident to the vehicle;
(d) the
buckle or other fastening of the seat belt shall—
(i) 
be so maintained that the belt can be readily fastened or unfastened;
(ii) 
be kept free from any temporary or permanent obstruction; and
(iii) 
except in the case of a disabled person's seat belt, be readily accessible
to a person sitting in the seat for which the seat belt is provided;
(e) the
webbing or other material which forms the seat belt shall be maintained free
from cuts or other visible faults (as, for example, extensive fraying) which
would be likely to affect adversely the performance of the belt when under
stress;
(f) the
ends of every seat belt, other than a disabled person's seat belt, shall be
securely fastened to the anchorage points provided for them; and
(g) the
ends of every disabled person's seat belt shall, when the seat belt is being
used for the purpose for which it was designed and constructed, be securely
fastened either to some part of the structure of the vehicle or to the seat
which is being occupied by the person wearing the belt so that the body of
the person wearing the belt would be restrained in the event of an accident
to the vehicle.
(5) No requirement
specified in paragraph (4) above applies if the vehicle is being used—

(a) on
a journey after the start of which the requirement ceased to be complied with;
or
(b) after
the requirement ceased to be complied with and steps have been taken for such
compliance to be restored with all reasonable expedition.
(6) Expressions
which are used in this regulation and are defined in regulation 47 have the same meaning
in this regulation as they have in regulation 47.

48A 

(1) No person shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road a coach or minibus wholly or mainly for the purpose of carrying a group of 3 or more children in the following circumstances unless the appropriate number of forward-facing passenger seats fitted to the vehicle meet the requirements of this regulation.
(2) The circumstances are that—
(a) the group of children are on an organised trip; and
(b) the journey is being made for the purposes of the trip.
(3) In paragraph (1), the reference to the appropriate number is a reference to the number of children being carried in the vehicle (excluding disabled children in wheelchairs).
(3A) For the purposes of this regulation a rearward-facing seat shall be treated as a forward-facing seat which meets the requirements of this regulation if the coach or minibus concerned was first used on or after 1st October 2001, and the rearward-facing seat complies with the requirements of regulations 46 and 47.
(4) Without prejudice to the generality of paragraph (2)(a), a group of children shall, for the purposes of this regulation, be regarded as being on an organised trip if they are being carried to or from their school or from one part of their school premises to another.
(5) Without prejudice to the meaning of paragraph (2)(b), paragraph (1) shall not apply to a vehicle if it is being used in the provision of a bus service of a description specified in paragraph 2 of the Schedule to the Fuel Duty Grant (Eligible Bus Services) Regulations 1985 or if it is otherwise being used wholly or mainly for the purpose of providing a transport service for the general public.
(6) For a forward-facing passenger seat to meet the requirements of this regulation a seat belt must be provided for it, and —
(a) if paragraph (3) of regulation 47 does not (in whole or part) apply to the seat belt and the seat belt was first fitted to the vehicle after 10th February 1997, the seat belt must comply with that paragraph to the extent (if any) that it would have to so comply were—
(i) that regulation to apply to all motor vehicles, and
(ii) there substituted for the words “provided” to “or (e)”, in that paragraph, the words “provided for any person in a vehicle to which this regulation applies”;
(b) if paragraph (5) of regulation 47 does not apply to the seat belt and the seat belt is a seat belt for an adult (not being a disabled person’s belt) that was first fitted to the vehicle after 10th February 1997, the seat belt must comply with the requirements specified in paragraph (7) below;
(c) if paragraph (5) of regulation 47 does not apply to the seat belt and the seat belt is a child restraint that was first fitted to the vehicle after 10th February 1997, the seat belt must be properly secured to anchorages provided for it;
(d) if paragraph (5) of regulation 47 does not apply to the seat belt and the seat belt is a disabled person’s belt that was first fitted to the vehicle after 10th February 1997, the seat belt must be properly secured to the vehicle or to the seat;
(e) if regulation 47 does not apply to the vehicle and the seat belt was first fitted to the vehicle after 10th February 1997, the seat belt must comply with paragraph (7) of that regulation to the extent (if any) that it would have to so comply were that regulation to apply to all motor vehicles; and
(f) if regulation 48 does not apply to the seat belt and the seat belt was first fitted to the vehicle after 10th February 1997, the requirements of paragraph (4) of that regulation must be met in relation to the anchorages, fastenings, adjusting device and retracting mechanism (if any) of the seat belt to the extent (if any) that those requirements would have to be met were that paragraph to apply to all anchorages, fastenings, adjusting devices and retracting mechanisms of seat belts fitted to motor vehicles,
and paragraph (2) of regulation 48 shall apply for the purposes of sub-paragraph (f) above as it applies for the purposes of that regulation.
(7) The requirements referred to in paragraph (6)(b) are that the seat belt must be properly secured to the anchorage points provided for it and, in a case where any of those anchorage points is first fitted to the vehicle after 10th February 1997 the anchorage points to which it is secured must comply—
(a) if the vehicle is a coach, with the requirements specified in regulation 46(4)(b) or (4A)(b)(ii); or
(b) in any other case, with the requirements specified in regulation 46(4)(b).
(8) Until 10th February 1998, this regulation shall not apply to a coach first used before 1st October 1988.
(9) In this regulation—
 “school” has the meaning given by section 14(5) of the Further and Higher Education Act 1992;
 “forward-facing passenger seat” means a forward-facing seat which is not the driver’s seat; and
 “child restraint”, “disabled person’s belt”, “forward-facing seat”, “seat”, and “seat belt” have the meanings given in regulation 47.
(10) For the purpose of this regulation, a child is a person who is aged 3 years or more but is under the age of 16 years.
49 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), this regulation applies to a wheeled goods vehicle
being either—
(a) a
motor vehicle with a maximum gross weight which exceeds 3500 kg and which
was first used on or after 1st April 1984; or
(b) a
trailer manufactured on or after 1st May 1983 with an unladen weight which
exceeds 1020 kg.
(2) This regulation
does not apply to—
(a) a
motor vehicle which has a maximum speed not exceeding 15 mph;
(b) a
motor car or a heavy motor car constructed or adapted to form part of an articulated
vehicle;
(c) an
agricultural trailer;
(d) engineering
plant;
(e) a
fire engine;
(f) an
agricultural motor vehicle;
(g) a
vehicle fitted at the rear with apparatus specially designed for spreading
material on a road;
(h) a
vehicle so constructed that it can be unloaded by part of the vehicle being
tipped rearwards;
(i) a
vehicle owned by the Secretary of State for Defence and used for naval, military
or air force purposes;
(j) a
vehicle to which no bodywork has been fitted and which is being driven or
towed—
(i) 
for the purpose of a quality or safety check by its manufacturer or a dealer
in, or distributor of, such vehicles; or
(ii) 
to a place where, by previous arrangement, bodywork is to be fitted or work
preparatory to the fitting of bodywork is to be carried out; or
(iii) 
by previous arrangement to premises of a dealer in, or distributor of, such
vehicles;
(k) a
vehicle which is being driven or towed to a place where by previous arrangement
a device is to be fitted so that it complies with this regulation;
(l) a
vehicle specially designed and constructed, and not merely adapted, to carry
other vehicles loaded onto it from the rear;
(m) a
trailer specially designed and constructed, and not merely adapted, to carry
round timber, beams or girders, being items of exceptional length;
(n) a
vehicle fitted with a tail lift so constructed that the lift platform forms
part of the floor of the vehicle and this part has a length of at least 1
m measured parallel to the longitudinal axis of the vehicle;
(o) a
trailer having a base or centre in a country outside Great Britain from which
it normally starts its journeys, provided that a period of not more than 12
months has elapsed since the vehicle was last brought into Great Britain;

(p) a
vehicle specially designed, and not merely adapted, for the carriage and mixing
of liquid concrete;
(q) a
vehicle designed and used solely for the delivery of coal by means of a special
conveyor which is carried on the vehicle and when in use is fitted to the
rear of the vehicle so as to render its being equipped with a rear under-run
protective device impracticable; or
(r) an
agricultural trailed appliance.
(3) Subject
to the provisions of paragraphs (4), (5) and (6), every vehicle to which this
regulation applies shall be equipped with a rear under-run protective device.

(4) A vehicle
to which this regulation applies and which is fitted with a tail lift, bodywork
or other part which renders its being equipped with a rear under-run protective
device impracticable shall instead be equipped with one or more devices which
do not protrude beyond the overall width of the vehicle (excluding any part
of the device or the devices) and which comply with the following requirements—

(a) where
more than one device is fitted, not more than 50 cm shall lie between one
device and the device next to it;
(b) not
more than 30 cm shall lie between the outermost end of a device nearest to
the outermost part of the vehicle to which it is fitted and a longitudinal
plane passing through the outer end of the rear axle of the vehicle on the
same side of the vehicle or, in a case where the vehicle is fitted with more
than one rear axle, through the outer end of the widest rear axle on the same
side of the vehicle, and paragraph II.5.4.2 in the Annex
 to Community Directive 79/490 shall
not have effect in a case where this requirement is met; and
(c) the
device or, where more than one device is fitted, all the devices together,
shall have the characteristics specified in paragraphs  II.5.4.1  to II.5.4.5.5.2
in the Annex to the said Directive save—

(i) 
as provided in sub-paragraphs (a) and (b) above;
(ii) 
that for the reference in paragraph II.5.4.5.1
in that Annex to 30 cm there is substituted a reference to 35 cm; and
(iii) 
that the distance of 40 cm specified in paragraph II.5.4.5
in that Annex may be measured exclusive of the said tail-lift, bodywork or
other part.
(5) The provisions
of paragraph (3) shall have effect so that in the case of—
(a) a
vehicle which is fitted with a demountable body, the characteristics specified
in paragraph II.5.4.2 in the Annex
to the said Directive have effect as if the reference to 10 cm were a reference
to 30 cm and as if in paragraph II.5.4.5.1
the reference to 30 cm were a reference to 35 cm; and
(b) a
trailer with a single axle or two close-coupled axles, the height of 55 cm
referred to in paragraph II.5.4.5.1
in that Annex is measured when the coupling of the trailer to the vehicle
by which it is drawn is at the height recommended by the manufacturer of the
trailer.
(6) Instead
of complying with paragraphs (3) to (5) a vehicle may comply with  Community Directive 97/19.
(7) In this
regulation—
 “rear under-run protective device”
 means a device within the description
given in paragraph II.5.4 in the Annex
 to Community Directive 79/490.

50 
Every device fitted to a vehicle in compliance with the requirements
of regulation 49
shall at all times when the vehicle is on a road be maintained free from any
obvious defect which would be likely to affect adversely the performance of
the device in the function of giving resistance in the event of an impact
from the rear.
51 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), this regulation applies to a wheeled goods vehicle
being—
(a) a
motor vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1984 with a maximum gross weight
which exceeds 3500 kg; or
(b) a
trailer manufactured on or after 1st May 1983 with an unladen weight which
exceeds 1020 kg; or
(c) a
semi-trailer manufactured before 1st May 1983 which has a relevant plate showing
a gross weight exceeding 26,000 kg and which forms part of an articulated
vehicle with a relevant train weight exceeding 32,520 kg.
(2) This regulation
does not apply to—
(a) a
motor vehicle which has a maximum speed not exceeding 15 mph;
(b) an
agricultural trailer;
(c) engineering
plant;
(d) a
fire engine;
(e) an
agricultural motor vehicle;
(f) a
vehicle so constructed that it can be unloaded by part of the vehicle being
tipped sideways or rearwards;
(g) a
vehicle owned by the Secretary of State for Defence and used for naval, military
or air force purposes;
(h) a
vehicle to which no bodywork has been fitted and which is being driven or
towed—
(i) 
for the purpose of a quality or safety check by its manufacturer or a dealer
in, or distributor of, such vehicles;
(ii) 
to a place where, by previous arrangement, bodywork is to be fitted or work
preparatory to the fitting of bodywork is to be carried out; or
(iii) 
by previous arrangement to premises of a dealer in, or distributor of, such
vehicles;
(i) a
vehicle which is being driven or towed to a place where by previous arrangement
a sideguard is to be fitted so that it complies with this regulation;
(j) a
refuse vehicle;
(k) a
trailer specially designed and constructed, and not merely adapted, to carry
round timber, beams or girders, being items of exceptional length;
(l) a
motor car or a heavy motor car constructed or adapted to form part of an articulated
vehicle;
(m) a
vehicle specially designed and constructed, and not merely adapted, to carry
other vehicles loaded onto it from the front or the rear;
(n) a
trailer with a load platform—
(i) 
no part of any edge of which is more than 60 mm inboard from the tangential
plane; and
(ii) 
the upper surface of which is not more than 750 mm from the ground throughout
that part of its length under which a sideguard would have to be fitted in
accordance with paragraph (5)(d) to (g) if this exemption did not apply to it;
(o) a
trailer having a base or centre in a country outside Great Britain from which
it normally starts its journeys, provided that a period of not more than 12
months has elapsed since the vehicle was last brought into Great Britain;
or
(p) an
agricultural trailed appliance.
(2A) This regulation also applies to a wheeled goods vehicle, whether of a description falling within paragraph (2) or not, which is—
(a) a semi-trailer some or all of the wheels of which are driven by the drawing vehicle; or
(b) a vehicle first used on or after 1 April 2025 and which is of a type required to be fitted with lateral protection in accordance with Regulation (EU) 2018/858 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 30 May 2018 on the approval and market surveillance of motor vehicles and their trailers, and of systems, components and separate technical units intended for such vehicles.
(3) Every
vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be securely fitted with a sideguard
to give protection on any side of the vehicle where—
(a) if
it is a semi-trailer, the distance between the transverse planes passing through
the centre of its foremost axle and through the centre of its king pin or,
in the case of a vehicle having more than one king pin, the rearmost one,
exceeds 4.5 m; or
(b) if
it is any other vehicle, the distance between the centres of any two consecutive
axles exceeds 3 m.
(4) Save as
provided in paragraphs (6) and (7), a sideguard with which a vehicle is by
this regulation required to be fitted shall comply with all the specifications
listed in paragraph (5).
(5) Those
specifications are—
(a) the
outermost surface of every sideguard shall be smooth, essentially rigid and
either flat or horizontally corrugated, save that—
(i) 
any part of the surface may overlap another provided that the overlapping
edges face rearwards or downwards;
(ii) 
a gap not exceeding 25 mm measured longitudinally may exist between any two
adjacent parts of the surface provided that the foremost edge of the rearward
part does not protrude outboard of the rearmost edge of the forward part;
and
(iii) 
domed heads of bolts or rivets may protrude beyond the surface to a distance
not exceeding 10 mm;
(b) no
part of the lowest edge of a sideguard shall be more than 550 mm above the
ground when the vehicle to which it is fitted is on level ground and, in the
case of a semi-trailer, when its load platform is horizontal;
(c) in
a case specified in an item in column 2 of the Table the highest edge of a
sideguard shall be as specified in that item in column 3;
(d) the
distance between the rearmost edge of a sideguard and the transverse plane
passing through the foremost part of the tyre fitted to the wheel of the vehicle
nearest to it shall not exceed 300 mm;
(e) the
distance between the foremost edge of a sideguard fitted to a semi-trailer
and a transverse plane passing through the centre of the vehicle's king pin
or, if the vehicle has more than one king pin, the rearmost one, shall not
exceed 3 m;
(f) the
foremost edge of a sideguard fitted to a semi-trailer with landing legs shall,
as well as complying with sub-paragraph (e),
not be more than 250 mm to the rear of a transverse plane passing through
the centre of the leg nearest to that edge;
(g) the
distance between the foremost edge of a sideguard fitted to a vehicle other
than a semi-trailer and a transverse plane passing through the rearmost part
of the tyre fitted to the wheel of the vehicle nearest to it shall not exceed
300 mm if the vehicle is a motor vehicle and 500 mm if the vehicle is a trailer;

(h) the
external edges of a sideguard shall be rounded at a radius of at least 2.5
mm;
(i) no
sideguard shall be more than 30 mm inboard from the tangential plane;
(j) no
sideguard shall project beyond the longitudinal plane from which, in the absence
of a sideguard, the vehicle's overall width would fall to be measured;
(k) every
sideguard shall cover an area extending to at least 100 mm upwards from its
lowest edge 100 mm downwards from its highest edge, and 100 mm rearwards and
inwards from its foremost edge, and no sideguard shall have a vertical gap
measuring more than 300 mm nor any vertical surface measuring less than 100
mm; and
(l) except
in the case of a vehicle described in paragraph (1)
(c) every sideguard shall be capable of withstanding a force of
2 kilonewtons (or 1 kilonewton in the case of a vehicle described in paragraph (2A)(b))  applied perpendicularly to any part of its surface by the centre
of a ram the face of which is circular and not more than 220 mm in diameter,
and during such application—
(i) 
no part of the sideguard shall be deflected by more than 150 mm, and
(ii) 
no part of the sideguard which is less than 250 mm from its rearmost part
shall be deflected by more than 30 mm.

TABLE(regulation 51(5))

1 2
 3
Item Case Requirement
about highest edge of sideguard
1 Where the floor of
the vehicle to which the sideguard is fitted—
(i) extends laterally outside the tangential plane;
(ii) is not more than 1.85 m from the ground;(iii)
extends laterally over the whole of the length of the sideguard with which
the vehicle is required by this regulation to be fitted; and
(iv) is wholly covered at its edge by a side-rave the lower edge of which
is not more than 150 mm below the underside of the floor. Not more than 350 mm below the lower edge of the side-rave.

2 Where the floor of the vehicle to which the sideguard is fitted—
(i) extends laterally outside the tangential plane;
and(ii) does not comply with all of the provisions
specified in sub-paragraphs (ii), (iii) and (iv) in item 1 above,and any part of the structure of the vehicle is cut within 1.85
m of the ground by the tangential plane. 
Not more than 350 mm below the structure of the vehicle where it is cut by
the tangential plane.
3 Where—(i) no part of
the structure of the vehicle is cut within 1.85 m of the ground by the tangential
plane; and(ii) the upper surface of the load carrying
structure of the vehicle is less than 1.5 m from the ground. Not less than the height of the upper surface of the load
carrying structure of the vehicle.

4 A vehicle specially designed, and not
merely adapted, for the carriage and mixing of liquid concrete. Not less than 1 m from the ground.
5 Any other
case. Not less than 1.5 m from the ground.

(6) The provisions
of paragraph (4) apply—
(a) in
the case of an extendible trailer when it is, by virtue of the extending mechanism,
extended to a length greater than its minimum, so as not to require, in respect
of any additional distance solely attributable to the extension, compliance
with the specifications mentioned in paragraph (5)
(d) to (g);
(b) in
the case of a vehicle designed and constructed, and not merely adapted, to
be fitted with a demountable body or to carry a container, when it is not
fitted with a demountable body or carrying such a container as if it were
fitted with such a body or carrying such a container; and
(c) only
so far as it is practicable in the case of—
(i) 
a vehicle designed solely for the carriage of a fluid substance in a closed
tank which is permanently fitted to the vehicle and provided with valves and
hose or pipe connections for loading or unloading; and
(ii) 
a vehicle which requires additional stability during loading or unloading
or while being used for operations for which it is designed or adapted and
is fitted on one or both sides with an extendible device to provide such stability.

(7) In the
case of a motor vehicle to which this regulation applies and which is of a
type which was required to be approved by the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles
Regulations before 1st October 1983—
(a) if
the bodywork of the vehicle covers the whole of the area specified as regards
a sideguard in paragraph (5)(b), (c), (d) and (g) above the other provisions of that paragraph
do not apply to that vehicle; and
(b) if
the bodywork of the vehicle covers only part of that area the part of that
area which is not so covered shall be fitted with a sideguard which complies
with the provisions of paragraph (5) above save that there shall not be a
gap between—
(i) 
the rearmost edge of the sideguard or the rearmost part of the bodywork (whichever
is furthest to the rear) and the transverse plane mentioned in paragraph (5)(d) of more than 300 mm;
(ii) 
the foremost edge of the sideguard or the foremost part of the bodywork (whichever
is furthest to the front) and the transverse plane mentioned in paragraph
(5)(g) of more than 300 mm; or
(iii) 
any vertical or sloping edge of any part of the bodywork in question and the
edge of the sideguard immediately forwards or rearwards thereof of more than
25 mm measured horizontally.
(8) In this
regulation
 “relevant plate”
means a Ministry plate, where fitted, and in other cases
a plate fitted in accordance with regulation 66;

 “relevant train weight”
 means the train weight shown in column
2 of the Ministry plate, where fitted, and in other cases the maximum train
weight shown at item 8 of the plate fitted in accordance with regulation 66; and

 “tangential plane”,
in relation to a sideguard, means the vertical plane
tangential to the external face of the outermost part of the tyre (excluding
any distortion caused by the weight of the vehicle) fitted to the outermost
wheel at the rear and on the same side of the vehicle.
(9) Instead of complying with the foregoing provisions of this regulation a vehicle may comply with Community Directive 89/297.
52 
Every sideguard fitted to a vehicle in compliance with the requirements
of regulation 51
shall at all times when the vehicle is on a road be maintained free from any
obvious defect which would be likely to affect adversely its effectiveness.

53 

(1) Subject
to paragraph (2), no mascot, emblem or other ornamental object shall be carried
by a motor vehicle first used on or after 1st October 1937 in any position
where it is likely to strike any person with whom the vehicle may collide
unless the mascot is not liable to cause injury to such person by reason of
any projection thereon.
(2) Instead
of complying with the requirements of paragraph (1) a vehicle may comply with Community Directive 74/483 or 79/488 or ECE Regulation 26.01.
53A 

(1) This regulation applies to every coach which is—
(a) a single decked vehicle;
(b) equipped with a compartment below the deck for the luggage of passengers; and
(c) first used on or after  1st April 1993.
(2) Every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall comply with the requirements of ECE Regulation 66.
53B 

(1) This regulation applies to every coach which is—
(a) a double-decked vehicle; and
(b) first used on or after 1st April 1990.
(2) Subject to the following provisions of this regulation, every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be equipped with two staircases, one of which shall be located in one half of the vehicle and the other in the other half of the vehicle.
(3) Instead of being equipped with two staircases in accordance with paragraph (2), a vehicle to which this regulation applies may be equipped in accordance with the following provisions of this regulation with a hammer or other similar device with which in case of emergency any side window of the vehicle may be broken.
(4) Where a vehicle is equipped with—
(a) a staircase located in one half of the vehicle; and
(b) an emergency exit complying with regulation 21(8) of the Public Service Vehicles (Conditions of Fitness, Equipment, Use and Certification) Regulations 1981 located in the same half of the upper deck of the vehicle;
the hammer or the similar device shall be located in the other half of that deck.
(5) Any hammer or other similar device with which a vehicle is equipped pursuant to this regulation shall be located in a conspicuous and readily accessible position in the upper deck of the vehicle.
(6) There shall be displayed, in a conspicuous position in close proximity to the hammer or other similar device, a notice which shall contain in clear and indelible lettering—
(a) in letters not less than 25 mm high, the heading “IN EMERGENCY”; and
(b) in letters not less than 10 mm high, instructions that in case of emergency the hammer or device is to be used first to break any side window by striking the glass near the edge of the window and then to clear any remaining glass from the window aperture.
(7) For the purposes of this regulation a staircase, emergency exit, hammer or other similar device (as the case may be) shall be considered to be located in the other half of the vehicle if the shortest distance between any part of that staircase, exit, hammer or device (as the case may be) and any part of any other staircase, emergency exit, hammer or device is not less than one half of the overall length of the vehicle.
53C. 

(1) A coach which is required by either regulation 53A or 53B, as the case may be, to meet the requirements specified in that particular provision, need not meet them if it meets the requirements of such of the Annexes to Directive 2001/85/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council of 20 November 2001, relating to special provisions for vehicles used for the carriage of passengers comprising more than eight seats in addition to the driver’s seat, and amending Directives 70/156/EEC and 97/27/EC, as apply to that coach..
(2) A coach which is required by either regulation 53A or 53B, as the case may be, to meet the requirements specified in that particular provision, need not meet them if it meets such requirements of ECE Regulation 107.01 or 107.02 as apply to that coach.
K
54 

(1) Every
vehicle propelled by an internal combustion engine shall be fitted with an
exhaust system including a silencer and the exhaust gases from the engine
shall not escape into the atmosphere without first passing through the silencer.

(2) Every
exhaust system and silencer shall be maintained in good and efficient working
order and  shall not after the date of manufacture be altered  so as to increase the noise made by the escape
of exhaust gases.
(3) Instead
of complying with paragraph (1) a vehicle may comply with Community Directive 77/212, 81/334, 84/372 , 84/424 or 92/97 or ECE Regulation 51.02  or, in the case of a motor
cycle other than a moped, 78/1015 , 87/56 or 89/235.
(4) In this
regulation 
“moped” has the meaning given
to it in paragraph (5) of Schedule 9.

55 

(1) Save as
provided in  paragraphs (1A) and (2)  and regulation 59,
this regulation applies to every wheeled motor vehicle having at least three
wheels and first used on or after 1st October 1983 which is—
(a) a
vehicle, not falling within sub-paragraph (b)
or (c), with or without bodywork;
(b) a
vehicle not falling within sub-paragraph (c)
which is—
(i) 
engineering plant;
(ii) 
a locomotive other than an agricultural motor vehicle;
(iii) 
a motor tractor other than an industrial tractor or an agricultural motor
vehicle;
(iv) 
a public works vehicle;
(v) 
a works truck; or
(vi) 
a refuse vehicle; or
(c) a
vehicle which—
(i) 
has a compression ignition engine;
(ii) 
is so constructed or adapted that the driving power of the engine is, or by
appropriate use of the controls can be, transmitted to all wheels of the vehicle;
and
(iii) 
falls within category I.1.1., I.1.2, or I.1.3 specified in Article 1 of Community Directive 77/212.

(1A) This regulation does not apply to a vehicle to which an item in the Table in regulation 55A applies.
(2) This regulation
does not apply to—
(a) a
motorcycle with a sidecar attached;
(b) an
agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor, which is first used before 1st June 1986 or which
is not driven at more than 20 mph;
(ba) a category T tractor which is first used before 1st June 1986 or which is not driven at more than 40 km/h;
(c) an
industrial tractor;
(d) a
road roller;
(e) a
vehicle specially constructed, and not merely adapted, for the purposes of
fighting fires or salvage from fires at or in the vicinity of airports, and
having an engine power exceeding 220 kW;
(f) a
vehicle which runs on rails; or
(g) a
vehicle manufactured by Leyland Vehicles Ltd. and known as the Atlantean Bus,
if first used before 1st October 1984.
(3) Save as
provided in paragraphs (4) and (5), every vehicle to which this regulation
applies shall be so constructed that it complies with the requirements set
out in item 1, 2, 3 or 4 of the Table; a vehicle complies with those requirements
if—
(a) its
sound level does not exceed the relevant limit specified in column 2(a), (b) or (c), as the case may be, in the relevant item when
measured under the conditions specified in column 3 in that item and by the
method specified in column 4 in that item using the apparatus prescribed in
paragraph (6); and
(b) in
the case of a vehicle referred to in paragraph 1(a)
 (other than one having less than four wheels or a maximum speed
not exceeding 25 km/h) or 1(c), the device
designed to reduce the exhaust noise meets the requirements specified in column
5 in that item.

TABLE(regulation 55(3))

1 
2 3 4 5
 Limits
of sound level

Item (a) Vehicle referred
to in paragraph (1)(a) (b) Vehicle referred to in paragraph (1)(b) (c) Vehicle referred to in paragraph (1)(c) Conditions of measurement
 Method
of measurement 
Requirements for exhaust device
1 Limits specified
in paragraph I.1 of the Annex
to Community
Directive 77/212. 89dB(A) 82dB(A) Conditions specified in paragraph I.3 of the Annex
to Community
Directive 77/212 Method specified in paragraph I.4.1 of the Annex
to Community
Directive 77/212 Requirements specified in heading II of the Annex to Community Directive 77/212
(except paragraphs II.2
and II.5).

2 Limits specified in paragraph 5.2.2.1 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 81/334. 89dB(A) 82dB(A) Conditions specified in paragraph 5.2.2.3 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 81/334. Method specified in paragraph 5.2.2.4 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 81/334. Interpretation of results
as specified in paragraph 5.2.2.5
of that Annex. Requirements specified
in section 3 and paragraphs 5.1
and 5.3.1 of
Annex 1 to Community Directive 81/334.
3 
Limits specified in paragraph 5.2.2.1 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 84/372 89dB(A) 82dB(A) Conditions specified in paragraph 5.2.2.3 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 84/372 Method specified in paragraph 5.2.2.4 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 84/372, except that vehicles with
5 or more forward gears and a maximum power to maximum gross weight ratio
not less than 75 kW per 1000 kg may be tested in 3rd gear only. Interpretation
of results as specified in paragraph 5.2.2.5
of that Annex. Requirements specified
in section 3 and paragraphs 5.1
and 5.3.1 of
Annex I to Community Directive 84/372.
4 
Limits specified in paragraph 5.2.2.1 of the Annex
I to Community Directive 84/424 Vehicles with engine power—–less than 75kW
– 84dB(A)–not less than 75kW
–86dB(A) Limits specified in paragraph 5.2.2.1 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 84/424. Conditions specified in paragraph 5.2.2.3 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 84/424 Method specified in paragraph 5.2.2.4 of Annex I
to Community
Directive 84/424, except that vehicles with
5 or more forward gears and a maximum power to maximum gross weight ratio
not less than 75 kW per 1000 kg may be tested in 3rd gear only. Interpretation
of results as specified in paragraph 5.2.2.5
of that Annex Requirements specified
in section 3 and paragraphs 5.1 and 5.3.1 of Annex
I to Community Directive 84/424.
(4) Save as
provided in paragraph (5), paragraph (3) applies to every vehicle to which
this regulation applies and which is first used on or after 1st April 1990,
unless it is equipped with 5 or more forward gears and has a maximum power
to maximum gross weight ratio not less than 75 kW per 1000 kg, and is of a
type in respect of which a type approval certificate has been issued under
the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations as if, for the reference to
items 1, 2, 3 or 4 of the Table there were substituted a reference to item
4 of the Table.
(5) Paragraph
(4) does not apply to a vehicle in category 5.2.2.1.3 as defined in Annex I to Directive 84/424
and equipped with a compression ignition engine, a vehicle in category 5.2.2.1.4
as defined in that Annex, or a vehicle referred to in paragraph 1(b) unless it is first used on or after 1st April
1991.
(6) The apparatus
prescribed for the purposes of paragraph 3(a)
and regulation 56(2)(a) and Schedule 7A  
is a sound level meter of the type described in Publication No. 179 of the
International Electrotechnical Commission, in either its first or second edition,
a sound level meter complying with the specification for Type 0 or Type 1
in Publication No. 651 (1979) “Sound Level Meters” of the International
Electrotechnical Commission, or a sound level meter complying with the specifications
of the British Standard Number BS 5969:1981 which came into effect on 29th
May 1981.
(6A) A vehicle shall be deemed to satisfy the requirements of this regulation if it is so constructed that it complies with the requirements specified in column 4 of item 2 in the Table in regulation 55A as they apply to a vehicle first used on or after the date specified in column 3 of that item.
(7) Instead
of complying with the preceding provisions of this regulation a vehicle may
comply at the time of its first use with Community Directive 77/212, 81/334, 84/372  , 84/424, 92/97 or 96/20 or ECE Regulation 51.02.
55A 

(1) A motor vehicle to which an item in the Table below applies shall be so constructed that it meets the requirements specified in column 4 of that item; and an item in that Table applies to a vehicle if it is of the description specified in column 2 of that item.This paragraph has effect subject to the following provisions of this regulation, regulation 59 and Schedule 7XA.

THE TABLE
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
Item Vehicles to which the item applies Earliest date of first use (see column 2) The requirements Modification of Community Directives in relation to special vehicles (See paragraph (4)(c))
1 
1 
All motor vehicles with less than 4 wheels and first used on or after the date specified in column 3 of this item.
2 
All special vehicles first used on or after the date specified in column 3 of this item.
3 
All motor vehicles first used on or after the date specified in column 3 of this item with a maximum speed not exceeding 25 km/h. 1st October 1996 The requirements of—
(a) regulation 55 as they would apply to the vehicle but for paragraph (1A) of that regulation; or
(b) paragraphs 3 and 5.2 of Annex I to Community Directive 92/97 or 96/20. For paragraph 5.2.2.1 of Annex I, substitute—“The sound level measured in accordance with 5.2.2.2 to 5.2.2.5 of this Annex shall not exceed—
(a) in the case of vehicles with engine power of less than 75 kW, 84 dB(A)
(b) in the case of vehicles with engine power not less than 75 kW, 86 dB(A).”
2 All motor vehicles first used on or after the date specified in column 3 of this item, not being a vehicle to which item 1 applies. 1st October 1996 The requirements of paragraphs 3 and 5 of Annex I to Community Directive 92/97 or 96/20. 
(2) Paragraph (1) does not apply to—
(a) a vehicle with fewer than 3 wheels; or
(b) a vehicle of a description mentioned in regulation 55(2).
(3) In this regulation, “special vehicle” means a vehicle which is—
(a) engineering plant;
(b) a locomotive other than an agricultural motor vehicle;
(c) a motor tractor other than an industrial tractor or an agricultural motor vehicle;
(d) a public works vehicle; or
(e) a works truck.
(4) For the purposes of this regulation—
(a) subject to paragraphs (b), (c), (d) and (e), the Community Directives referred to in this regulation shall have effect in relation to a vehicle that is not a “vehicle” within the meaning of the Framework Directive but is of a class of a description specified in column 2 of an item in the Table in regulation 15 (whether or not regulation 15 applies to the vehicle) as it has effect in relation to a vehicle of the category specified in column 3 of that item;
(b) subject to paragraphs (c), (d) and (e), a vehicle that does not fall within sub-paragraph (a) and is not a “vehicle” within the meaning of the Framework Directive shall be regarded as meeting the requirements of paragraph 5 of a Community Directive mentioned in the Table if it meets—
(i) the requirements of that paragraph as it applies to a vehicle in category M1 or N1 within the meaning of the Community Directive, or
(ii) the requirements of that paragraph as it applies to a vehicle that is not in either of those categories;
(c) subject to sub-paragraphs (d) and (e), in relation to a special vehicle the Community Directives mentioned in column 4 of an item in the Table shall have effect with the modifications (if any) specified in column 5 of the item;
(d) a requirement in paragraph 5.2.2.1 of Annex 1 to Community Directive 92/97 for a sound level not to exceed a specified limit in specified circumstances shall be read as a requirement for the sound level not to exceed that limit by more than the amount mentioned in paragraph 4.1 of Annex V to the Community Directive in those circumstances;
(e) a requirement in paragraph 5.2.2.1 of Annex 1 to Community Directive 96/20 for a sound level not to exceed a specified limit in specified circumstances shall be read as a requirement for the sound level not to exceed that limit by more than the amount mentioned in paragraph 4.1 of Annex III to the Directive in those circumstances.
(5) Instead of complying with paragraph (1) a vehicle may comply at the time of its first use—
(a) in the case of a vehicle to which item 1 of the Table applies, with Community Directive 77/212, 81/334, 84/424, 92/97 or 96/20 or ECE Regulation 51.02; or
(b) in the case of a vehicle to which item 2 of the Table applies, with Community Directive 92/97 or 96/20 or ECE Regulation 51.02.
56 

(1) Save as
provided in regulation 59,
this regulation applies to every wheeled vehicle first used on or after 1st
April 1983 being an agricultural motor vehicle or an industrial tractor, other
than—
(a) an agricultural motor vehicle, not being a category T tractor, which is first used on or after 1st June 1986 and which is driven at more than 20 mph;
(aa) a category T tractor which is first used on or after 1st June 1986 and which is driven at more than 40 km/h; or
(b) a
road roller.
(2) Every
vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be so constructed—
(a) that
its sound level does not exceed—
(i) 
if it is a vehicle with engine power of less than 65kW, 89 dB(A);
(ii) 
if it is a vehicle with engine power of 65kW or more, and first used before
1st October 1991, 92 dB(A); or
(iii) 
if it is a vehicle with engine power of 65kW or more, and first used on or
after 1st October 1991, 89 dB(A),when measured under the conditions specified in paragraph I.3 of Annex VI of Community Directive 74/151
by the method specified in paragraph I.4.1
of that Annex using the apparatus prescribed in regulation 55(6);
and
(b) that
the device designed to reduce the exhaust noise meets the requirements specified
in paragraph II.1
of that Annex and, if fibrous absorbent material is used, the requirements
specified in paragraphs II.4.1 to II.4.3
of that Annex.
57 

(1) Subject to regulation 59, this regulation applies to every motor vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1983 which is—
(a) a moped; or
(b) a two-wheeled motor cycle, whether or not with sidecar attached, which is not a moped.
(2) A vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be so constructed that it meets,—
(a) if it is first used before 1st April 1991, the requirements of item 1 or 2 of the Table in Part I of Schedule 7A;
(b) if it is first used on or after that date, the requirements of item 2 of that Table.
(3) Instead of complying with paragraph (2), a vehicle first used before 1st April 1991 may comply at the time of its first use with Community Directive 78/1015, 87/56 or 89/235.
(4) Instead of complying with paragraph (2), a vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1991 may comply at the time of its first use with Community Directive 87/56 or 89/235.
(5) In this regulation “moped” has the meaning given to it in paragraph 5 of Schedule 9.
57A 

(1) Any original silencer forming part of the exhaust system of a vehicle to which regulation 57 applies, being a vehicle first used before 1st February 1996, shall—
(a) be so constructed that the vehicle meets the requirements specified in paragraph 3 (other than sub-paragraphs 3.2 and 3.3) of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015 and be marked in accordance with sub-paragraph 3.3 of that Annex; or
(b) be so constructed that the vehicle meets the requirements specified in paragraph 3 (other than sub-paragraphs 3.2 and 3.3) of Annex I to Community Directive 89/235 and be marked in accordance with sub-paragraph 3.3 of that Annex.
(2) Any original silencer forming part of the exhaust system of a vehicle to which regulation 57 applies, being a vehicle first used on or after 1st February 1996, shall be so constructed that the vehicle meets the requirements specified in paragraph 3 (other than sub-paragraphs 3.2 and 3.3) of Annex I to Community Directive 89/235 and be marked in accordance with sub-paragraph 3.3 of that Annex.
(3) A vehicle fitted with an original silencer may,—
(a) if the vehicle is first used before 1st February 1996, instead of complying with paragraph (1), comply at the time of first use with Community Directive 78/1015, 87/56 or 89/235; or
(b) if the vehicle is first used on or after that date, instead of complying with paragraph (2), comply at the time of first use with Community Directive 89/235.
(4) Where any replacement silencer forms part of the exhaust system of a vehicle to which regulation 57 applies, being a vehicle first used on or after 1st January 1985, the first requirement or the second requirement as set out below must be met in respect of the silencer.
(5) In order for the first requirement to be met in respect of a silencer forming part of the exhaust system of a vehicle (in this paragraph referred to as “the vehicle in question”),—
(a) if the vehicle in question is first used before 1st April 1991, the silencer must be so constructed that, were it to be fitted to an unused vehicle of the same model as the vehicle in question, the unused vehicle would meet—
(i) the requirements of item 1 or 3 of the Table in Part I of Schedule 7A; and
(ii) the requirements specified in paragraph 3 (other than sub-paragraphs 3.2 and 3.3) of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015 or 89/235,
and the silencer must be marked in accordance with sub-paragraph 3.3 of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015 or 89/235;
(b) if the vehicle in question is first used on or after the 1st April 1991 but before 1st February 1996, the silencer must be so constructed that, were it to be fitted to an unused vehicle of the same model as the vehicle in question, the unused vehicle would meet—
(i) the requirements of item 3 of the Table in Part I of Schedule 7A; and
(ii) the requirements specified in paragraph 3 (other than sub-paragraphs 3.2 and 3.3) of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015 or 89/235,
and the silencer must be marked in accordance with sub-paragraph 3.3 of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015 or 89/235;
(c) if the vehicle in question is first used on or after 1st February 1996, the silencer must be so constructed that, were it to be fitted to an unused vehicle of the same model as the vehicle in question, the unused vehicle would meet—
(i) the requirements of item 3 of the Table in Part I of Schedule 7A; and
(ii) the requirements specified in paragraph 3 (other than sub-paragraphs 3.2 and 3.3) of Annex I to Community Directive 89/235,
and the silencer must be marked in accordance with sub-paragraph 3.3 of Annex I to that Directive.
(6) In order for the second requirement to be met in respect of a silencer forming part of the exhaust system of a vehicle (in Part II of Schedule 7A referred to as “the vehicle in question”),—
(a) if the vehicle is first used before 1st April 1991, the silencer must meet the requirements of paragraph 2, 3 or 4 of Part II of Schedule 7A; or
(b) if the vehicle is first used on or after that date, the silencer must meet the requirements of paragraph 4 of Part II of Schedule 7A.
(7) Any requirements specified in paragraph (5) or in Part II of Schedule 7A relating to the silencer were it to be fitted to an unused vehicle of the same model as the vehicle in question (as defined in that paragraph or in paragraph (6) for the purposes of that Part, as the case may be) shall be deemed to be met if they are met by the silencer as fitted to the vehicle in question at the time that it is first fitted.
(8) For the purposes of this regulation, Community Directive 89/235 shall have effect as if—
(a) in Annex I, for sub-paragraph 3.4.1, there were substituted—“
3.4.1. After removal of the fibrous material, the vehicle must meet the relevant requirements.”; and
 for sub-paragraph 3.4.3 there were substituted—“
3.4.3. After the exhaust system has been put into a normal state for road use by one of the following conditioning methods, the vehicle must meet the relevant requirements:”;
(b) references in Annex I as so modified to a vehicle meeting the relevant requirements were,—
(i) in relation to an original silencer, references to a vehicle meeting the requirements of item 2 of the Table in Part I of Schedule 7A; and
(ii) in relation to a replacement silencer, references to a vehicle meeting the requirements of item 3 of that Table;
(c) in Annex II there were omitted sub-paragraphs 3.1.2, 3.4 and 3.5 and in sub-paragraph 3.2—
(i) the words “and the name referred to in 3.1.2”, and
(ii) the words after “legible”.
(8A) For the purposes of paragraphs (1)(b) and (2) in their application to vehicles with a design speed not exceeding 50km/h, Community Directive 89/235/EEC shall have effect as if it were not only modified in accordance with paragraph (8) but were further modified by the omission of—
(a) sub-paragraph 3.1.3 of Annex II; and
(b) in sub-paragraph 3.2 of that Annex, the words “and 3.1.3”.
(9) In relation to a replacement silencer which is—
(a) fitted to a vehicle before 1st February 1997; and
(b) clearly and indelibly marked with the name or trade mark of the manufacturer of the silencer and with that manufacturer’s part number relating to it,
paragraphs (5) and (6) of this regulation and Parts II and III of Schedule 7A shall have effect as if they contained no reference to a silencer being marked.
(10) For the purposes of this regulation, a silencer forming part of the exhaust system ofa vehicle shall not be regarded as being marked in accordance with sub-paragraph 3.3 of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015 or 89/235, paragraph (9) of this regulation or any paragraph of Part II of Schedule 7A if the marking is so obscured by any part of the vehicle that it cannot easily be read.
(11) Until 1st February 1996, for the purposes of paragraph (6), a vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1991 shall be treated as a vehicle first used before 1st April 1991.
(12) Part III of Schedule 7A shall have effect for the purpose of exempting certain silencers from the provisions of paragraph (4).
(13) No person shall use a motor cycle on a road or cause or permit such a vehicle to be so used if any part of the exhaust system has been indelibly marked by the manufacturer of that part with the words “NOT FOR ROAD USE”or words to that effect.
(14) In this regulation—“original silencer”, in relation to a vehicle, means a silencer which was fitted to the vehicle when it was manufactured;
 “replacement silencer”, in relation to a vehicle, means a silencer fitted to the vehicle, not being an original silencer; and
 “trade mark” has the same meaning as in the Trade Marks Act 1938.
57B 

(1) No person shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road a motor cycle to which regulation 57 applies if the three conditions specified below are all fulfilled.
(2) The first condition is fulfilled if the vehicle does not meet the noise limit requirements.
(3) The second condition is fulfilled if—
(a) any part of the vehicle is not in good and efficient working order, or
(b) the vehicle has been altered.
(4) The third condition is fulfilled if the noise made by the vehicle would have been materially less (so far as applicable)—
(a) were all parts of the vehicle in good and efficient working order, or
(b) had the vehicle not been altered.
(5) For the purposes of this regulation, a vehicle meets the noise limit requirements if,—
(a) in the case of a vehicle first used before 1st April 1991 and not fitted with a replacement silencer, it meets the requirements of item 1 or 2 of the Table in Part I of Schedule 7A;
(b) in the case of a vehicle first used before 1st April 1991 and fitted with a replacement silencer, it meets the requirements of item 1 or 3 of that Table;
(c) in the case of a vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1991 and not fitted with a replacement silencer, it meets the requirements of item 2 of that Table;
(d) in the case of a vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1991 and fitted with a replacement silencer, it meets the requirements of item 3 of that Table.
(6) In this regulation, “replacement silencer” has the same meaning as in regulation 57A.
58 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
59 
Regulations 55, 55A,  56,    57,57A and 57B    do not apply to a motor vehicle which is—
(a) proceeding
to a place where, by previous arrangement—
(i) noise
emitted by it is about to be measured for the purpose of ascertaining whether
or not the vehicle complies with such of those provisions as apply to it;
or
(ii) 
the vehicle is about to be mechanically adjusted, modified or equipped for
the purpose of securing that it so complies; or
(b) returning
from such a place immediately after the noise has been so measured.
60 

(1) Subject to paragraphs (1B), (1D), (1E) and (2)—
(a) every vehicle to which this sub-paragraph applies shall be so constructed that it complies with the requirements of paragraph 6 of Annex 1 to Community Directive 72/245 or paragraph 6 (as read with paragraph 8) of Annex 1 to Community Directive 95/54 (whether or not those Community Directives apply to the vehicle); and
(b) every agricultural and forestry tractor which is propelled by a spark ignition engine and is first used on or after 1st April 1974 shall be so constructed that it meets the requirements of paragraph 6 of Community Directive 72/245, 75/322 or 95/54.
(1A) Paragraph (1)(a) applies to every wheeled vehicle which is propelled by a spark ignition engine and—
(a) is first used on or after 1st April 1974 and before 1st January 1996; or
(b) is first used on or after 1st January 1996 and is a “vehicle” within the meaning of the Framework Directive.
(1B) For the purposes of paragraph (1)—
(a) a requirement in paragraph 6.2.2 of Community Directive 72/245 or 75/322 for any description of radiation level not to exceed a specified limit when measured in specified circumstances shall be read as a requirement for that description of radiation level not to exceed that limit by more than the amount mentioned in paragraph 9.2 of those Community Directives when measured in those circumstances; and
(b) a requirement in paragraph 6.2.2 or 6.3.2 of Community Directive 95/54 for any description of radiation level not to exceed a specified limit when measured in specified circumstances shall be read as a requirement for that description of radiation level not to exceed that limit by more than the amount mentioned in paragraph 7.3.1 of the Community Directive when measured in those circumstances.
(1C) Subject to paragraph (1F), the requirements of Community Directive 72/245/EC as amended by Community Directive 95/54/EC shall be met by electrical/electronic sub-assemblies as components or separate technical units first used on or after 1 October 2002.
(1D) Instead of complying with paragraph (1)(a) a vehicle may comply at the time of first use with Community Directive 72/245 or 95/54 or  ECE Regulations 10, 10.01 or 10.02.
(1E) Instead of complying with paragraph (1)(b) a vehicle may comply at the time of first use with Community Directive 75/322.
(1F) The requirements of paragraph (1C) shall not apply to electrical/electronic sub-assemblies of the following descriptions—
(a) replacement parts intended for use on vehicles manufactured in accordance with type approvals granted before 1 January 1996 in compliance with Community Directive 72/245/EEC or Community Directive 72/306/EEC including any subsequent extension that may have been granted to such type approvals;
(b) electrical/electronic sub-assemblies fitted to any vehicle under an authorisation having effect under Part III of the Police Act 1997 or Part II of the Regulation of Investigatory Powers Act 2000 or under a warrant under Part 5 of the Investigatory Powers Act 2016.
(2) This regulation
does not apply to a vehicle constructed or assembled by a person not ordinarily
engaged in the trade or business of manufacturing vehicles of that description,
but nothing in this paragraph affects the application to such vehicles of
the Wireless Telegraphy (Control of
Interference from Ignition Apparatus) Regulations 1973.

(3) In this regulation “electrical/electronic sub-assembly” has the same meaning as in Community Directive 95/54.
61 

(1) Subject
to  paragraph (3B), every vehicle shall be constructed and maintained  so as not to emit any
avoidable smoke or avoidable visible vapour.
(2) Every
motor vehicle using solid fuel shall be fitted with—
(a) a
tray or shield to prevent ashes and cinders from falling onto the road; and

(b) an
efficient appliance to prevent any emission of sparks or grit.
(2A) Paragraphs (3), (3A), (3C), (4A), (5)(b), (5)(c), (6), (7), (8), (9), (10) and (11) shall not apply to motor vehicles first used on or after 1st January 2001.
(3) Subject
to paragraph (4) and to the exemptions specified in an item in column 4 of
 Table I, every wheeled vehicle of a class specified in that item in column
2 shall be constructed so as to comply with the requirements specified in
that item in column 3.
(3A) A motor vehicle to which an item in Table II applies shall be so constructed as to comply with the requirements relating to conformity of production models set out in the provisions specified in that item in column (4) of that Table.
(3B) Instead of complying with paragraph (1) a vehicle may comply with a relevant instrument.
(3C) Instead of complying with such provisions of items 1, 2 and 3 in Table I as apply to it, a vehicle may at the time of its first use comply with a relevant instrument.
(4) For the purposes of paragraphs (3B) and (3C), a reference to a vehicle complying with a relevant instrument is a reference to a vehicle complying—

(a) if it is propelled by a compression ignition engine—
(i) in the case of an agricultural vehicle first used before 1st January 2001, with Community Directive 77/537, or
(ii) in the case of any other vehicle, either—(aa) Community Directive 72/306, as last amended by Community Directive 2005/21, or(bb) ECE Regulation 24.01, 24.02 or 24.03; or
(b) if it is propelled by a spark ignition engine, with any instrument mentioned in column (4)(a) of Table II.
(4A) In relation to a vehicle which—
(a) has an engine the cylinder capacity of which is less than 700 cc and has a rated power speed of more than 3,000 revolutions per minute;
(b) is first used before 1st October 1998,Community Directive 91/542 shall have effect for the purposes of this regulation as if for the figure “0.15” in the Table in paragraph 6.2.1 and 8.3.1.1 there were substituted “0.25”.For the purposes of this paragraph, “rated power speed” has the same meaning as in Community Directive 96/1.
(5) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road any motor vehicle—

(a) from
which any smoke, visible vapour, grit, sparks, ashes, cinders or oily substance
is emitted if that emission causes, or is likely to cause, damage to any property
or injury or danger to any person who is, or who may reasonably be expected
to be, on the road;
(b) which
is subject to the requirement in item 2 of Table I (whether or not it is
deemed to comply with that requirement by virtue of paragraph (4)), if the
fuel injection equipment, the engine speed governor or any other parts of
the engine by which it is propelled have been altered or adjusted so as to
increase the emission of smoke; or
(c) which
is subject to the requirement in item 1 of the Table if the device mentioned
in column 2 in that item is used while the vehicle is in motion.
(6) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a motor vehicle to which
item 3 of Table I applies unless it is so maintained that the means specified
in column 3 of that item are in good working order.
(7) Subject to paragraphs ...      (8), (9) and (10), no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a motor vehicle to which an item in Table II applies if, in relation to the emission of the substances specified in column (6) of the item, the vehicle does not comply with the requirements relating to conformity of production models specified in column (4) unless the following conditions are satisfied in respect to it–
(a) the failure to meet those requirements in relation to the emission of those substances does not result from an alteration to the propulsion unit or exhaust system of the vehicle,
(b) neither would those requirements  be met in relation to the emission of those substances nor would such emissions be materially reduced if maintenance work of a kind which would fall within the scope of a normal periodic service of the vehicle were to be carried out on the vehicle, and
(c) the failure to meet those requirements in relation to such emissions does not result from any device designed to control the emission of carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, oxides of nitrogen or particulates fitted to the vehicle being other than in good and efficient working order.
(7A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(7B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(7C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(7D) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(7E) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(7F) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(7G) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(7H) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(8) Paragraph (7) shall not apply to a vehicle first used before 26th June 1990.
(9) Where–
(a) a vehicle is fitted with a device of the kind referred to in sub-paragraph (c) of paragraph (7),
(b) the vehicle does not comply with the requirements specified in that paragraph in respect to it, and
(c) the conditions specified in sub-paragraphs (a) and (b) of that paragraph are satisfied in respect to the vehicle,
nothing in paragraph (7) shall prevent the vehicle being driven to a place where the device is to be repaired or replaced.
(10) Where a vehicle is constructed or assembled by a person not ordinarily engaged in the business of manufacturing motor vehicles of that description and is first used before  1st July 1998, the date on which it is first used shall, for the purposes of paragraphs (3A), (7), (8) and (9), be regarded as being the 1st January immediately preceding the date of manufacture of the engine by which it is propelled.However, the date on which a vehicle is first used shall not, by virtue of the foregoing provisions of this paragraph, be regarded in any circumstances as being later than the date on which it would otherwise have been regarded as being first used had those provisions been omitted.
(10A) Without prejudice to paragraphs (1) and (7) and subject to the following provisions of this regulation, no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used on a road, a vehicle first used on or after 1st August 1975 and propelled by a four-stroke spark ignition engine, if the vehicle is in such a condition and running on such fuel that—
(a) when the engine is idling the carbon monoxide content of the exhaust emissions from the engine exceeds—
(i) in the case of a vehicle first used before 1st August 1986, 4.5%; or
(ii) in the case of a vehicle first used on or after 1st August 1986, 3.5%;
of the total exhaust emissions from the engine by volume; and
(b) when the engine is running without load at a rotational speed of 2,000 revolutions per minute, the hydrocarbon content of those emissions exceeds 0.12% of the total exhaust emissions from the engine by volume.
(10AA) Without prejudice to paragraphs (1) and (7) and subject to the following provisions of this regulation, no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used on a road, a vehicle to which this paragraph applies and which is propelled by a spark ignition engine, if the vehicle is in such a condition and running on such fuel that Part I of Schedule 7B applies to the vehicle.
(10AB) Subject to paragraph (10B), paragraph (10AA) applies to—
(a) a passenger car which—
(i) is first used on or after 1st August 1992 and before  1st August 1995, and
(ii) is of a description mentioned in the Annex to the emissions publication;
(b) a vehicle which—
(i) is not a passenger car,
(ii) is first used on or after 1st August 1994 ..., and
(iii) is of a description mentioned in the Annex to the emissions publication; ... 
(c) a passenger car which is first used on or after  1st August 1995; ... or
(ca) a vehicle which—
(i) is not a passenger car,
(ii) is first used on or after 1st July 2002, and
(iii) has a maximum gross weight not exceeding 3,500kg;
(d) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
and in this paragraph, “emissions publication” has the meaning given in Part I of Schedule 7B.
(10AC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(10AD) Paragraph (10A) does not apply to — 
(a) a vehicle to which paragraph (10AA) applies; or
(b) a vehicle if, at the date that the engine was manufactured, that engine was incapable of meeting the requirements specified in that paragraph.
(10AE) Paragraph (10AA) does not apply to a vehicle if, at the date that the engine was manufactured, that engine was incapable of meeting the requirements specified in that paragraph.
(10B) Paragraphs (10A) and (10AA) do not apply to—
(a) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(b) a vehicle being driven to a place where it is to undergo repairs;
(c) a vehicle which was constructed or assembled by a person not ordinarily engaged in the business of manufacturing motor vehicles of that description and is first used before   1st July 1998;
(d) an exempt vehicle within the meaning given by paragraph (12)(a) ...;
(e) a goods vehicle with a maximum gross weight exceeding 3,500 kg;
(f) engineering plant, an industrial tractor, or a works truck; ...
(g) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . or
(h) a vehicle first used before 1st August 1987 if the engine is a rotary piston engine; and for the purposes of this paragraph “the engine”, in relation to a vehicle, means the engine by which it is propelled.
(10BA) Without prejudice to paragraphs (1) and (7), no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used on a road, a vehicle propelled by a compression ignition engine, if the vehicle is in such a condition and running on such fuel that Part II of Schedule 7B applies to the vehicle.
(10BB) Paragraph (10BA) shall not apply to—
(a) a vehicle if, at the date that the engine was manufactured, that engine was incapable of meeting the requirements specified in that paragraph;
(b) a vehicle being driven to a place where it is to undergo repairs;
(c) an exempt vehicle within the meaning given by paragraph (12)(a);
(d) engineering plant, an industrial tractor or a works truck; and
(e) a vehicle in Class III, IV, V , VI or VII within the meaning of the Motor Vehicles (Tests) Regulations 1981 and first used before 1st August 1979.
(10BC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(10C) For the purposes of this regulation—
(a) any rotary piston engine shall be deemed to be a four-stroke engine; and
(b) “rotary piston engine” means an engine in which the torque is provided by means of one or more rotary pistons and not by any reciprocating piston.
(11) Subject to Schedule 7XA, in this regulation, a reference to a vehicle to which an item in Table II applies is a reference to a vehicle which–
(a) is of a class specified in that item in column (2) of that Table,
(b) is first used on or after the date specified in that item in column (3) of that Table, and
(c) is not exempted by the entry in that item in column (5) of that Table.
and for the purposes of determining whether a vehicle is a vehicle to which any item numbered 8 or more  in that Table applies, regulation 4(2) shall be disregarded
(11A) In this regulation, “passenger car” means a motor vehicle which—
(a) is constructed or adapted for use for the carriage of passengers and is not a goods vehicle;
(b) has no more than five seats in addition to the driver’s seat; and
(c) has a maximum gross weight not exceeding 2,500kg.
(12) In Table II and paragraphs (10B) and (10BB)–
(a) “exempt vehicle” means–
(i) a vehicle with less than 4 wheels,
(ii) a vehicle with a maximum gross weight of less than 400 kg,
(iii) a vehicle with a maximum speed of less than 25 km/h, or
(iv) an agricultural motor vehicle;
(b) “direct injection” means a fuel injection system in which the injector communicates with an open combustion chamber or the main part of a divided combusion chamber.
(c) “indirect injection” means a fuel injection system in which the injector communicates with the subsidiary part of a divided combustion chamber.
(d) a reference in column (5) to a vehicle complying with an item is a reference to a vehicle that complies with the provisions specified in that item in column (4) whether the vehicle is or is not within the class of vehicles to which that item applies and any instrument mentioned in that item shall for the purposes of the reference have effect as if it applied to the vehicle in question (whether it would otherwise have done so or not).

Table I(regulation 61(3))

1
 2 3 4
Item Class of vehicle Requirements Exemptions
1 Vehicles propelled by a
compression ignition engine and equipped with a device designed to facilitate
starting the engine by causing it to be supplied with excess fuel. Provision shall be made to ensure the device cannot
readily be operated by a person inside the vehicle. 
(a) a work truck;
(b) a vehicle on which the device is so designed
and maintained that— 
(i) its use after the engine has started
cannot cause the engine to be supplied with excess fuel, or
(ii) it does not cause any increase in the
smoke or visible vapour emitted from the vehicle.
2 
Vehicles first used on or after 1st April 1973 and propelled by a compression
ignition engine. The engine of the vehicle
shall be of a type for which there has been issued by a person authorised
by the Secretary of State a type test certificate in accordance with the British
Standard Specification for the Performance of Diesel Engines for Road Vehicles
published on 19th May 1971 under number BS AU 141a: 1971. In the case of an
agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor (other than an agricultural motor vehicle which is first used after 1st June
1986 and is driven at more than 20 mph) , a category T tractor (other than one which is first used after 1st June 1986 and is driven at more than 40 km/h), an industrial tractor, a works truck
or engineering plant, for the purposes of that Specification as to the exhaust
gas opacity, measurements shall be made with the engine running at 80% of
its full load over the speed range from maximum speed down to the speed at
which maximum torque occurs as declared by the manufacturer of the vehicle
for those purposes. 
(a) a vehicle manufactured before 1st April 1973 and propelled
by an engine known as the Perkins 6.354 engine;(b) a vehicle propelled by an engine having not more
than 2 cylinders and being an agricultural motor vehicle , not being a category T tractor (other than an agricultural motor vehicle which
is first used on or after 1st June 1986 and which is driven at more that 20
mph) , a category T tractor (other than one which is first used on or after 1st June 1986 and is driven at more than 40 km/h), an industrial tractor, a works truck or engineering plant.
3 
Vehicles first used on or after 1st January 1972 and propelled by a spark
ignition engine other than a 2-stroke engine. 
The engine shall be equipped with means sufficient to ensure that, while the
engine is running, any vapours or gases in the engine crank case, or in any
other part of the engine to which vapours or gases may pass from that case,
are prevented, so far as is reasonably practicable, from escaping into the
atmosphere otherwise than through the combustion chamber of the engine. (a) a two-wheeled
motor cycle with or without a sidecar attached;...(c)a vehicle to which any item in Table II applies.
. . .   

TABLE II(regulation 61(3A), (3C), (7), (11) and (12))
(1) Item (2) Class of Vehicle (3) Date of First Use (4) Design, construction and equipment requirements
   (a) Instrument (b) Place in instrument where requirements are stated
     (5) Vehicles exempted from requirements (6) Emitted substances
1 Vehicles propelled by a spark ignition engine. 1st October 1982 Community Directive 78/665or
                      ECE Regulation 15.03 Annex I, paragraphs 3 and 5.Paragraphs 5, 8 and 11. 
(a) A vehicle whose maximum gross weight exceeds 3,500 kg;
(b) A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 2, 4, 5, 8, 11, 12 or 13;
(c) A vehicle whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(d) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons and oxides of nitrogen.
2 All vehicles. 1st April 1991 Community Directive 83/351or
                      ECE Regulation 15.04 Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8.Paragraphs 5, 8 and 12. 
(a) A vehicle propelled by a compression ignition engine and whose maximum gross weight exceeds 3,500 kg;
(b) A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 4, 5, 8, 11, 12 or 13;
(c) A vehicle within the meaning given by Article 1 of Community Directive 88/77 and which complies with the requirements of item 6, 9, or 10;
(d) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(e) A vehicle whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(f) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons and oxides of nitrogen.
3 Industrial tractors, works trucks and engineering plant propelled in each case by a compression ignition engine. 1st April 1993 
                  ECE Regulation 49 Paragraphs 5 and 7. A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 6, 9, 10, 11, 12 or 13. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons and oxides of nitrogen.
4 Passenger vehicles which—
(a) are constructed or adapted to carry not more than 5 passengers excluding the driver, and
(b) have a maximum gross weight of not more than 2,500 kg, not being off-road vehicles. 1st April 1991 Community Directive 88/76orCommunity Directive 89/458or
                      ECE Regulation 83 Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8.Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8.Paragraphs 5, 8 and 13. 
(a) A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 2, 8, 11, 12 or 13;
(b) A vehicle whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(c) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons and oxides of nitrogen.
5 Vehicles which are not of a description specified in this column in item 4 but which—
(a) are propelled by a spark ignition engine and have a maximum gross weight of not more than 2,000 kg,or
(b) are propelled by a compression ignition engine and have a maximum gross weight of more than 3,500 kg. 1st April 19921st April 1991 Community Directive 88/76or
                      ECE Regulation 83 Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8.Paragraphs 5, 8 and 13. 
(a) A vehicle within the meaning given by Article 1 of Community Directive 88/77 and which complies with the requirements of item 6, 9, 10, 11, 12 or 13;
(b) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(c) A vehicle whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(d) A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 8;
(e) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons and oxides of nitrogen.
6 All vehicles propelled by compression ignition engines. 1st April 1991 Community Directive 88/77or
                      ECE Regulation 49.01 Annex I, paragraphs 6, 7 and 8.Paragraphs 5, 6 and 7. 
(a) A vehicle whose maximum gross weight is less than 3,500 kg and which complies with the requirements of item 2;
(b) A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 4, 5, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 or 13;
(c) A fire appliance which is first used before 1st October 1992;
(d) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(e) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons and oxides of nitrogen.
7 Passenger vehicles which—
(a) are constructed or adapted to carry not more than 5 passengers excluding the driver,
(b) have a maximum gross weight of not more than 2,500 kg, and
(c) are propelled by a compression ignition engine of the indirect injection type. 1st April 1991 Community Directive 88/436 Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8 as far as they relate to particulate emissions. 
(a) A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 8, 11, 12 or 13;
(b) A vehicle whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(c) An off-road vehicle;
(d) An exempt vehicle. Particulates.
8 All vehicles. 31st December 1992 Community Directive 91/441or
                      ECE Regulation 83.01 Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8.Paragraphs 5, 8 and 13. 
(a) A vehicle within the meaning given by Article 1 of Community Directive 88/77 and which—
(i) complies with the requirements of item 6 and is first used before 1st October 1993, or
(ii) complies with the requirements of item 9, 10, 11, 12 or 13;
(b) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(c) A vehicle whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(d) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, oxides of nitrogen and particulates.
9 All vehicles propelled by a compression ignition engine. 1st October 1993 Community Directive 91/542or
                      ECE Regulation 49.02 Annex I, paragraphs 6, 7 and 8 (excluding line B in the Tables in sub-paragraphs 6.2.1 and 8.3.1.1).Paragraphs 5, 6 and 7 (excluding line B in the Tables in sub-paragraphs 5.2.1 and 7.4.2.1). 
(a) A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 8, 10, 11, 12 or 13;
(b) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(c) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, oxides of nitrogen and particulates.
10 All vehicles propelled by a compression ignition engine. 1st October 1996 Community Directive 91/542or
                      ECE Regulation 49.02 Annex I, paragraphs 6, 7 and 8 (excluding line A in the Tables in sub-paragraphs 6.2.1 and 8.3.1.1).Paragraphs 5, 6 and 7 (excluding line A in the Tables in sub-paragraphs 5.2.1 and 7.4.2.1). 
(a) A vehicle which complies with the requirements of item 8, 11, 12 or 13;
(b) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(c) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, oxides of nitrogen and particulates.
11 All vehicles. 1st October 1994 Community Directive 93/59  or ECE Regulation 83.02 Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8. 
(a) A vehicle within the meaning given by Article 1 of Community Directive 88/77 and which complies with the requirements of items 9, 10, 12 or 13;
(b) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(c) Vehicles whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(d) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, oxides of nitrogen and particulates.
12 All vehicles. 1st January 1997 Community Directive 94/12  or ECE Regulation 83.03 Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8. 
(a) A vehicle within the meaning given by Article 1 of Community Directive 88/77 and which complies with the requirements of items 9, 10, 11 or 13;
(b) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(c) Vehicles whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(d) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, oxides of nitrogen and particulates.
13 All vehicles. 1st October 1997 Community Directive 96/69  or ECE Regulation 83.04 Annex I, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8. 
(a) A vehicle within the meaning given by Article 1 of Community Directive 88/77 and which complies with the requirements of items 9, 10, or 12;
(b) A vehicle as defined in column 2 of item 14;
(c) An industrial tractor, works truck or engineering plant;
(d) Vehicles whose maximum speed is less than 50 km/h;
(e) An exempt vehicle. Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, oxides of nitrogen and particulates.
14 Vehicles falling within
(a) Class II or III, as specified in the Annex to Community Directive 96/69, of category N1, or
(b) Category M and specified in footnote (2) of that Annex.Note: references to categories M and N1 are to those categories as specified in Annex II of the Framework Directive. 1st October 1998 Community Directive 96/69 or ECE Regulation 83.04 Annex 1, paragraphs 5, 7 and 8.  Carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, oxides of nitrogen and particulates.
61A 

(1) This regulation shall apply to motor vehicles first used on or after 1st January 2001.
(2) Subject to paragraphs (5) to (7) and Schedule 7XA, a motor vehicle in any category shall comply with such design, construction and equipment requirements and such limit values as may be specified for a motor vehicle of that category and weight by any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 of the Table and from such date as is specified by that Community Directive.
(3) Subject to paragraphs (4) to (7) and Schedule 7XA, no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a motor vehicle if the motor vehicle does not comply with such limit values as may apply to it by virtue of any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 of the Table, and from such date as is specified by that Community Directive, unless the following conditions are satisfied with respect to it—
(a) the failure to meet the limit values does not result from an alteration to the propulsion unit or exhaust system of the motor vehicle;
(b) neither would those limit values be met nor the emissions of gaseous and particulate pollutants and smoke and evaporative emissions be materially reduced if maintenance work of a kind which would fall within the scope of a normal periodic service of the vehicle were carried out on the motor vehicle; and
(c) the failure to meet those limit values does not result from any device designed to control the emission of gaseous and particulate pollutants and smoke and evaporative emissions which is fitted to the motor vehicle being other than in good and efficient working order.
(4) Where—
(a) a motor vehicle is fitted with a device of the kind referred to in sub-paragraph (c) of paragraph (3);
(b) the motor vehicle does not comply with the limit values applying to it which are referred to in that paragraph; and
(c) the conditions specified in sub-paragraphs (a) and (b) of paragraph (3) are satisfied in respect of the motor vehicle
nothing in paragraph (3) shall prevent the motor vehicle being driven to a place where the device is to be repaired or replaced.
(5) Subject to paragraph (6), if the Secretary of State has exempted any motor vehicle produced in a small series from one or more of the provisions of a Community Directive specified in item 1 of the Table in accordance with the procedure in Article 8(2)(a) of the Framework Directive then paragraphs (2) to (4) shall not apply to that motor vehicle insofar as it has been so exempted.
(6) If any motor vehicle has been exempted from one or more of the provisions of a Community Directive specified in item 1 of the Table in accordance with paragraph (5), then in the Table as it applies to that motor vehicle there shall be deemed to be substituted, for the reference to Community Directive 96/69/EC or ECE Regulation 83.04, Community Directive 98/69/EC and 1999/102/EC–
(a) in the case of passenger cars as defined in regulations 61(11A), a reference to Community Directive 94/12/EC or ECE Regulation 83.03; and
(b) in the case of other motor vehicles of category M, a reference to Community Directive 93/59/EEC or ECE Regulation 83.02
and in any such case paragraphs (2) to (4) shall apply to the motor vehicle as if they referred to the substituted Community Directives or ECE Regulations.
(7) If a vehicle has, in accordance with Schedule 7XA, been exempted from the need to comply with any provision of a Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table (“the exempted provision”), it shall, in substitution for the exempted provision, comply with the equivalent provision (if any) that would have applied by virtue of this regulation in relation to such a vehicle immediately before the coming into force of the requirement to comply with the exempted provision; and in relation to that equivalent provision paragraphs 2 to 4 shall apply as if they referred to the Community Directive under which that equivalent provision arose.
(8) In this regulation—
(a) “category” means a category for the purpose of Annex II of the Framework Directive;
(b) “date as is specified” means, in relation to any vehicle and—
(i) in relation to limit values set by a Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table, the date specified by that Community Directive as that from which Member States are required to prohibit the registration or the entry into service of that vehicle if it does not comply with those limit values; or
(ii) in relation to emission control and monitoring systems and devices, the date specified by a Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table as that from which Member States are required to ensure that such equipment is fitted to that vehicle,
provided that, where a Community Directive specified in item 2 in the Table re-enacts a requirement imposed by a Community Directive that had been specified in that item immediately before 9th November 2006, the date as is specified shall be the date that had been specified by that previous Directive;
(c) “limit values” means the permitted amounts of gaseous and particulate pollutants and smoke and evaporative emissions;
(d) “small series” means the motor vehicles within a family of types as defined in Annex XII of the Framework Directive which are registered or enter into service in a period of twelve months beginning on 1st January in any year where the total number of motor vehicles does not exceed the small series limits specified in that Annex.
(9) Regulation 4(2) does not apply to any requirement imposed on a vehicle by or under this Regulation.
(Regulation 61A)
Item Community Directive or ECE Regulation Amending Community Directive or ECE Regulation
1. 70/220/EEC 96/69/EC or ECE Regulation 83.0498/69/EC1999/102/EC2001/1/EC
2.  2005/55/EC or ECE Regulation 49.02 2005/78/EC2006/51/EC
61B. 

(1) Subject to paragraphs (7), (8), (9) and (10) and Schedule 7XA, this regulation applies to vehicles set out in Article 2 of Directive 2006/40, regardless of their date of manufacture.
(2) Regulation 4(2) does not apply in relation to a vehicle to which this regulation applies.
(3) A vehicle type approved on or after 1st January 2011 may not be retrofitted with an air conditioning system designed to contain high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases.
(4) On or after 1st January 2017, a vehicle may not be retrofitted with an air conditioning system designed to contain high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases.
(5) A vehicle type approved on or after 1st January 2011 may not be fitted with an air conditioning system containing high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases.
(6) On or after 1st January 2017, a vehicle may not be fitted with an air conditioning system containing high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases.
(7) Paragraph (5) does not apply to a vehicle where—
(a) it was type approved on or after 1st January 2011, and
(b) on the date it was type approved, it was not prevented from being fitted with an air conditioning system containing high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases by any pre-requisite for type approval imposed by—
(i) the 1988 Act or any regulations made under it, except for this regulation;
(ii) the Road Traffic (Northern Ireland) Order 1981 or any regulations made under it; or
(iii) the Vehicle Approval Regulations.
(8) Paragraph (6) does not apply to a vehicle where—
(a) it was registered on or after 1st January 2017, and
(b) on the date it was registered, it was not prevented from being fitted with an air conditioning system containing high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases by any pre-requisite for registration imposed by—
(i) the 1988 Act or any regulations made under it, except for this regulation;
(ii) the Road Traffic (Northern Ireland) Order 1981 or any regulations made under it; or
(iii) the Vehicle Approval Regulations.
(9) Paragraph (6) does not apply to a vehicle where—
(a) it was used for the first time on a road in Great Britain on or after 1st January 2017 (this date not being determined, for the purposes of this sub-paragraph, in accordance with regulation 3(3)), and
(b) on the date it was first used, it was not prevented from being fitted with an air conditioning system containing high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases by any pre-requisite for use imposed by—
(i) the 1988 Act or any regulations made under it, except for this regulation;
(ii) the Road Traffic (Northern Ireland) Order 1981 or any regulations made under it; or
(iii) the Vehicle Approval Regulations.
(10) Paragraph (6) does not apply to a vehicle which before 1st January 2017 was fitted with an air conditioning system containing high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases.
(11) For the purposes of this regulation, a vehicle was type approved if—
(a) there has been issued in relation to it—
(i) an EC type approval certificate under regulation 4(5) of the EC Whole Vehicle Type Approval Regulations;
(ii) an EC type approval certificate under a provision of the law of any EEA State which corresponds to regulation 4(5) of the EC Whole Vehicle Type Approval Regulations;
(iii) an EC type approval certificate under regulation 13(3) of the Vehicle Approval Regulations;
(iv) an EC type approval certificate under a provision of the law of any EEA State which corresponds to regulation 13(3) of the Vehicle Approval Regulations;
(v) a type approval certificate under section 55 of the 1988 Act; or
(vi) a Minister’s Approval certificate under section 58(1) of the 1988 Act; or
(vii) a certificate under section 58(4) of the 1988 Act by reason of the vehicle conforming with another vehicle in respect of which a Minister’s Approval Certificate was issued under section 58(1) of that Act.
(12) In this regulation—
 “air conditioning system” means any system whose main purpose is to decrease the air temperature and humidity of the passenger compartment of a vehicle;
 “high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases” means fluorinated greenhouse gases having a global warming potential higher than 150, “fluorinated greenhouse gases” has the same meaning as in Article 3(5) of Community Directive 2006/40, and “global warming potential” has the same meaning as in Article 3(8) (including the footnote) of Community Directive 2006/40, read in conjunction with the second sentence of Article 3(9) (including the footnote) of the same Directive;
 “retrofitted” means fitted to a vehicle after it has been first used.
61C. 

(1) The requirements in articles 4 to 6 and 10 and Annex 1 of European Community Regulation 715/2007 shall—
(a) in relation to complete end-of-series vehicles—
(i) of category N1 class II and III, and
(ii) of category N2 having a reference mass not exceeding 2,610 kilograms,
be deemed to be fulfilled for the period beginning with the relevant date and ceasing at the end of 31st December 2012;
(b) in relation to end-of-series completed multi-stage build vehicles of category N1 class I, be deemed to be fulfilled for the period beginning with the relevant date and ceasing at the end of 30th June 2012;
(c) in relation to end-of-series completed multi-stage build vehicles—
(i) of category N1 class II and III, and
(ii) of category N2 having a reference mass not exceeding 2,610 kilograms,
be deemed to be fulfilled for the period beginning with the relevant date and ceasing at the end of 30th June 2013.
(2) The requirements in articles 4 to 6 and 8 and Annex I of European Community Regulation 595/2009 shall—
(a) for category N2 end-of-series vehicles having a reference mass exceeding 2,610 kilograms, and
(b) category N3 end-of-series vehicles,
be deemed to be fulfilled, in relation to complete vehicles, for the period beginning with the relevant date and ceasing at the end of 30th December 2014, or in the case of completed multi-stage build vehicles, beginning with the relevant date and ceasing at the end of 29th June 2015.
(3) For the purpose of paragraphs (1) and (2), a vehicle is an end-of-series vehicle if—
(a) three months or more before the relevant date, a certificate of conformity or a Minister’s approval certificate issued under section 58(4) of the 1988 Act was in force for the vehicle, and the Minister’s approval certificate issued under section 58(1) of that Act or type approval certificate (as the case may be) had been issued by virtue of an emissions requirement that—
(i) then applied to the vehicle, but
(ii) apart from this regulation, would have ceased to apply on the relevant date, and
(b) it is in the territory of an EEA state on the relevant date.
(4) In this regulation—
 “category N1 class I” means a motor vehicle with at least 4 wheels designed or constructed for the carriage of goods and having a reference mass not exceeding 1,305 kilograms;
 “category N1 class II” means a motor vehicle with at least 4 wheels designed or constructed for the carriage of goods and having a reference mass exceeding 1,305 kilograms but not exceeding 1,760 kilograms;
 “category N1 class III” means a motor vehicle with at least 4 wheels designed or constructed for the carriage of goods and having a reference mass exceeding 1,760 kilograms;
 “category N2” and “category N3” have the respective meanings given in Annex II to Directive 2007/46/EC;
 “complete vehicle” means any vehicle which need not be completed in order to meet the relevant technical requirements of Directive 2007/46/EC;
 “completed multi-stage build vehicle” means a vehicle resulting from the process of multi-stage type-approval which meets the relevant technical requirements of Directive 2007/46/EC;
 “reference mass” has the meaning given in Article 3(3) of European Community Regulation 715/2007;
 “relevant date” means—
(i) in relation to vehicles to which paragraph (1) applies, the date on which the Road Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment No. 2) Regulations 2011 come into force, and
(ii) in relation to vehicles to which paragraph (2) applies, 31st December 2013.
61D. 

(1) The Secretary of State must from time to time—
(a) carry out a review of regulations 61 to 61B, which relate to emissions,
(b) set out the conclusions of the review in a report, and
(c) publish the report.
(2) In carrying out the review the Secretary of State must, so far as is reasonable, have regard to how, in so far as they make provision in relation to emissions—
(a) the Framework Directive, and
(b) Directives 70/220/EEC, 88/77/EEC, 2005/55/EC and 2006/40/EC,
which are implemented by means of various provisions in these Regulations and by the Road Vehicles (Approval) Regulations 2009, are implemented in other Member States.
(3) The report must in particular—
(a) set out the objectives intended to be achieved by the regulatory system established by these Regulations to the extent that they relate to emissions,
(b) assess the extent to which those objectives are achieved, and
(c) assess whether those objectives remain appropriate and, if so, the extent to which they could be achieved with a system that imposes less regulation.
(4) The first report under this regulation must be published before the end of the period of five years beginning with 14th January 2012.
(5) Reports under this regulation are afterwards to be published at intervals not exceeding five years.
62 

(1) No wheeled
vehicle first used after 15th January 1931 shall be equipped with any closet
or urinal which can discharge directly on to a road.
(2) Every
tank into which a closet or urinal with which a vehicle is equipped empties,
and every closet or urinal which does not empty into a tank, shall contain
chemicals which are non-inflammable and non-irritant and provide an efficient
germicide.
63 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (4), this regulation applies to—
(a) invalid
carriages;
(b) heavy
motor cars, motor cars and motor cycles, not being agricultural motor vehicles
or pedestrian-controlled vehicles;
(c) agricultural motor vehicles, not being category T tractors, driven at more than 20 mph;
(ca) category T tractors driven at more than 40 km/h; and
(d) trailers.

(2) Subject
to paragraphs (3) and (5), every vehicle to which this regulation applies
shall be equipped with wings or other similar fittings to catch, so far as
practicable, mud or water thrown up by the rotation of its wheels or tracks.

(3) The requirements
specified in paragraph (2) apply, in the case of a trailer with more than
two wheels, only in respect of the rearmost two wheels.
(4) Those
requirements do not apply in respect of—
(a) a
works truck;
(b) a
living van;
(c) a
water cart;
(d) an
agricultural trailer drawn by a motor vehicle which is not driven at a speed
in excess of 40 km/h;
(e) an
agricultural trailed appliance;
(f) an
agricultural trailed appliance conveyor;
(g) a
broken down vehicle;
(h) a
heavy motor car, motor car or trailer in an unfinished condition which is
proceeding to a workshop for completion;
(i) a
trailer used for or in connection with the carriage of round timber and the
rear wheels of any heavy motor car or motor car drawing a semi-trailer so
used; or
(j) a
trailer drawn by a motor vehicle the maximum speed of which is restricted
to 20 mph or less under Schedule 6
to the 1984 Act.
(5) Instead
of complying with paragraph (2) a vehicle may comply with Community Directive 78/549.
64 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), this regulation applies to every wheeled goods
vehicle which is—
(a) a
motor vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1986 having a maximum gross
weight exceeding 12,000 kg;
(b) a
trailer manufactured on or after 1st May 1985 having a maximum gross weight
exceeding 3500 kg; or
(c) a
trailer, whenever manufactured, having a maximum gross weight exceeding 16,000
kg and 2 or more axles.
(2) This regulation
does not apply to—
(a) a
motor vehicle so constructed that the driving power of its engine is, or can
by use of its controls be, transmitted to all the wheels on at least one front
axle and on at least one rear axle;
(b) a
motor vehicle of which no part which lies within the specified area is less
than 400 mm vertically above the ground when the vehicle is standing on reasonably
flat ground;
(c) a
works truck;
(d) a
works trailer;
(e) a
broken down vehicle;
(f) a
motor vehicle which has a maximum speed not exceeding 30 mph;
(g) a
vehicle of a kind specified in sub-paragraphs (b), (c), (d), (e),
(f), (g), (h), (j), (k), (o) or (p) of regulation 51(2);

(h) a
vehicle specially designed, and not merely adapted, for the carriage and mixing
of liquid concrete; or
(i) a
vehicle which is being driven or towed to a place where by previous arrangement
a device is to be fitted so that it complies with the requirements specified
in paragraph (3).
(2A) This regulation shall not apply to a vehicle fitted with a spray-suppression system in accordance with the requirements of Annex III of Community Directive 91/226(3) if the spray suppression devices with which the vehicle is equipped are legibly and permanently marked with a designated approval mark.
(3) A vehicle
to which this regulation applies and which is of a class specified in an item
in column 2 of the Table shall not be used on a road on or after the date
specified in column 3 in that item, unless it is fitted in relation to the
wheels on each of its axles, with such containment devices as satisfy the
technical requirements and other provisions about containment devices specified
in the British Standard Specification, provided that in the case of a containment
device fitted before 1st January 1985 the said requirements shall be deemed
to be complied with if that containment device substantially conforms to those
requirements.

TABLE(regulation 64(3))

1 
2 3
Item Class of Vehicle 
Date
1 A trailer manufactured before 1st January 1975 1st October 1987
2 A trailer manufactured
on or after 1st January 1975 but before 1st May 1985 1st October 1986

3 A trailer manufactured on or after
1st May 1985 1st May 1985
4 
A motor vehicle 1st April 1986
(4) In this
regulation—
 “the British Standard Specification” means—


(a) in relation to a containment device fitted before 1st May 1987, Part 1a of the amended Specification and Part 2 of the original Specification; and
(b) in relation to a containment device fitted on or after 1st May 1987, Part 1a and Part 2a of the amended Specification;
 “designated approval mark” means the marking designated as an approval mark by regulation 5 of the Approval Marks Regulations and shown at item 30 in Schedule 4 to those Regulations;
 “the original Specification” means the British Standard Specification for Spray Reducing Devices for Heavy Goods Vehicles published under the reference BS AU 200: Part 1: 1984 and BS AU 200; Part 2: 1984;
 “the amended Specification” means the original Specification as amended and published under the reference BS AU 200: Part 1a: 1986 and BS AU 200: Part 2a: 1986;
 “containment device” means any device so described in the original Specification or the amended Specification;
 “the specified area”
means the area formed by the overall length of the vehicle
and the middle 80% of the shortest distance between the inner edges of any
two wheels on opposite sides of the vehicle (such distance being ascertained
when the vehicle is fitted with suitable tyres inflated to a pressure recommended
by the manufacturer, but excluding any bulging of the tyres near the ground)
.
(5) Nothing
in this regulation derogates from any requirement specified in regulation 63.
65 
Every part of every containment device with which a vehicle is
required to be fitted by the provisions of regulation 64
shall at all times when the vehicle is on a road be maintained free from any
obvious defect which would be likely to affect adversely the effectiveness
of the device.
PART III
66 

(1) This regulation
applies to—
(a) a wheeled
heavy motor car or motor car first used on or after 1st January 1968 not being—

(i) a dual-purpose
vehicle;
(ii) an agricultural
motor vehicle;
(iii) a
works truck;
(iv) a pedestrian-controlled
vehicle; ...
(v) save as
provided in sub-paragraph (b) below, a
passenger vehicle; or
(vi) a vehicle which is exempt from section 63(1) of the Road Traffic Act 1988 by virtue of regulation 14(6) of the Motor Vehicles (Approval) Regulations 1996.
(b) a bus (whether
or not it is an articulated bus) first used on or after 1st April 1982;
(c) a wheeled
locomotive or motor tractor first used on or after 1st April 1973 not being—

(i) an agricultural
motor vehicle;
(ii) an industrial
tractor;
(iii) a
works truck;
(iv) engineering
plant; or
(v) a pedestrian-controlled
vehicle;
(d) a wheeled
trailer manufactured on or after 1st January 1968 which exceeds 1020 kg in
weight unladen not being—
(i) a trailer
not constructed or adapted to carry any load, other than plant or special
appliances or apparatus which is a permanent or essentially permanent fixture,
and not exceeding 2290 kg in total weight;
(ii) a living
van not exceeding 2040 kg in weight unladen and fitted with pneumatic tyres;

(iii) a
works trailer;
(iv) a trailer
mentioned in regulation 16(3)(b) to (g);
or
(v) a trailer
which was manufactured and used outside Great Britain before it was first
used in Great Britain; and
(e) a converter
dolly manufactured on or after 1st January 1979.
(2) Every vehicle
to which this regulation applies shall be equipped with a plate securely attached
to the vehicle in a conspicuous and readily accessible position which either—

(a) contains the
particulars required, in the case of a motor vehicle by Part I of Schedule 8 or, in the
case of a trailer, by Part II
of that Schedule, and complies with the provisions of Part III of that Schedule; or

(b) complies with
the requirements specified in the Annex to Community Directive 78/507
or, in the case of a vehicle first used before 1st October 1982, in the Annex to Community Directive 76/114,
such requirements being in any case modified as provided in paragraph (3).

(3) Instead of the
particulars required by items 2.1.4 to 2.1.7 of that Annex, the plate required
by paragraph (2)(b) shall show, for a vehicle
of a class specified in column 2 of the Table against an item of that Annex
so specified in column 1, the following particulars—
(a) the maximum
permitted weight for that class, if any, shown in column 3 of the Table;
(b) where the
maximum weight shown in column 4 of the Table exceeds the maximum permitted
weight, the maximum weight in a column on the plate to the right of the maximum
permitted weight; and
(c) if no weight
is shown in column 3 of the Table, the maximum weight shown in column 4 of
the Table, in the right hand column of the plate.

TABLE(regulation 66(3))

1 2 3 4

Item in Annex to Directive 
Class of vehicle Maximum
permitted weight Maximum
weight

2.1.4 (Laden weight of vehicle) (i) Motor
vehicles The maximum gross weight in
Great Britain referred to in item 10 in Part I of Schedule
8. The
maximum gross weight referred to in item 7 in Part I of Schedule 8
.
 (ii) Trailers, other
than semi-trailers The maximum gross
weight in Great Britain referred to in item 8 in Part II of Schedule
8. The
maximum gross weight referred to in item 6 in Part II of Schedule
8.
 (iii) Semi-trailers  The maximum gross weight referred to in item 6 in Part II of Schedule 8.

2.1.5 (Train weight of motor
vehicle) Motor vehicles constructed to
draw a trailer The lower of—(a) the maximum train weight referred to in item 8 in Part I of Schedule 8;
and(b) the maximum laden weight specified, in the case
of vehicles constructed to form part of an articulated vehicle, in regulation 77, and, in other cases,
in regulation 76.
 The maximum train weight referred to
in item 8 in Part I of Schedule 8.

2.1.6 (Axle weight
of vehicle) (i) Motor vehicles The maximum weight in Great Britain for each axle
referred to in item 9 in Part I of Schedule 8
. The
maximum weight for each axle referred to in item 6 in Part I of Schedule 8
.
 (ii) Trailers 
The maximum weight in Great Britain for each axle referred to in item 7 in Part II of Schedule 8.
 The maximum weight for each axle referred
to in item 4 in Part II of Schedule
8.

2.1.7 (Load imposed by semi-trailer) 
Semi-trailers  The maximum load imposed on the drawing vehicle referred to in item 5 in Part II of Schedule 8.

(4) Part III of Schedule 8 applies
for determining the relevant weights to be shown on a plate in accordance
with this regulation.
(5) Where, in accordance with the provisions of this regulation and of Schedule 8, a motor vehicle first used, or a trailer manufactured, after 31st December 1998, is required to be equipped with a plate showing the maximum gross weight in Great Britain or the maximum weight in Great Britain for each axle of the vehicle, the plate may instead show particulars of the maximum authorised weight for the vehicle or, as the case may be, the maximum authorised weight for each axle of the vehicle.
(6) In paragraph (5) the references to the maximum authorised weight for a vehicle and maximum authorised for each axle of a vehicle mean those weights determined in accordance with the Motor Vehicles (Authorised Weight) Regulations 1998.
(7) The plate for a vehicle which falls within paragraph (1)(a) and which is a motor vehicle first used after 31st December 1998 need not include the particulars referred to in paragraph 9 or 10 of Part I of Schedule 8.
(8) In Great Britain a maximum gross weight of 18000 kg may be displayed on the plate of a motor vehicle with two axles which falls within sub-paragraph (1)(b) and which first came into use after 31st December 1998 where the maximum gross weight determined in accordance with the Motor Vehicles (Authorised Weight) Regulations 1998 exceeds 18000 kg.
67 

(1) This regulation
applies to a wheeled vehicle which is first used on or after 1st April 1980
and to which the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations apply.
(2) A vehicle to which
this regulation applies shall be equipped with a plate which is in a conspicuous
and readily accessible position, is affixed to a vehicle part which is not
normally subject to replacement and shows clearly and indelibly—
(a) the vehicle
identification number in accordance with the requirements specified—

(i) in the
case of a vehicle first used before 1st April 1987, in 
paragraphs 3.1.1 and 3.1.2 of the Annex to Community Directive 76/114/EEC
; or
(ii) in any
case, in sections 3 and 4 of the Annex
to Community
Directive 78/507/EEC;
(b) the name of
the manufacturer; and
(c) the approval
reference number of either—
(i) the type
approval certificate which relates to the vehicle model or the model variant
of the vehicle model, as the case may be, issued in accordance with the provisions
of regulation 9(1) of, and Part I of Schedule 3
to, the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations; or
(ii) the
Minister's approval certificate which relates to the vehicle, issued in accordance
with the provisions of regulation 9(2)
of, and Part
1A of Schedule 4 to, the said Regulations.
Provided that the information
required under sub-paragraph (c) above
may be shown clearly and indelibly on an additional plate which is fitted
in a conspicuous and readibly accessible position and which is affixed to
a vehicle part which is not normally subject to replacement.
(3) The vehicle identification
number of every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be marked on
the chassis, frame or other similar structure, on the off side of the vehicle,
in a clearly visible and accessible position, and by a method such as hammering
or stamping, in such a way that it cannot be obliterated or deteriorate.
68 

(1) Save as provided
in paragraph (3) below, every wheeled agricultural trailed appliance manufactured
on or after 1st December 1985 shall be equipped with a plate affixed to the
vehicle in a conspicuous and readily accessible position and which is clearly
and indelibly marked with the particulars specified in paragraph (2) below.

(2) Those particulars
are—
(a) the name of
the manufacturer of the appliance;
(b) the year in
which the appliance was manufactured;
(c) the maximum
gross weight;
(d) the unladen
weight; and
(e) the maximum
load which would be imposed by the appliance on the drawing vehicle.
(3) In the case of
a towed roller consisting of several separate rollers used in combination,
a single plate shall satisfy the requirement specified in paragraph (2) above.

69 

(1) This regulation
applies to every motor cycle first used on or after 1st August 1977 which
is not—
(a) propelled
by an internal combustion engine with a cylinder capacity exceeding 150 cc
if the vehicle was first used before 1st January 1982 or 125 cc if it was
first used on or after 1st January 1982;
(b) a mowing machine;
or
(c) a pedestrian-controlled
vehicle.
(2) Every vehicle
to which this regulation applies shall be equipped with a plate which is securely
affixed to the vehicle in a conspicuous and readily accessible position and
which complies with the requirements of Schedule 9.

70 

(1) Every ... vehicle
to which the Plating and Testing Regulations apply and in respect of which
a plating certificate has been issued shall, from the date specified in paragraph
(2), be equipped with a Ministry plate securely affixed, so as to be legible
at all times, in a conspicuous and readily accessible position, and in the
cab of the vehicle if it has one.
(2) That date is in
the case of—
(a) a vehicle
to which the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations apply, the date
of the fourteenth day after the plate was issued; or
(b) any other
vehicle, the date by which it is required, by the said Regulations, to be
submitted for examination for plating.
(3) In these Regulations “Ministry plate” means a plate which–
(a) is issued by the Secretary of State following the issue or amendment of a plating certificate; and
(b) subject to paragraph (4), contains the particulars required by Schedule 10, 10A, 10B or 10C.
(4) Instead of particulars of the gross weight, train weight and axle weights of the vehicle to which it relates, a Ministry plate may contain particulars of the maximum authorised weight for the vehicle, maximum authorised weight for a combination of which the vehicle forms part and maximum authorised axle weights for the vehicle, determined in accordance with the Road Vehicles (Authorised Weight) Regulations 1998 and the form of the plate shall be amended accordingly.
70A 

(1) This regulation applies to every vehicle to which regulation 36A or 36B applies and which is fitted with a speed limiter.
(2) Every vehicle to which this regulation applies shall be equipped with a plate which meets the requirements specified in paragraph (3).
(3) ... the requirements are that the plate is in conspicuous position in the driving compartment of the vehicle and is clearly and indelibly marked with the speed at which the speed limiter has been set.
70B 

(1) This regulation applies to a vehicle which is not a goods vehicle fitted in accordance with regulation 70 with a Ministry plate containing the particulars required by Schedule 10A or 10C and which is either—
(a) a bus or a heavy motor car and which was manufactured after 31st May 1998; or
(b) a trailer used in combination with a vehicle falling within paragraph (a) and manufactured after 31st May 1998.
(2) A vehicle to which this regulation applies shall not be used unless—
(a) the vehicle is equipped with a plate securely attached to the vehicle in a conspicuous and readily accessible position and containing the particulars as to the dimensions of the vehicle specified in Annex III of Community Directive 96/53/EC; or
(b) those particulars are included in the particulars shown on the plate with which the vehicle is equipped in accordance with regulation 66.
71 

(1) This regulation
applies to a vehicle (other than an agricultural motor vehicle which is either
a track-laying vehicle not exceeding 3050 kg in unladen weight or a wheeled
vehicle) which is—
(a) a locomotive;

(b) a motor tractor;

(c) a bus  which is registered under the 1971 Act (or any enactment repealed thereby)
...; or

(d) an unbraked
wheeled trailer, other than one mentioned in regulation 16(3)(b), (bb), (bc), (c), (d), (e), (f), or (g).

(2) There shall be
plainly marked in a conspicuous place on the outside of a vehicle to which
this regulation applies, on its near side—
(a) if it is a
vehicle falling in paragraph (1)(a), (b), or (c), its
unladen weight; and
(b) if it is a
vehicle falling in paragraph (1)(d), its
maximum gross weight.
71A 

(1) This regulation applies to a trailer that—
(a) is not a motor vehicle;
(b) is manufactured on or after 1st January 1997; and
(c) has a maximum total design axle weight not exceeding 750 kg.
(2) The year of manufacture of every trailer to which this regulation applies shall be marked on the chassis, frame or other similar structure on the nearside of the vehicle, in a clearly visible and accessible position, and by a method such as hammering or stamping, in such a way that it cannot be obliterated or deteriorate.
72 

(1) This regulation
applies to every goods vehicle to which the Plating and Testing Regulations
apply and for which a plating certificate has been issued.
(2) Without prejudice
to the provisions of regulation 70,
any weight which by virtue of regulation 80
may not be exceeded in the case of a goods vehicle to which this regulation
applies may be marked on either side, or on both sides, of the vehicle.
(3) Where at any time
by virtue of any provision contained in regulation 75
a goods vehicle to which this regulation applies may not be used in excess
of a weight which is less than the gross weight which may not be exceeded
by that vehicle by virtue of regulation 80,
the first mentioned weight may be marked on either side, or on both sides,
of the vehicle.
(4) Where at any time
by virtue of any provision contained in regulation 76 and 77
a goods vehicle to which this regulation applies is drawing, or being drawn
by, another vehicle and those vehicles may not be used together in excess
of a laden weight applicable to those vehicles by virtue of any such provision,
that weight may be marked on either side, or on both sides, of that goods
vehicle.
73 

(1) Every Ministry
test date disc which is issued, following the issue of a goods vehicle test
certificate, in respect of a trailer to which the Plating and Testing Regulations
apply and for which a plating certificate has been issued shall be carried
on the trailer in a legible condition and in a conspicuous and readily accessible
position in which it is clearly visible by daylight from the near side of
the road, from the date of its issue until but not beyond the date of expiry
of that test certificate or the date of issue of a further test certificate
for that trailer, whichever date is the earlier.
(2) In this regulation “Ministry
test date disc” means a plate issued
by the Secretary of State for a goods vehicle, being a trailer, following
the issue of a goods vehicle test certificate for that trailer under the Plating
and Testing Regulations and containing the following particulars— 
(a) the identification
mark allotted to that trailer and shown in that certificate;

(b) the
date until which that certificate is valid; and

(c) the
number of the vehicle testing station shown in that certificate.
74 

(1) Subject to the
conditions specified in paragraph (2), the following persons are hereby empowered
to test and inspect the brakes, silencers, steering gear and tyres of any
vehicle, on any premises where that vehicle is located—
(a) a police constable
in uniform;
(b) a person appointed
by the Commissioner of Police of the Metropolis to inspect public carriages
for the purpose of the Metropolitan Public Carriage Act
1869;
(c) a person appointed
by the police authority or local policing body for a police area to act for the purposes of section 53 of the 1972 Act;
(d) a goods vehicle
examiner as defined in section 56
of the 1972 Act;
(e) a certifying
officer as defined in section 7(1)
of the 1981 Act; and
(f) a public service
vehicle examiner appointed as mentioned in section 7(2)
of the 1981 Act.
(2) Those conditions
are—
(a) any person
empowered as there mentioned shall produce his authorisation if required to
do so;
(b) no such person
shall enter any premises unless the consent of the owner of those premises
has first been obtained;
(c) no such person
shall test or inspect any vehicle on any premises unless—
(i) the owner
of the vehicle consents thereto;
(ii) notice
has been given to that owner personally or left at his address not less than
48 hours before the time of the proposed test or inspection, or has been sent
to him at least 72 hours before that time by the recorded delivery service
to his address last known to the person giving the notice; or
(iii) the
test or inspection is made within 48 hours of an accident to which section 25 of the 1972 Act applies
and in which the vehicle was involved.
(3) For the purposes
of this regulation, the owner of the vehicle shall be deemed to be in the
case of a vehicle—
(a) which is for
the time being registered under the 1971 Act, and is not being used under
a trade licence under that Act the person appearing as the owner of the vehicle
in the register kept by the Secretary of State under that Act;
(b) used under
a trade licence, the holder of the licence; or
(c) exempt from
excise duty by virtue of the Motor Vehicles (International
Circulation) Order 1975, the person resident
outside the United Kingdom who has brought the vehicle into Great Britain;
and in cases (a) and (b) the address of the owner as shown on the said
register or, as the case may be, on the licence may be treated as his address.

PART IV
A
75 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), the laden weight of a vehicle of a class specified
in an item in column 2 of the Table shall not exceed the maximum permitted
laden weight specified in that item in column 3.
(2) The maximum
permitted laden weight of a vehicle first used before 1st June 1973 which
falls in item 1 or 2 shall not be less than would be the case if the vehicle
fell in item 9.

TABLE(regulation 75(1))

1 2
 3
Item Class of vehicle 
Maximum permitted laden weight
  (kg)
1 A wheeled heavy motor car or motor car which is not described
in items  1A, 2,  4 or 5 and which complies with the relevant braking requirement
 (see regulation 78(3) to (6) in relation to buses) The weight determined in accordance with Part I of Schedule 11
1A A wheeled heavy motor car or motor car which is not described initem 2, 4, or 5, which complies with the relevant braking requirementand in which—
(a) every driving axle not being a steering axle is fitted with twin tyres; and
(b) either every driving axle is fitted with road friendly suspension or no axle has an axle weight exceeding 9,500kg. The weight determined in accordance with Part IA of Schedule 11
2 A wheeled heavy motor car or motor car (not being
an agricultural motor vehicle) which forms part of an articulated vehicle
and which complies with the relevant braking requirement The weight specified in column (5) in Part II of Schedule
11 in the item which is appropriate having
regard to columns (2), (3) and (4) in that Part
3 A wheeled trailer,
including a composite trailer, but not including a semi-trailer, which is
drawn by a motor tractor, heavy motor car or motor car which complies with
the relevant braking requirement, other than a trailer described in items
6, 7, 8 or 11 As for
item 1
4 An articulated bus (see regulation 78(3) to (5)) 27,000
5 
A wheeled agricultural motor vehicle 
As for item 1, but subject to a maximum of 24,390
6 A balanced agricultural
trailer, as defined in paragraph (4),
which is not described in items 8, 11 or 16 
As for item 1, but subject to a maximum of 18,290
7 An unbalanced
agricultural trailer, as defined in paragraph (4)
which is not described in items 8, 11 or 16 
18,290 inclusive of the weight imposed by the trailer on the drawing vehicle

8 A wheeled trailer manufactured on or after 27th February 1977 and
fitted with brakes which automatically come into operation on the over-run
of the trailer (whether or not it is fitted with any other brake), except
an agricultural trailer which is being drawn by an agricultural motor vehicle,
which complies with the requirements specified in items 3, 14 and 17 of Schedule 3
and of which the brakes can be applied either by the driver of the drawing
vehicle or by some other person on that vehicle or on the trailer 3,500
9 
A wheeled heavy motor car or motor car not described in items 1, 2, 4 or 5—

 (a) with not more than
4 wheels 14,230
 (b) with more than 4 but not more than 6 wheels 20,330
 
(c) with more than 6 wheels 
24,390
10 A wheeled trailer not described in items 3, 6, 7, 8 or 11
having less than 6 wheels, and not forming part of an articulated vehicle;
and an agricultural trailed appliance 14,230
11 A trailer manufactured before 27th February 1977
and having no brakes other than—(i) a parking
brake and(ii) brakes which come into operation on the
overrun of the trailer 
3,560
12 A wheeled locomotive, not described in item 5, which
is equipped with suitable and sufficient springs between each wheel and the
vehicle's frame and with a pneumatic tyre or a tyre of soft or elastic material
fitted to each wheel—
 
(a) if having less than 6 wheels 
22,360
 (b) if having
6 wheels 26,420
 
(c) if having more than 6 wheels 
30,490
13 A track-laying locomotive with resilient material interposed
between the rims of the weight-carrying rollers and the road so that the weight
of the vehicle (other than that borne by any wheels and the portion of the
track in contact with the road) is supported by the resilient material. 22,360
14 A locomotive
not described in items 5, 12 or 13 20,830
15 A track-laying heavy motor car or motor car 22,360
16 A track-laying
trailer 13,210
(3) The maximum
total weight of all trailers, whether laden or unladen, drawn at any one time
by a locomotive shall not exceed  44,000 kg.
(3A) Nothing in item 1 or 1A of the Table shall prevent a vehicle being used on a road if—
(a) a plating certificate in respect of the vehicle was in force immediately before the 1st January 1993; and
(b) the laden weight of the vehicle does not exceed the weight shown in that certificate as being the weight not to be exceeded in Great Britain.
(4) In this Part of these Regulations and in Schedule 11—
 “air spring” means a spring operated by means of air or other compressible fluid under pressure;
 “air suspension” means a suspension system in which at least 75 per cent of the spring effect is caused by an air spring.
 “balanced agricultural trailer”
 means an agricultural trailer the whole
of the weight of which is borne by its own wheels; and
 “unbalanced agricultural trailer”
 means an agricultural trailer of which
some, but not more than 35%, of the weight is borne by the drawing vehicle
and the rest of the weight is borne by its own wheels.
(5) For the purposes of this Part of these Regulations and Schedule 11, an axle shall be regarded as fitted with a road friendly suspension if its suspension is—
(a) an air suspension, or
(b) a suspension, not being an air suspension, which is regarded as being equivalent to an air suspension for the purposes of Community Directive 92/7.
(6) For the purposes of this Part of these Regulations and Schedule 11, an axle shall be regarded as fitted with twin tyres if it would be regarded as fitted with twin tyres for the purposes of Community Directive 92/7.
76 

(1) The total
laden weight of a motor vehicle and the trailer or trailers (other than semi-trailers)
drawn by it shall not, in a case specified in an item in column 2 of the Table,
exceed the maximum permitted train weight specified in that item in column
3.
(1A) This regulation is subject to Schedule 11A (exemptions relating to intermodal transport operations).
(2) In this regulation, the expressions “road friendly suspension”, “twin tyres” and “unbalanced agricultural trailer” shall be construed in accordance with regulation 75(4), (5) and (6).

TABLE(regulation 76(1))

1 2
 3
Item Vehicle Combination 
Maximum permitted train weight
  (kg)
1  A wheeled trailer which is drawn by a wheeled motor tractor, heavy motor car (not being in any case an agricultural motor vehicle), where—
(a) the combination has a total of 4 axles and is being used for international transport; and
(b) the drawing vehicle is a vehicle which was first used on or after 1st April 1973 and complies with the relevant braking requirement 35,000
1A  A wheeled trailer which is drawn by a wheeled motor tractor, heavy motor car or motor car (not being in any case an agricultural motor vehicle), where the combination has a total of 4 axles and the following conditions are satisfied in relation to the drawing vehicle, namely—
(a) it was first used on or after 1st April 1973;
(b) it complies with the relevant braking requirement;
(c) every driving axle not being a steering axle is fitted with twin tyres; and
(d) every driving axle is fitted with road friendly suspension 35,000
1AA  A wheeled trailer which is drawn by a wheeled motor tractor, heavy motor car or motor car (not being in any case an agricultural motor vehicle), where the combination has a total of 5 or more axles and the following conditions are satisfied in relation to the drawing vehicle, namely—
(a) it was first used on or after 1st April 1973;
(b) it complies with the relevant braking requirement;
(c) every driving axle not being a steering axle is fitted with twin tyres; and
(d) either every driving axle is fitted with road friendly suspension or no axle has an axle weight exceeding 8,500kg 38,000
1B  A wheeled trailer, not being part of a combination described in items 1, 1A or 1AA which is drawn by a wheeled motor tractor, heavy motor car or motor car (not being in any case an agricultural motor vehicle), where—
(a) the trailer is fitted with power–assisted brakes which can be operated by the driver of the drawing vehicle and are not rendered ineffective by the non– rotation of its engine; and
(b) the drawing vehicle is equipped with a warning device so placed as to be readily visible to the driver of the vehicle and which is capable of indicating any impending failure of, or deficiency in, the vacuum or pressure system 32,520
1C 
A wheeled trailer which is of a description specified in item 8 in the Table of regulation 75 drawn by a wheeled motor tractor, heavy motor car or motor car (not being in any case an agricultural motor vehicle), the drawing vehicle being a vehicle which—
(a) was first used on or after 1st April 1973; and(b) complies with the relevant braking requirement 29,500
2 
A wheeled agricultural motor vehicle drawing a wheeled unbalanced agricultural
trailer, if the distance between the rearmost axle of the trailer and the
rearmost axle of the drawing vehicle does not exceed 2.9 m 20,000
2A A category T tractor drawing one wheeled agricultural trailer (other than (i) an agricultural trailed appliance conveyor or (ii) a wheeled unbalanced agricultural trailer where the distance between the rearmost axle of the unbalanced trailer and the rearmost axle of the drawing vehicle is 2.9 m or less). 31,000
3 A wheeled trailer or trailers
drawn by a wheeled motor tractor, heavy motor car, motor car or agricultural
motor vehicle, not being a combination of vehicles mentioned in items 1 , 1A,  1AA, 1B, 1C, 2 or 2A 24,390
4 
A track-laying trailer drawn by a motor tractor, heavy motor car or motor
car, whether wheeled or track-laying and a wheeled trailer, drawn by a track-laying
vehicle being a motor tractor, heavy motor car or motor car 22,360
77 

(1) Except
as provided in paragraph (2), the laden weight of an articulated vehicle of
a class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table shall not exceed the
weight specified in column 3 in that item.

TABLE(regulation 77(1))

1 
2 3
Item Class of vehicle 
Maximum permitted laden weight
  (kg)
1 An articulated
vehicle which complies with the relevant braking requirement. Whichever is the lower of—(a) the weight specified in column (3) of Part III of Schedule 11
in the item in which the spacing between the rearmost axles of the motor vehicle
and the semi-trailer is specified in column (2), ...; and(b) if the vehicle is of a description
specified in an item in column (2) of Part IV of Schedule
11, the weight specified in column (3) of that
item
2 An articulated vehicle which does not comply with the relevant
braking requirement if the trailer has—
 
(a) less than 4 wheels 20,330

 (b) 4 wheels or more 24,390
(2) This regulation
does not apply to an agricultural motor vehicle, an agricultural trailer or
an agricultural trailed appliance.
(2A) This regulation is subject to Schedule 11A (exemptions relating to intermodal transport operations).
(3) In Part IV of Schedule 11, “road friendly suspension” and “twin tyres” shall be construed in accordance with regulation 75(5) and (6).
78 

(1) The weight
transmitted to the road by one or more wheels of a vehicle as mentioned in
an item in column 2 of the Table shall not exceed the maximum permitted weight
specified in that item in column 3.
(2) The Parts
of the Table have the following application—
(a) Part I applies to wheeled heavy
motor cars, motor cars and trailers which comply with the relevant braking
requirement and to wheeled agricultural motor vehicles, agricultural trailers
and agricultural trailed appliances; items 1(b)
and 2 also apply to buses;
(b) Part II applies to wheeled heavy
motor cars, motor cars and trailers which do not fall in Part I;
(c) Part III applies to wheeled locomotives;
and
(d) Part IV applies to track-laying
vehicles.

TABLE(regulation 78(1))
PART I(wheeled heavy motor cars, motor cars and trailers which comply
with the relevant braking requirement and wheeled agricultural motor vehicles,
agricultural trailers and agricultural trailed appliances; and, in respect
of items 1(b) and 2, buses)
1 
2 3
Item Wheel criteria 
Maximum permitted weight
  (kg)
1 Two wheels in line
transversely each of which is fitted with a wide tyre or with two pneumatic
tyres having the centres of their areas of contact with the road not less
than 300 mm apart, measured at right angles to the longitudinal axis of the
vehicle—
 (a) if the wheels
are on the sole driving axle of a motor vehicle  not being a bus, 10,500
 
(b) if the vehicle is a bus which has 2 axles and of which the
weight transmitted to the road surface by its wheels is calculated in accordance
with regulation 78(5),
 10,500
 (c) in any other case 10,170

2 Two wheels in line transversely otherwise
than as mentioned in item 1 
9,200
3 More than two wheels in line transversely—
 (a) in the case of a vehicle manufactured before
1st May 1983  where  the wheels are on one axle of a group of ... closely spaced
axles ..., 10,170
 
(b) in the case of a vehicle manufactured on or after 1st May 1983,
 10,170
 (c) in any other case 11,180
4 One wheel not transversely in line with any other
wheel—
 (a) if the wheel
is fitted as described in item 1, 5,090
 (b) in any other
case 4,600
PART II(wheeled heavy motor cars, motor cars and trailers
not failing in Part I)

1 2 3
Item Wheel criteria Maximum permitted weight
  (kg)
5 More
than two wheels transmitting weight to a strip of the road surface on which
the vehicle rests contained between two parallel lines at right angles to
the longitudinal axis of the vehicle—
 
(a) less than 1.02 m apart, 
11,180
 (b) 1.02 m or more apart
but less than 1.22 m apart, 
16,260
 (c) 1.22 m or
more apart but less than 2.13 m apart 18,300

6 Two wheels in line transversely 9,200

7 One wheel, where no other wheel is
in the same line transversely. 4,600
PART III(wheeled locomotives)
1 2 3
Item Wheel criteria Maximum permitted weight
  (kg)
8 Two wheels
in line transversely (except in the case of a road roller, or a vehicle with
not more than four wheels first used before 1st June 1955) 11,180
9 Any two wheels in the case
of a wheeled locomotive having not more than four wheels first used before
1st June 1955  , not being— 
(a) a road roller;
(b) an agricultural motor vehicle (other than a category T tractor) which is driven at or below 20 mph; or
(c) a category T tractor which is driven at or below 40 km/h. Three
quarters of the total weight of the locomotive.
PART IV(track-laying vehicles)
1 2 3
Item Wheel criteria Maximum permitted weight
  (kg)
10 
The weight of a heavy motor car, motor car or trailer transmitted to any strip
of the road surface on which the vehicle rests contained between two parallel
lines 0.6 m apart at right angles to the longitudinal axis of the vehicle
 10,170
11 Two wheels
in line—
 (a) heavy motor
cars or motor cars with 2 wheels, 8,130
 (b) heavy motor
cars or motor cars with more than 2 wheels 7,630
12 One wheel, where no other wheel is in the same line
transversely, on a heavy motor car or a motor car 4,070
(3) In the
case of an articulated bus, or, subject to paragraph (4), of a bus first used
before 1st April 1988, the laden weight, for the purposes of ... regulation 75,
and the weight transmitted to the road surface by wheels of the vehicle, for
the purposes of items 1 and 2 of the Table in this regulation, shall be calculated
with reference to the vehicle when it is complete and fully equipped for service
with—
(a) a
full supply of water, oil and fuel; and
(b) weights
of 63.5 kg for each person (including crew)—
(i) 
for whom a seat is provided in the position in which he may be seated; and

(ii) 
who may by or under any enactment be carried standing, the total of such weights
being reasonably distributed in the space in which such persons may be carried,
save that in the case of a bus (not being an articulated bus) only the number
of such persons exceeding 8 shall be taken into account.
(4) The weights
for the purposes referred to in paragraph (3) may, in the case of a bus to
which that paragraph applies, be calculated in accordance with paragraph (5)
instead of paragraph (3).
(5) In the
case of a bus first used on or after 1st April 1988, the weights for the purposes
referred to in paragraph (3) shall be calculated with reference to the vehicle
when it is complete and fully equipped for service with—
(a) a
full supply of water, oil and fuel;
(b) a
weight of 65 kg for each person (including crew)—
(i) 
for whom a seat is provided, in the position in which he may be seated; and

(ii) 
who may by or under any enactment be carried standing, the total of such weights
being reasonably distributed in the space in which such persons may be so
carried, save that in the case of a bus (not being an articulated bus) only
the number of such persons exceeding 4 shall be taken into account;
(c) all
luggage space within the vehicle but not within the passenger compartment
loaded at the rate of 100 kg per m3 or 10 kg per
person mentioned in sub-paragraph (b) above,
whichever is the less; and
(d) any
area of the roof of the vehicle constructed or adapted for the storage of
luggage loaded with a uniformly distributed load at the rate of 75 kg per
m2.
(6) Regulation 75 shall not apply to a two axle bus if—
(a) its laden weight as calculated in accordance with paragraph (5) does not exceed 17,000kg; and
(b) the distance between the two axles is at least 3.0m.
79 

(1) This regulation
applies to—
(a) a
wheeled motor vehicle which complies with the relevant braking requirement;

(b) a
wheeled trailer which is drawn by such a motor vehicle; and
(c) an
agricultural motor vehicle, an agricultural trailer and an agricultural trailed
appliance.
(2) Save as provided in paragraph (5), where a vehicle to which this regulation applies is of a description specified in an item in column 2 of Part V of Schedule 11 and has two closely-spaced axles, the total weight transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels of those axles shall not exceed the maximum permitted weight specified in column 3 of that item.
(3) Save as provided in paragraph (5), where a vehicle to which this regulation applies is of a description specified in an item in column 2 of Part VI of Schedule 11 and has three closely-spaced axles, the total weight transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels of those axles shall not exceed the weight specified in column 3.
(4) Save as provided by paragraph (5), where a vehicle is fitted with four or more closely-spaced axles, the weight transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels of those axles shall not exceed 24,000kg.
(5) Nothing
in paragraphs (2), (3) or (4) of this regulation shall apply so as to prevent
a vehicle first used before 1st June 1973 from being used on a road at a weight
as respects those axles at which it could be used if it fell within item 5
in the Table in regulation 78 and nothing in those paragraphs shall prevent a vehicle being used on a road if— 
(a) a plating certificate in respect of the vehicle was in force immediately before the 1st January 1993; and
(b) no axle has an axle weight exceeding the weight shown in that certificate as being the weight not to be exceeded in Great Britain for that axle.
(6) In Parts V and VI of Schedule 11, “air-suspension” “road friendly suspension” and “twin tyres” shall be construed in accordance with regulation 75(4), (5) and (6).
79A 
Nothing in regulations 75 to 79 shall be taken to prohibit the use of a vehicle in circumstances where the maximum authorised weight for the vehicle, for any vehicle combination of which the vehicle forms part and for any axle of the vehicle, as determined in accordance with the Road Vehicles (Authorised Weight) Regulations 1998, is not exceeded.
80 

(1) Subject
to   paragraphs (2),  (2B), (2C) and (4) , no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a
road a vehicle—
(a) fitted
with a plate in accordance with regulation 66,
but for which no plating certificate has been issued, if any of the weights
shown on the plate is equalled or exceeded;
(b) for
which a plating certificate has been issued, if any of the weights shown in
column (2) of the plating certificate is equalled or exceeded; or
(c) required
by regulation 68
to be fitted with a plate, if the maximum gross weight referred to in paragraph
(2)(c) of that regulation is equalled or exceeded.

(2) Where
any two or more axles are fitted with a compensating arrangement in accordance
with regulation 23
the sum of the weights shown for them in the plating certificate shall not
be equalled or exceeded. In a case where a plating certificate has not been issued the
sum of the weights referred to shall be that shown for the said axles in the
plate fitted in accordance with regulation 66.

(2A) Paragraph (1) shall not apply to a vehicle for which a plating certificate has been issued in the form set out in Schedule 10A or 10C where—
(a) the vehicle is being used for international transport; and
(b) none of the weights shown in column (3) of the plating certificate is equalled or exceeded.
(2B) Where both a train weight and a maximum train weight are shown in column (2) of a plating certificate issued for a motor vehicle, paragraph (1)(b) in so far as it relates to train weights shall not apply to the motor vehicle if—
(a) the motor vehicle is a wheeled heavy motor car drawing a wheeled trailer and the requirements set out in Part II of Schedule 11A are for the time being fulfilled; or
(b) the motor vehicle is comprised in an articulated vehicle and the requirements set out in Part III of Schedule 11A are for the time being fulfilled,
and the train weight of the motor vehicle does not equal or exceed the maximum train weight shown in column (2) of the certificate.
(3) Nothing
in regulations 75 to 79
 or in the Road Vehicles (Authorised Weight) Regulations 1998 shall permit any such weight as is mentioned in the preceding provisions of
this regulation to be equalled or exceeded and nothing in this regulation shall permit
any weight prescribed by regulations 75 to 79
 or in the Road Vehicles (Authorised Weight) Regulations 1998
in relation to the vehicle in question to be equalled or exceeded.
(4) Paragraph (1) shall not apply where a vehicle is used on a road before 1st January 2000 if–
(a) the vehicle is fitted with a plate in accordance with regulation 66(1)(b) and the maximum gross weight and the maximum weight for any axle of the vehicle are not exceeded; or
(b) there is in force a plating certificate for the vehicle that was issued before 1st January 1999 and the design weight of the vehicle is not exceeded; and
(c) in either case the maximum authorised weight for the vehicle, maximum authorised weight for a combination of which the vehicle forms part and maximum authorised weight for any axle of the vehicle, determined in accordance with the Road Vehicles (Authorised Weight) Regulations 1998, are not exceeded.
B
81 
For the purposes of this regulation, regulation 82 and Schedule 12—

(a) “lateral
projection”, in relation to a load carried by a vehicle,
means that part of the load which extends beyond a side
of the vehicle;
(b) 
the width of any lateral projection shall be measured between longitudinal
planes passing through the extreme projecting point of the vehicle on that
side on which the projection lies and that part of the projection furthest
from that point;
(c) 
references to a special appliance or apparatus, in relation to a vehicle,
are references to any crane or other special appliance or apparatus fitted
to the vehicle which is a permanent or essentially permanent fixture;
(d) “forward
projection” and “rearward projection”— 
(i) in relation to a load carried in such a manner that
its weight  is borne by  only one vehicle, mean respectively that part of the load
which extends beyond the foremost point of the vehicle and that part which
extends beyond the rearmost point of the vehicle;

(ii) in relation to a load carried in such a manner that part of its
weight  is borne by  more than one vehicle, mean respectively that part of the
load which extends beyond the foremost point of the foremost vehicle by which
the load is carried except where the context otherwise requires and that part
of the load which extends beyond the rearmost point of the rearmost vehicle
by which the load is carried; and

(iii) in relation to any special appliance or apparatus, mean respectively
that part of the appliance or apparatus which, if it were deemed to be a load
carried by the vehicle, would be a part of a load extending beyond the foremost
point of the vehicle and that part which would be a part of a load extending
beyond the rearmost point of the vehicle,
 and references in regulation 82
and Schedule
12 to a forward projection or to a rearward
projection in relation to a vehicle shall be construed accordingly;

(e) 
the length of any forward projection or of any rearward projection shall be
measured between transverse planes passing—
(i) 
in the case of a forward projection, through the foremost point of the vehicle
and that part of the projection furthest from that point; and
(ii) 
in the case of a rearward projection, through the rearmost point of the vehicle
and that part of the projection furthest from that point;In this and the foregoing sub-paragraph “vehicle” does not include any special appliance or apparatus or any part
thereof which is a forward projection or a rearward projection;

(f) 
references to the distance between vehicles, in relation to vehicles carrying
a load, are references to the distance between the nearest points of any two
adjacent vehicles by which the load is carried, measured when the longitudinal
axis of each vehicle lies in the same vertical plane.For the purposes of this sub-paragraph, in determining the nearest
point of two vehicles any part of either vehicle designed primarily for use
as a means of attaching the one vehicle to the other and any fitting designed
for use in connection with any such part shall be disregarded;
(g) 
references to a combination of vehicles, in relation to a motor vehicle which
is drawing one or more trailers, are references to the motor vehicle and the
trailer or trailers drawn thereby, including any other motor vehicle which
is used for the purpose of assisting in the propulsion of the trailer or the
trailers on the road;
(h) 
the overall length of a combination of vehicles shall be taken as the distance
between the foremost point of the drawing vehicle comprised in the combination
and the rearmost point of the rearmost vehicle comprised therein, measured
when the longitudinal axis of each vehicle comprised in the combination lies
in the same vertical plane;
(i) 
the extreme projecting point of a vehicle is the point from which the overall
width of the vehicle is calculated in accordance with the definition of overall
width contained in regulation 3(2);

(j) 
without prejudice to sub-paragraph (e)
the foremost or, as the case may be, the rearmost point of a vehicle is the
foremost or rearmost point from which the overall length of the vehicle is
calculated in accordance with the definition of overall length contained in regulation 3(2); and
(k) 
an agricultural, horticultural or forestry implement rigidly but not permanently
mounted on an agricultural motor vehicle, agricultural trailer or agricultural
trailed appliance, whether or not part of its weight is supported by one or
more of its own wheels, shall not be treated as a load, or special appliance,
on that vehicle.
82 

(1) 
No load shall be carried on a vehicle so that the overall width of the vehicle
together with the width of any lateral projection or projections of its load
exceeds 4.3m.
(2) 
Subject to the following provisions of this regulation, no load shall be carried
on a vehicle so that—
(a) 
the load has a lateral projection or projections on either side exceeding
305mm; or
(b) 
the overall width of the vehicle and of any lateral projection or projections
of its load exceeds 2.9m.Provided
that this paragraph does not apply to the carriage of—
(i) loose agricultural produce not baled or crated; or
(ii) an indivisible load if—(A) it is not reasonably practicable to comply with this paragraph
and the conditions specified in  paragraphs 1 and 5  of Schedule 12
are complied with; and(B) where the overall width of the vehicle together with the
width of any lateral projection or projections of its load exceeds 3.5m, the
conditions specified in paragraph 2 of Schedule 12
are complied with.
(3) 
Where a load is carried so that its weight rests on a vehicle or vehicles,
the length specified in paragraph (5) shall not exceed 27.4m.
(4) A load shall not be carried so that its weight is borne by a vehicle or vehicles if either—
(a) the length specified in paragraph (5) exceeds 18.65m; or
(b) the load is borne by a trailer or trailers and the length specified in paragraph (6) exceeds 25.9m,
unless the conditions specified in paragraphs 1 and 2 of Part I of Schedule 12 are complied with.
(5) 
The length referred to in paragraphs (3) and (4)(a)
 is—
(a) 
where the  weight of the load is borne by  a single vehicle, the overall length of the vehicle
together with the length of any forward and rearward projection of the load;

(b) 
where the  weight of the load is borne by  a motor vehicle and one trailer, whether or not forming
an articulated vehicle, the overall length of the trailer together with the
length of any projection of the load in front of the foremost point of the
trailer and of any rearward projection of the load; and
(c) 
in any other case, the overall length of all the vehicles  which bear the weight of the load, together with the length of any distance between them and of any forward
or rearward projection of the load.
(6) 
The length referred to in paragraph (4)(b)
is the overall length of the combination of vehicles, together with the length
of any forward or rearward projection of the load.
(7) 
Subject to the following provisions of this regulation no person shall use,
or cause or permit to be used, on a road a vehicle, not being a straddle carrier,
carrying a load or fitted with a special appliance or apparatus if the load,
appliance or apparatus has a forward projection of a length specified in an
item in column 2 of the Table, or rearward projection of a length specified
in an item in column 3, unless the conditions specified in that item in column
4 are complied with.

TABLE(regulation 82(7))

1 2 3 4
Item Length of forward projection Length of rearward projection Conditions to be complied with
   (a) (b)
   if the load consists of a racing boat propelled
solely by oars. in any other case
1 
Exceeding 1 m but not exceeding 2 m — Para 4 of Schedule 12 —
2 Exceeding 2
m but not exceeding 3.05 m 
— Para 4 of Schedule 12 Paras 2 and 3 of Schedule 12
3 
Exceeding 3.05 m —
 Paras 1 and 4 of Schedule 12 Paras 1, 2 and 3 of Schedule 12
4 — Exceeding 1 m but
not exceeding 2 m Para 4 of Schedule 12 Para 4 of Schedule 12
5 — Exceeding 2 m but
not exceeding 3.05 m Para 4 of Schedule 12 Para 3 of Schedule 12
6 — Exceeding 3.05 m Paras 1 and 4 of Schedule 12 Paras 1, 2 and 3 of Schedule 12
(8) 
Subject to the following provisions of this regulation, no person shall use,
or cause or permit to be used, on a road a straddle carrier carrying a load
if—
(a) 
the load has a rearward projection exceeding 1 m unless the conditions specified
in paragraph 4 of Schedule 12
are met;
(b) 
the load has a forward projection exceeding 2 m or a rearward projection exceeding
3m; or
(c) 
the overall length of the vehicle together with the length of any forward
projection and of any rearward projection of its load exceeds 12.2mProvided
that—
(i) sub-paragraph (a) does
not apply to a vehicle being used in passing from one part of private premises
to another part thereof or to other private premises in the immediate neighbourhood;

(ii) sub-paragraphs (b)
and (c) do not apply to a vehicle being
used as in proviso (i) above if—(A) the vehicle is not being driven at a speed exceeding
12 mph; and(B) where the overall length of the vehicle together with
the length of any forward projection and of any rearward projection of its
load exceeds 12.2m, the conditions specified in paragraphs 1 and 2 of Schedule 12
are complied with.
(9) 
Where another vehicle is attached to that end of a vehicle from which a projection
extends, then for the purposes of any requirement in this regulation to comply
with paragraph 3 or 4 of Schedule 12,
that projection shall be treated as a forward or rearward projection only
if, and to the extent that it extends beyond the foremost point or, as the
case may be, the rearmost point, of that other vehicle, measured when the
longitudinal axis of each vehicle lies in the same vertical plane.
(10) 
In the case of a vehicle being used—
(a) 
for fire brigadeScottish Fire and Rescue Serviceor, in England or Wales, fire and rescue authorityor, in England, fire and rescue authority... or police purposes or for defence purposes (including
civil defence purposes); 
(aa) for ambulance purposes or for the purpose of providing a response to an emergency at the request of an NHS ambulance service; or
(b) 
in connection with the removal of any obstruction to traffic,if compliance with any provision of this regulation would hinder
or be likely to hinder the use of the vehicle for the purpose for which it
is being used, that provision does not apply to that vehicle while it is being
so used.
(11) 
No person shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road an agricultural,
horticultural or forestry implement rigidly, but not permanently, mounted
on a wheeled agricultural motor vehicle, agricultural trailer, or agricultural
trailed appliance, whether or not part of its weight is supported by one or
more of its own wheels if—
(a) 
the overall width of the vehicle together with the lateral projection of the
implement exceeds  2.55m; or
(b) 
the implement projects more than 1m forwards or rearwards of the vehicle,
so however, that this restriction shall not apply in a case where—

(i) 
part of the weight of the implement is supported by one or more of its own
wheels; and
(ii) 
the longitudinal axis of the greater part of the implement is capable of articulating
in the horizontal plane in relation to the longitudinal axis of the rear portion
of the vehicle.
C
83 

(1) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a wheeled vehicle of a
class specified in an item in column 2 of the Table drawing a trailer, subject
to any exceptions which may be specified in that item in column 3.

TABLE(regulation 83(1))

1 2
 3
Item Class of vehicles 
Exceptions

1 A straddle carrier —
2 An invalid carriage —
3 An articulated
bus —
4 
A bus not being an articulated bus or a minibus (a) 1 broken down bus where
no person other than the driver is carried in either vehicle or(b)1 trailer
5 A locomotive 3 trailers
6 A motor tractor 1 trailer,2 trailers
if neither is laden
7 A heavy motor car or a motor car not described in
item 1, 3 or 4 2 trailers if one of them
is a towing implement and part of the other is secured to and either rests
on or is suspended from that implement1 trailer in
any other case
8 An agricultural motor vehicle 
(a) in respect of trailers other than agricultural
trailers and agricultural trailed appliances, such trailers as are permitted
under items 5, 6, or 7 above, as the case may be; or
(b) in respect of agricultural trailers and
agricultural trailed appliances— 
(i) 2 unladen agricultural trailers, or
(ii) 1 agricultural trailer and I agricultural
trailed appliance, or
(iii) 2 agricultural trailed appliances
(2) For the
purposes of items 5, 6 and 7 of the Table—
(a) an
unladen articulated vehicle, when being drawn by another motor vehicle because
it has broken down, shall be treated as a single trailer; and
(b) a
towed roller used for the purposes of agriculture, horticulture or forestry
and consisting of several separate rollers shall be treated as one agricultural
trailed appliance.
(3) No track-laying
motor vehicle which exceeds 8 m in overall length shall draw a trailer other
than a broken down vehicle which is being drawn in consequence of the breakdown.

(4) For the purpose of this regulation, the word “trailer” does not include a vehicle which is drawn by a steam powered vehicle and which is used solely for carrying water for the purpose of the drawing vehicle.
84 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used,
on a road a motor cycle—
(a) drawing
behind it more than one trailer;
(b) drawing
behind it any trailer carrying a passenger;
(c) drawing
behind it a trailer with an unladen weight exceeding 254 kg;
(d) with
not more than 2 wheels, without a sidecar, and with an engine capacity which
does not exceed 125 cc, drawing behind it any trailer; or
(e) with
not more than 2 wheels, without a sidecar and with an engine capacity exceeding
125 cc, drawing behind it any trailer unless—
(i) 
the trailer has an overall width not exceeding 1 m;
(ii) 
the distance between the rear axle of the motor cycle and the rearmost part
of the trailer does not exceed 2.5 m;
(iii) 
the motor cycle is clearly and indelibly marked in a conspicuous and readily
accessible position with its kerbside weight;
(iv) 
the trailer is clearly and indelibly marked in a conspicuous and readily accessible
position with its unladen weight; and
(v) 
the laden weight of the trailer does not exceed 150 kg or two thirds of the
kerbside weight of the motor cycle, whichever is the less.
(2) The provisions
of paragraph (1)(b), 
(d) and (e) do not apply if
the trailer is a broken down motorcycle and one passenger is riding it.
85 

(1) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a wheeled agricultural
motor vehicle drawing one or more wheeled trailers if the weight of the drawing
vehicle is less than a quarter of the weight of the trailer or trailers, unless
the brakes fitted to each trailer in compliance with 
regulation 15 or 16 are operated directly by
the service braking system fitted to the motor vehicle.
(2) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road, any motor vehicle drawing
an agricultural trailer of which—
(a) more
than 35% of the weight is borne by the drawing vehicle; or
(b) the
gross weight exceeds 14,230 kg, unless it is fitted with brakes as mentioned
in paragraph (1).
(3) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road an agricultural trailer
manufactured on or after 1st December 1985 which is drawn by a motor vehicle
first used on or after 1st June 1986 unless the brakes fitted to the trailer—

(a) in
accordance with regulation 15
can be applied progressively by the driver of the drawing vehicle, from his
normal driving position and while keeping proper control of that vehicle,
using a means of operation mounted on the drawing vehicle; or
(b) automatically
come into operation on the over-run of the trailer.
86 

(1) Where
a trailer is attached to the vehicle immediately in front of it solely by
means of a rope or chain, the distance between the trailer and that vehicle
shall not in any case exceed 4.5 m, and shall not exceed 1.5 m unless the
rope or chain is made clearly visible to any other person using the road within
a reasonable distance from either side.
(2) For the
purpose of determining the said distance any part of either vehicle designed
primarily for use as a means of attaching the one vehicle to the other and
any fitting designed for use in connection with any such part shall be disregarded.

86A 

(1) No person shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road a motor vehicle drawing one trailer if the trailer—
(a) is a trailer to which regulation 15 applies; and
(b) is not fitted with a device which is designed to stop the trailer automatically in the event of the separation of the main coupling while the trailer is in motion,
unless the requirements of paragraph (2) are met in relation to the motor vehicle and trailer.
(2) The requirements of this paragraph, in relation to a motor vehicle drawing a trailer, are that a secondary coupling is attached to the motor vehicle and trailer in such a way that, in the event of the separation of the main coupling while the trailer is in motion,—
(a) the drawbar of the trailer would be prevented from touching the ground; and
(b) there would be some residual steering of the trailer.
(3) No person shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road a motor vehicle drawing one trailer if—
(a) the trailer is a trailer to which regulation 15 applies;
(b) the trailer is fitted with a device which is designed to stop the trailer automatically in the event of the separation of the main coupling while the trailer is in motion;
(c) the operation of the device in those circumstances depends upon a secondary coupling linking the device to the motor vehicle; and
(d) the trailer is not also fitted with a device which is designed to stop the trailer automatically in those circumstances in the absence of such a secondary coupling,
unless the requirements of paragraph (4) are met in relation to the motor vehicle and trailer.
(4) The requirements of this paragraph, in relation to a motor vehicle drawing a trailer, are that the secondary coupling is attached to the motor vehicle and trailer in such a way that, in the event of the separation of the main coupling while the trailer is in motion, the device of the kind referred to in paragraph (3)(b) and (c) fitted to the trailer would stop the trailer.
(5) This regulation is without prejudice to any other provision in these Regulations.
86B 

(1) This regulation applies to every light passenger vehicle first used on or after 1st August 1998 in respect of which an EC certificate of conformity has effect.
(2) No person shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road any vehicle to which this regulation applies unless any mechanical coupling device which is attached to it complies with the relevant technical and installation requirements of Annexes I, V, VI and VII of Community Directive 94/20 and is marked in accordance with sub-paragraphs 3.3.4 to 3.3.5 of Annex I to that Directive.
(3) For the purposes of this regulation, in a case where a vehicle is drawing a trailer a mechanical coupling device shall not be regarded as being attached to that vehicle if it forms part of the trailer.
(4) In this regulation “mechanical coupling device” shall be construed in accordance with paragraph 2.1 of Annex I to Community Directive 94/20.
87 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used,
on a road an unbraked wheeled trailer if—
(a) its
laden weight exceeds its maximum gross weight; or
(b) it
is drawn by a vehicle of which the kerbside weight is less than twice the
sum of the unladen weight of the trailer and the weight of any load which
the trailer is carrying.
(2) This regulation
does not apply to—
(a) an
agricultural trailer; or
(b) a
trailer mentioned in   paragraph (b), (bb), (bc), (c), (d), (e), (f) or (g) of regulation 16(3).

88 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
89 
No person in charge of a motor vehicle, or trailer drawn thereby,
shall cause or permit such trailer to stand on a road when detached from the
drawing vehicle unless one at least of the wheels of the trailer is (or, in
the case of a track-laying trailer, its tracks are) prevented from revolving
by the setting of  a parking brake  or the use of a chain, chock or other efficient
device.
90 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used,
on a road any trailer for the carriage of passengers for hire or reward.
(2) The provisions
of paragraph (1) do not apply in respect of a wheeled trailer which is, or
is carrying, a broken down motor vehicle if—
(a) the
trailer is drawn at a speed not exceeding 30 mph; and
(b) where
the trailer is, or is carrying, a broken down bus, it is attached to the drawing
vehicle by a rigid draw bar.
(3) Save as
provided in paragraph (4), no person shall use, or cause or permit to be used,
on a road a wheeled trailer in which any person is carried and which is a
living van having either—
(a) less
than 4 wheels; or
(b) 4
wheels consisting of two close-coupled wheels on each side.
(4) The provisions
of paragraph (3) do not apply in respect of a trailer which is being tested
by—
(a) its
manufacturer;
(b) a
person by whom it has been, or is being, repaired; or
(c) a
distributor of, or dealer in, trailers.
91 

(1) The requirements
of section 34 of
the 1972 Act with regard to the employment of drivers and attendants shall
not apply in respect of the following vehicles—
(a) an
articulated vehicle;
(b) an
agricultural motor vehicle which is drawing an agricultural trailer or an
agricultural trailed appliance;
(c) a
trailer with not more than two wheels drawn by a motor car or a motor cycle
or a four-wheeled trailer having two close-coupled wheels on each side drawn
by a motor car;
(d) a
motor tractor drawing any—
(i) 
closed trailer specially constructed and used for the conveyance of meat between
docks and railway stations or between wholesale markets and docks or railway
stations;
(ii) 
machine or implement used for the purpose of the maintenance, repair or cleansing
of roads; or
(iii) 
refuse vehicle;
(e) a
works truck drawing any works trailer where the unladen weight of each vehicle
does not exceed 1525 kg;
(f) a
motor vehicle drawing a trailer which has no brakes other than a parking brake
and brakes which automatically come into operation on the overrun of the trailer;

(g) a
road roller;
(h) a
motor vehicle belonging to the Secretary of State for Defence and being used
for naval, military or air force purposes drawing a trailer fitted with brakes
which can be applied by the driver of the drawing vehicle;
(i) a
motor vehicle drawing a broken down vehicle, whether or not in consequence
of a breakdown, in such a manner that the broken down vehicle cannot be steered
by its own steering gear;
(j) a
motor vehicle drawing another vehicle in the exercise of a statutory power
of removal in such a manner that the vehicle being so drawn cannot be steered
by its own steering gear;
(k) a
motor vehicle which is drawing a towing implement not attached to any other
vehicle; or
(l) a
motor vehicle drawing a trailer or trailers where every such trailer is fitted
with power-assisted or power-operated brakes which can be operated by the
driver of the drawing vehicle and are not rendered ineffective by the non-rotation
of the engine of the drawing vehicle—
(i) 
where one such trailer is drawn; or
(ii) 
where two or more such trailers are drawn, if one attendant is carried on
either the drawing vehicle or a trailer for the purpose of attending to the
trailers.
(2) The requirements
of the said section 34 with regard to the employment of persons to drive or
attend a locomotive whilst being driven on a highway shall not apply in the
case of a locomotive propelled by the combustion of liquid fuel or by electrical
power, whether or not the locomotive is drawing a trailer or trailers.
(3) The provisions
of this regulation shall not be treated as prejudicing the operation of any
provision of regulation 82
in so far as it provides, in relation to the use of a vehicle on a road, for
compliance with the conditions specified in paragraph 2 of Schedule 12
(which relates to the employment of persons in attending to vehicles and their
load).
92 
Every sidecar fitted to a motor cycle shall be so attached that
the wheel thereof is not wholly outside the space between transverse planes
passing through the extreme projecting points at the front and at the rear
of the motor cycle.
93 
No person shall use or cause or permit to be used on a road any
two-wheeled motor cycle registered on or after 1st August 1981, not being
a motor cycle brought temporarily into Great Britain by a person resident
abroad, if there is a sidecar attached to the right (or off) side of the motor
cycle.
CA
93A 

(1) Subject to paragraph (5), no person shall use or cause or permit to be used a motor vehicle for the carriage or haulage of dangerous goods on a road if it is a vehicle within the meaning of the Framework Directive and—
(a) its maximum gross weight exceeds 16,000 kg; or
(b) it is drawing a trailer which has a maximum total design axle weight exceeding 10,000 kg,
unless the vehicle meets the requirements of paragraph (2).
(2) Subject to paragraph (6), in order for a motor vehicle to meet the requirements of this paragraph—
(a) it must not be drawing more than one trailer;
(b) without prejudice to regulation 15, it must be fitted with an anti-lock braking system that meets the requirements of paragraph (1) of marginal 220 521 of Appendix B.2 to Annex B to the ADR;
(c) it must be fitted with an endurance braking system (which may consist of one device or a combination of several devices) that meets the requirements of sub-paragraphs (a) to (d) of paragraph (2) of marginal 220 522 of Appendix B.2 to Annex B to the ADR;
(d) if it is not drawing a trailer, it must meet the requirements of the 4th, 5th, 6th and 7th sub-paragraphs of paragraph (2) of marginal 10 221 of Annex B to the ADR;
(e) without prejudice to regulation 15, if it is drawing a trailer with a maximum total design axle weight exceeding 10,000 kg—
(i) the trailer must be fitted with an anti-lock braking system that meets the requirements of paragraph (2) of marginal 220 521 of Appendix B.2 to Annex B to the ADR, and
(ii) the electrical connections between the motor vehicle and the trailer must meet the requirements of paragraph (3) of marginal 220 521 of Appendix B.2 to Annex B to the ADR;
(f) if it is drawing a trailer, the combination of vehicles must meet the requirements of the 4th, 5th, 6th and 7th sub-paragraphs of paragraph (2) of marginal 10 221 of Annex B to the ADR;
(g) if it is drawing a trailer fitted with an endurance braking system, the trailer must meet the requirements of paragraph (3) of marginal 220 522 of Appendix B.2 to Annex B to the ADR; and
(h) if it is drawing a trailer, the requirements of either paragraph (3) or (4) must be met.
(3) The requirements of this paragraph are that the motor vehicle meets the requirements of paragraph (2)(e) of marginal 220 522 of Appendix B.2 to Annex B to the ADR.
(4) The requirements of this paragraph are that the motor vehicle—
(a) does not contravene the restriction mentioned in sub-paragraph (f) of paragraph (2) of marginal 220 522 of Appendix B.2 to Annex B to the ADR; and
(b) meets the requirements of the second sentence of that sub-paragraph in relation to the trailer.
(5) Paragraph (1) does not apply to a motor vehicle manufactured before 1st January 1997.
(6) Sub-paragraph (e) of paragraph (2) does not apply to a trailer manufactured before 1st January 1997.
(7) For the purposes of this regulation, Annex B to the ADR (including the Appendices to that Annex) shall have effect as if—
(a) references to ECE Regulation 13 (however expressed) were references to ECE Regulation 13.06 or 13.07;
(b) references to Directive 71/320/EEC were references to Community Directive 91/422;
(c) references to the corresponding EEC Directive, in relation to Annex 5 to ECE Regulation 13, were references to paragraph 1.5 of Annex II to Community Directive 91/422.
(8) Subject to paragraph (9), a reference in this regulation to dangerous goods is a reference to a load comprising explosives of such type and in such quantity that it could not be carried by road in a single transport unit of Type I and II without there being a contravention of the restrictions set out in marginal 11 401 of Annex B to the ADR as read with marginal 11 402 of that Annex.
(9) For the purposes of paragraph (8)—
(a) marginal 11 402 of Annex B to the ADR shall have effect with the omission of the words “in conformity with the prohibitions of mixed loading contained in 11 403”; and
(b) “transport unit of Type I or II” means a transport unit of Type I or a transport unit of Type II as defined in marginal 11 204 of that Annex.
(10) In this regulation, “ADR” means the 1995 edition of the “European Agreement concerning the International Carriage of Dangerous Goods by Road (ADR)” produced by the Department of Transport and published by Her Majesty’s Stationery Office (ISBN 0-11-551265-9).
D
94 

(1) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a vehicle with a gas propulsion
system unless the whole of such system is in a safe condition.
(2) No person shall use, or cause or permit to be used, in any gas supply system for the propulsion of a vehicle when the vehicle is on a road any fuel except liquefied petroleum gas, hydrogen or natural gas.
(2A) No person may use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a vehicle that is fitted with a hydrogen fuel system or a natural gas fuel system unless—
(a) that vehicle has been approved under the Road Vehicles (Approval) Regulations 2020 for that system at the time of registration, or
(b) that vehicle meets the requirements in paragraph (2B) or (2C).
(2B) A vehicle meets the requirements of this paragraph if it—
(a) is designed and constructed, and not merely adapted, to be fuelled by hydrogen,
(b) complies with the Pressure Equipment (Safety) Regulations 2016,
(c) complies with Schedule 5A, and
(d) is one of the following vehicles—
(i) an agricultural motor vehicle;
(ii) engineering plant;
(iii) a works truck.
(2C) A vehicle meets the requirements of this paragraph if it—
(a) is designed and constructed, and not merely adapted, to be fuelled by hydrogen,
(b) complies with Parts I and II of ECE Regulation 134, 134.01 or 134.02,
(c) complies with Schedule 5A, and
(d) is a category T tractor.
(3) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a vehicle which is propelled
by gas unless the gas container in which such fuel is stored is on the motor
vehicle, and not on any trailer, and in the case of an articulated vehicle
on the portion of the vehicle to which the engine is fitted.
(4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
95 

(1) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, in or on a vehicle on a road any
gas-fired appliance unless the whole of such appliance and the gas system
attached thereto is in an efficient and safe condition.
(2) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, in any gas-fired appliance in or
on a vehicle on a road any fuel except liquefied petroleum gas as defined
in regulation 94(4).

(3) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, in or on a vehicle on a road any
gas-fired appliance unless the vehicle is so ventilated that—
(a) an
ample supply of air is available for the operation of the appliance;
(b) the
use of the appliance does not adversely affect the health or comfort of any
person using the vehicle; and
(c) any
unburnt gas is safely disposed of to the outside of the vehicle.
(4) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a vehicle in or on which
there is—
(a) one
gas-fired appliance unless the gas supply for such appliance is shut off at
the point where it leaves the container of containers at all times when the
appliance is not in use;
(b) more
than one gas-fired appliance each of which has the same supply of gas unless
the gas supply for such appliances is shut off at the point where it leaves
the container or containers at all times when none of such appliances is in
use; or
(c) more
than one gas-fired appliance each of which does not have the same supply of
gas unless each gas supply for such appliances is shut off at the point where
it leaves the container or containers at all times when none of such appliances
which it supplies is in use.
96 

(1) Subject
to paragraph (2), this regulation applies to every motor vehicle and trailer.

(2) Paragraphs
(3) and (4) do not apply to a vehicle constructed or adapted for the conveyance
of goods under controlled temperatures.
(3) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, in any vehicle to which this paragraph
applies, while the vehicle is in motion on a road, any gas-fired appliance
except—
(a) a
gas-fired appliance which is fitted to engineering plant while the plant is
being used for the purposes of the engineering operations for which it was
designed;
(b) a
gas-fired appliance which is permanently attached to a bus, provided that
any appliance for heating or cooling the interior of the bus for the comfort
of the driver and any passengers does not expose a naked flame on the outside
of the appliance; or
(c) in
any other vehicle, a refrigerating appliance or an appliance which does not
expose a naked flame on the outside of the appliance and which is permanently
attached to the vehicle and designed for the purpose of heating any part of
the interior of the vehicle for the comfort of the driver and any passengers.

(4) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, in any vehicle to which this paragraph
applies, while the vehicle is in motion on a road, any gas-fired appliance
to which—
(a) sub-paragraph
(3)(a) refers, unless the appliance complies
with the requirements specified in paragraphs 12 and 13 of Schedule 5
 and the gas system to which it is attached
complies with the requirements specified in paragraphs 2 to 9
and 15 of Schedule
5; or
(b) sub-paragraph
(3)(b) refers, unless the appliance complies
with the requirements specified in paragraphs 12, 13 and 14 of Schedule
5 and the gas system to which it is attached
complies with the requirements specified in paragraphs 2 to 9, 11 and 15 of Schedule 5;
or
(c) sub-paragraph
(3)(c) refers, unless the appliance complies—

(i) 
if it is fitted to a motor vehicle, with the requirements specified in paragraphs 12, 13 and 14 of Schedule 5;
and
(ii) 
in any other case, with the requirements specified in 
paragraphs 12 and 13 of Schedule 5;and the gas system to which the appliance is attached complies
with the requirements specified in paragraphs 2 to 9
and 15 of Schedule
5.
(5) No person
shall use, or cause or permit to be used, in a vehicle to which this regulation
applies which is in motion on a road any gas-fired appliance unless it is
fitted with a valve which stops the supply of gas to the appliance if the
appliance fails to perform its function and causes gas to be emitted.
DA
96A. 
No person shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on any vehicle or vehicle combination on a road, any aerodynamic devices and equipment, unless—
(a) they are used on the rear of the vehicle or vehicle combination, and
(b) the vehicle or vehicle combination is of a class specified in items 1, 3, 3A, 3C, 4, 4A, 4B, or 8 of the Table in regulation 7.
96B. 
No person shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road any vehicle or vehicle combination with an elongated cab unless the vehicle or vehicle combination is of a class specified in items 1, 3A, 3B, 3C or 4 of the Table in regulation 7.
E
97 
No motor vehicle shall be used on a road in such manner as to cause
any excessive noise which could have been avoided by the exercise of reasonable
care on the part of the driver.
98 

(1) Save as
provided in paragraph (2), the driver of a vehicle shall, when the vehicle
is stationary, stop the action of any machinery attached to or forming part
of the vehicle so far as may be necessary for the prevention of noise or of exhaust emissions.
(2) The provisions
of paragraph (1) do not apply—
(a) when
the vehicle is stationary owing to the necessities of traffic;
(b) so
as to prevent the examination or working of the machinery where the examination
is necessitated by any failure or derangement of the machinery or where the
machinery is required to be worked for a purpose other than driving the vehicle;
or
(c) in
respect of a vehicle propelled by gas produced in plant carried on the vehicle,
to such plant.
99 

(1) Subject
to the following paragraphs, no person shall sound, or cause or permit to
be sounded, any horn, gong, bell or siren fitted to or carried on a vehicle
which is—
(a) stationary
on a road, at any time, other than at times of danger due to another moving
vehicle on or near the road; or
(b) in
motion on a restricted road, between 23.30 hours and 07.00 hours in the following
morning.
(2) The provisions
of paragraph (1)(a) do not apply in respect
of the sounding of a reversing alarm when the vehicle to which it is fitted
is about to move backwards and its engine is running.
(3) No person
shall sound, or cause or permit to be sounded, on a road any reversing alarm
fitted to a vehicle—
(a) unless
the vehicle is a goods vehicle which has a maximum gross weight not less than
2000 kg, a bus, engineering plant,  a refuse vehicle, or a works truck; or
(b) if
the sound of the alarm is likely to be confused with a sound emitted in the
operation of a pedestrian crossing established, or having effect as if established,
under Part III
of the 1984 Act.
(4) Subject
to the provisions of the following paragraphs, no person shall sound, or cause
or permit to be sounded a gong, bell, siren or two-tone horn, fitted to or
otherwise carried on a vehicle (whether it is stationary or not).
(5) Nothing
in paragraph (1) or (4) shall prevent the sounding of—
(a) an
instrument or apparatus fitted to, or otherwise carried on, a vehicle at a
time when the vehicle is being used for one of the purposes specified in regulation 37(5) and it is necessary
or desirable to do so either to indicate to other road users the urgency of
the purposes for which the vehicle is being used, or to warn other road users
of the presence of the vehicle on the road; or
(b) a
horn (not being a two-tone horn), bell, gong or siren—
(i) 
to raise alarm as to the theft or attempted theft of the vehicle or its contents;
or
(ii) 
in the case of a bus, to summon help for the driver, the conductor or an inspector.

(6) Subject
to the provisions of section 62
of the Control
of Pollution Act 1974 and notwithstanding the
provisions of paragraphs (1) and (4) above, a person may, between 12.00 hours
and 19.00 hours, sound or cause or permit to be sounded an instrument or apparatus,
other than a two-tone horn, fitted to or otherwise carried on a vehicle, being
an instrument or apparatus designed to emit a sound for the purpose of informing
members of the public that the vehicle is conveying goods for sale, if, when
the apparatus or instrument is sounded, it is sounded only for that purpose.

(7) For the
purposes of this regulation the expressions which are referred to in regulation 37(10) have the meanings
there given to them and the expression “restricted road”
in paragraph (1) means a road which is a restricted
road for the purpose of section 81
of the 1984 Act.
F
100 

(1) A motor
vehicle, every trailer drawn thereby and all parts and accessories of such
vehicle and trailer shall at all times be in such condition, and the number
of passengers carried by such vehicle or trailer, the manner in which any
passengers are carried in or on such vehicle or trailer, and the weight, distribution,
packing and adjustment of the load of such vehicle or trailer shall at all
times be such, that no danger is caused or is likely to be caused to any person
in or on the vehicle or trailer or on a road.Provided that
the provisions of this regulation with regard to the number of passengers
carried shall not apply to a vehicle to which the Public Service Vehicles (Carrying Capacity) Regulations 1984
 apply.
(2) The load
carried by a motor vehicle or trailer shall at all times be so secured, if
necessary by physical restraint other than its own weight, and be in such
a position, that neither danger nor nuisance is likely to be caused to any
person or property by reason of the load or any part thereof falling or being
blown from the vehicle or by reason of any other movement of the load or any
part thereof in relation to the vehicle.
(3) No motor
vehicle or trailer shall be used for any purpose for which it is so unsuitable
as to cause or be likely to cause danger or nuisance to any person in or on
the vehicle or trailer or on a road.
100A 

(1) No person shall use, or cause or permit to be used, on a road a vehicle displaying the rectangular plate described in the definition of “low platform trailer” in the Table in regulation 3(2) or anything resembling such a plate at a speed exceeding 40 mph.
(2) No person shall use, or cause or permit to be used on a road a vehicle displaying the rectangular plate described in Schedule 13 (Plate for restricted speed vehicle) or anything resembling such a plate at a speed exceeding 50 mph.
101 

(1) Save
as provided in paragraph (2) no person shall, except with the except with
the permission of a police officer in a uniform, cause or permit any motor
vehicle to stand on a road at any time between ... sunset and
... sunrise unless the near side of the vehicle is as close
as may be to the edge of the carriageway.
(2) The provisions
of paragraph (1) do not apply in respect of any motor vehicle—
(a) 
being used for fire brigadeScottish Fire and Rescue Serviceor, in England or Wales, fire and rescue authorityor, in England, fire and rescue authority, ... or police purposes or for defence purposes
(including civil defence purposes) if compliance with those provisions would
hinder or be likely to hinder the use of the vehicle for the purpose for which
it is being used on that occasion;
(aa) being used for ambulance purposes or for the purpose of providing a response to an emergency at the request of an NHS ambulance service if compliance with those provisions would hinder or be likely to hinder the use of the vehicle for the purpose for which it is being used on that occasion;
(b) 
being used in connection with—
(i) 
any building operation or demolition;
(ii) 
the repair of any other vehicle;
(iii) 
the removal of any obstruction to traffic;
(iv) 
the maintenance, repair or reconstruction of any road; or
(v) 
the laying, erection, alteration or repair in or near to any road of any sewer,
main, pipe or apparatus for the supply of gas, water or electricity, of any
electronic communications apparatus as defined in Schedule 2 to the Telecommunication Act 1984
or of the apparatus of any electric transport undertaking,if, in any such case, compliance with those provisions would hinder
or be likely to hinder the use of the vehicle for the purpose for which it
is being used on that occasion;
(c) 
on any road in which vehicles are allowed to proceed in one direction only;

(d) 
standing on a part of a road set aside for the parking of vehicles or as a
stand for hackney carriages or as a stand for buses or as a place at which
such vehicles may stop for a longer time than is necessary for the taking
up and setting down of passengers where compliance with those provisions would
conflict with the provisions of any order, regulations or byelaws governing
the use of such part of a road for that purpose; or
(e) 
waiting to set down or pick up passengers in accordance with regulations made
or directions given by a chief officer of police in regard to such setting
down or picking up.
102 
If any person in addition to the driver is carried astride a two-wheeled
motor cycle on a road (whether a sidecar is attached to it or not) suitable
supports or rests for the feet shall be available on the motor cycle for that
person.
103 
No person in charge of a motor vehicle or trailer shall cause or
permit the vehicle to stand on a road so as to cause any unnecessary obstruction
of the road.
104 
No person shall drive or cause or permit any other person to drive,
a motor vehicle on a road if he is in such a position that he cannot have
proper control of the vehicle or have a full view of the road and traffic
ahead.
105 
No person shall open, or cause or permit to be opened, any door
of a vehicle on a road so as to injure or endanger any person.
106 
No person shall drive, or cause or permit to be driven, a motor
vehicle backwards on a road further than may be requisite for the safety or
reasonable convenience of the occupants of the vehicle or other traffic, unless
it is a road roller or is engaged in the construction, maintenance or repair
of the road.
107 

(1) Save
as provided in paragraph (2), no person shall leave, or cause or permit to
be left, on a road a motor vehicle which is not attended by a person licensed
to drive it unless the engine is stopped and any parking brake with which
the vehicle is required to be equipped is effectively set.
(2) The requirement
specified in paragraph (1) as to the stopping of the engine shall not apply
in respect of a vehicle—
(a) 
being used for ... fire brigadeScottish Fire and Rescue Serviceor, in England or Wales, fire and rescue authorityor, in England, fire and rescue authority or police purposes;
(aa) being used for ambulance purposes or for the purpose of providing a response to an emergency at the request of an NHS ambulance service; or
(b) 
in such a position and condition as not to be likely to endanger any person
or property and engaged in an operation which requires its engine to be used
to—
(i) 
drive machinery forming part of, or mounted on, the vehicle and used for purposes
other than driving the vehicle; or
(ii) 
maintain the electrical power of the batteries of the vehicle at a level required
for driving that machinery or apparatus.
(3) In this
regulation “parking brake” means 
a brake fitted to a vehicle in accordance with requirement 16 or 18 in Schedule 3.
108 
Where a vehicle is fitted with any apparatus or appliance designed
for lifting and part of the apparatus or appliance consists of a suspended
implement, the implement shall at all times while the vehicle is in motion
on a road and when the implement is not attached to any load supported by
the appliance or apparatus be so secured either to the appliance or apparatus
or to some part of the vehicle that no danger is caused or is likely to be
caused to any person on the vehicle or on the road.
109 

(1) No person
shall drive, or cause or permit to be driven, a motor vehicle on a road, if
the driver is in such a position as to be able to see, whether directly or
by reflection, a television receiving apparatus or other cinematographic apparatus
used to display anything other than information—
(a) 
about the state of the vehicle or its equipment;
(b) 
about the location of the vehicle and the road on which it is located;
(c) 
to assist the driver to see the road adjacent to the vehicle; or
(d) 
to assist the driver to reach his destination.
(2) In this
regulation “television receiving apparatus”
means any cathode ray tube carried on a vehicle and
on which there can be displayed an image derived from a television broadcast,
a recording or a camera or computer.
110. 

(1) No person shall drive a motor vehicle on a road if he is using—
(a) a hand-held mobile telephone; or
(b) a hand-held device of a kind specified in paragraph (4).
(2) No person shall cause or permit any other person to drive a motor vehicle on a road while that other person is using—
(a) a hand-held mobile telephone; or
(b) a hand-held device of a kind specified in paragraph (4).
(3) No person shall supervise a holder of a provisional licence if the person supervising is using—
(a) a hand-held mobile telephone; or
(b) a hand-held device of a kind specified in paragraph (4),
at a time when the provisional licence holder is driving a motor vehicle on a road.
(4) A device referred to in paragraphs (1)(b), (2)(b) and (3)(b) is a device, other than a two-way radio, which is capable of transmitting and receiving data, whether or not those capabilities are enabled.
(5) A person does not contravene a provision of this regulation if, at the time of the alleged contravention—
(a) he is using the telephone or other device to call the police, fire, ambulance or other emergency service on 112 or 999;
(b) he is acting in response to a genuine emergency; and
(c) it is unsafe or impracticable for him to cease driving in order to make the call (or, in the case of an alleged contravention of paragraph (3)(b), for the provisional licence holder to cease driving while the call was being made).
(5A) A person does not contravene a provision of this regulation if, at the time of the alleged contravention—
(a) that person is using the mobile telephone or other device only to perform a remote controlled parking function of the motor vehicle; and
(b) that mobile telephone or other device only enables the motor vehicle to move where the following conditions are satisfied—
(i) there is continuous activation of the remote control application of the telephone or device by the driver;
(ii) the signal between the motor vehicle and the telephone or the motor vehicle and the device, as appropriate, is maintained; and
(iii) the distance between the motor vehicle and the telephone or the motor vehicle and the device, as appropriate, is not more than 6 metres.
(5B) A person does not contravene a provision of this regulation, if at the time of the alleged contravention—
(a) that person is using the mobile telephone or other device to make a contactless payment;
(b) for a good or service which is received at the same time as, or after, the contactless payment is made; and
(c) the motor vehicle is stationary.
(5C) A person does not contravene a provision of this regulation if, at the time of the alleged contravention—
(a) that person is using a mobile telephone or other device which is capable of functioning (whether or not it is also capable of functioning in other ways) so as to transmit a spoken message only while a button on the device is pressed at the same time as the person is speaking the message; and
(b) that person is using the device to transmit a spoken message in the manner described in sub-paragraph (a) or to receive a spoken message—
(i) on an electronic communications network to which access is controlled by the Secretary of State and which that person is authorised to access; and
(ii) in the course of performing duties for the police, fire, ambulance or other emergency service.
(6) For the purposes of this regulation—
(a) a mobile telephone or other device is to be treated as hand-held if it is, or must be, held at some point while being used;
(b) a person supervises the holder of a provisional licence if he does so pursuant to a condition imposed on that licence holder prescribed under section 97(3)(a) of the Road Traffic Act 1988 (grant of provisional licence);
(c) in paragraphs (1) to (3) the word “using” includes the following—
(i) illuminating the screen;
(ii) checking the time;
(iii) checking notifications;
(iv) unlocking the device;
(v) making, receiving, or rejecting a telephone or internet based call;
(vi) sending, receiving or uploading oral or written content;
(vii) sending, receiving or uploading a photo or video;
(viii) utilising camera, video, or sound recording functionality;
(ix) drafting any text;
(x) accessing any stored data such as documents, books, audio files, photos, videos, films, playlists, notes or messages;
(xi) accessing an application;
(xii) accessing the internet;
(d) “two-way radio” means any wireless telegraphy apparatus which is designed or adapted—
(i) for the purpose of transmitting and receiving spoken messages; and
(ii) to operate on any frequency other than 880 MHz to 915 MHz, 925 MHz to 960 MHz, 1710 MHz to 1785 MHz, 1805 MHz to 1880 MHz, 1900 MHz to 1980 MHz or 2110 MHz to 2170 MHz; and
(e) “wireless telegraphy” has the same meaning as in section 19(1) of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949;
(f) “contactless payment” means a payment made at a contactless payment terminal using the contactless payment facility of a card, mobile telephone or other device;
(g) “an application” means a software programme that runs through a web browser or offline on a mobile telephone or other device.
111. 

(1) The Secretary of State must from time to time—
(a) carry out a review of the regulatory provision contained in—
(i) regulation 18 in so far as it relates to the efficiency of brakes,
(ii) regulation 70,
(iii) paragraph 8 of Schedule 7B, and
(b) publish a report setting out the conclusions of the review.
(2) The first report must be published before 20th May 2023.
(3) Subsequent reports must be published at intervals not exceeding 5 years.
(4) Section 30(3) of the Small Business, Enterprise and Employment Act 2015 requires that a review carried out under this regulation must, so far as is reasonable, have regard to how Directive 2014/45/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of 3 April 2014 on periodic roadworthiness tests for motor vehicles and their trailers is implemented in other member States.
(5) Section 30(4) of the Small Business, Enterprise and Employment Act 2015 requires that a report published under this regulation must, in particular—
(a) set out the objectives intended to be achieved by the regulatory provision referred to in paragraph (1)(a),
(b) assess the extent to which those objectives are achieved,
(c) assess whether those objectives remain appropriate, and
(d) if those objectives remain appropriate, assess the extent to which they could be achieved in another way which involves less onerous regulatory provision.
(6) In this regulation, “regulatory provision” has the same meaning as in sections 28 to 32 of the Small Business, Enterprise and Employment Act 2015 (see section 32 of that Act).
John Moore
Secretary of State for Transport
25th June 1986
SCHEDULE 1


Title
 Year and Number
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Track Laying Vehicles)
Regulations 1955 S.I. 1955/990

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Track
Laying Vehicles) (Amendment) Regulations 1957 S.I. 1957/439
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and
Use) (Track Laying Vehicles) (Amendment) (No. 2) Regulations 1957 S.I. 1957/972
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and
Use) (Track Laying Vehicles) (Amendment) Regulations 1959 S.I. 1959/2053
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and
Use) (Track Laying Vehicles) (Amendment) Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/817
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and
Use) (Track Laying Vehicles) (Amendment) (No. 2) Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/1811
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and
Use) Regulations 1978 S.I. 1978/1017

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
Regulations 1978 S.I. 1978/1233

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 3) Regulations 1978 S.I. 1978/1235

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 4) Regulations 1978 S.I. 1978/1263

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 5) Regulations 1978 S.I. 1978/1317

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
Regulations 1979 S.I. 1979/138

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 2) Regulations 1979 S.I. 1979/843

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 3) Regulations 1979 S.I. 1979/1062

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
Regulations 1980 S.I. 1980/140

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 2) Regulations 1980 S.I. 1980/139

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 3) Regulations 1980 S.I. 1980/287

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 4) Regulations 1980 S.I. 1980/610

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 5) Regulations 1980 S.I. 1980/880

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 6) Regulations 1980 S.I. 1980/1166

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 7) Regulations 1980 S.I. 1980/1789

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
Regulations 1981 S.I. 1981/261

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 2) Regulations 1981 S.I. 1981/697

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 3) Regulations 1981 S.I. 1981/915

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 4) Regulations 1981 S.I. 1981/1189

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 5) Regulations 1981 S.I. 1981/1580

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 6) Regulations 1981 S.I. 1981/1663

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 7) Regulations 1981 S.I. 1981/1688

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
Regulations 1982 S.I. 1982/1057

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 2) Regulations 1982 S.I. 1982/1132

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 3) Regulations 1982 S.I. 1982/1223

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 4) Regulations 1982 S.I. 1982/1272

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 5) Regulations 1982 S.I. 1982/1422

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 6) Regulations 1982 S.I. 1982/1480

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 7) Regulations 1982 S.I. 1982/1576

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
Regulations 1983 S.I. 1983/112

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 2) Regulations 1983 S.I. 1983/471

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 3) Regulations 1983 S.I. 1983/932

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/195

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 2) Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/331

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 3) Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/386

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 4) Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/679

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 5) Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/813

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 6) Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/1543

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
(No. 7) Regulations 1984 S.I. 1984/1809

The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment)
Regulations 1985 S.I. 1985/91
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment) (No. 2) Regulations
1985 
S.I. 1985/730
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment) (No. 3) Regulations
1985 
S.I. 1985/1363
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment) (No. 4) Regulations
1985 
S.I. 1985/2039
The Motor Vehicles (Construction and Use) (Amendment) (No. 5) Regulations
1985 
S.I. 1985/2051
SCHEDULE 2
(see regulation 3)

TABLE I
1 2
 3 4
Item Reference No. Community Directives Item No. in Schedule 1
to—
  (a)
 (b) (c) (d) (a) (b)
  
Date Official Journal
Reference Subject matter
 Previous Directives included
 The Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations
 The Type Approval for Goods Vehicles
Regulations

1 70/157 6.2.70 L42,
23.2.70, p.16 The permissible sound level
and the exhaust system of motor vehicles   
2 70/220 20.3.70 L76,
6.4.70, p.1 Measures to be taken against
air pollution by gases from spark ignition engines of motor vehicles   
3 70/221 20.3.70 L76, 6.4.70, p. 23
 Liquid fuel tanks and rear protective
devices for motor vehicles and their trailers   
4 70/388 27.7.70 L176, 10.8.70, p.
12 Audible warning devices for motor
vehicles   
5 71/127 1.3.71 L68,
22.3.71, p. 1 The rear-view mirrors of
motor vehicles  10 
6 71/320 26.7.71 L202,
6.9.71, p. 37 The braking devices of
certain categories of motor vehicles and their trailers   
7 72/245 20.6.72 L152, 6.7.72, p. 15
 The suppression of radio interference
produced by spark ignition engines fitted to motor vehicles  2A 5A
8 72/306 2.8.72 L190,
20.8.72, p. 1 The emission of pollutants
from diesel engines for use in vehicles  5 3
9 73/350 7.11.73 L321, 22.11.73, p.
33 The permissible sound level and the
exhaust system of motor vehicles 70/157  4A
10 74/132 11.2.74 L74, 19.3.74, p. 7
 The braking devices of certain categories
of motor vehicles and their trailers 71/320  
11 74/151 4.3.74 L84, 28.3.74, p. 25
 Parts and characteristics of agricultural
motor vehicles (see Note 1)   

12 74/290 28.5.74 L159,
15.6.74, p. 61 Measures to be taken against
air pollution by gases from spark ignition engines for motor vehicles 70/220  
13 74/346 25.6.74 L191, 15.7.74, p.
1 Rear view mirrors for agricultural
motor vehicles (see Note 1)   

14 74/347 25.6.74 L191,
15.7.74, p. 5 Field of vision and windscreen
wipers for agricultural motor vehicles (see Note 1)   
15 74/483 17.9.74 L266, 2.10.74, p.
4 External projections of motor vehicles
  
19 
16 75/322 20.5.75 L147,
9.6.75, p. 28 Suppression of radio interference
from spark ignition engines of agricultural motor vehicles (see Note 1)   
17 75/443 26.6.75 L196, 26.7.75, p.
1 Reverse and speedometer equipment of
motor vehicles  20 
18 75/524 25.7.75 L236,
8.9.75, p. 3 The braking devices of certain
categories of motor vehicles and their trailers 71/320
as amended by 74/132 13A 

19 76/114 18.12.75 L24,
30.1.76, p. 1 Statutory plates and inscriptions
for motor vehicles and trailers   

20 76/115 18.12.75 L24,
30.1.76, p. 6 Anchorages for motor vehicle
seat belts  12A 
21 76/432 6.4.76 L122,
8.5.76, p. 1 Braking devices of agricultural
vehicles (see Note 1)   
22 77/102 30.11.76 L32,
3.2.77, p. 32 Measures to be taken against
air pollution by gases from spark ignition engines of motor vehicles 70/220
as amended by 74/290  
23 77/212 8.3.77 L66, 12.3.77, p. 33
 The permissible sound level and the
exhaust system of motor vehicles 70/157 as amended by 73/350 14B 4B, 4C, 4D
24 77/537 28.6.77 L220, 29.8.77, p.
38 Emission of pollution from diesel
engines for agricultural motor vehicles (see Note 1)   
25 77/541 28.6.77 L220, 29.8.77, p.
95 Seat belts and restraint systems for
motor vehicles  12A 
26 77/649 27.9.77 L267,
19.10.77, p. 1 Field of vision of motor
vehicle drivers   
27 78/318 21.12.77 L81,
28.3.78, p. 49 Wiper and washer systems
of motor vehicles  22 
28 78/507 19.5.78 L155,
13.6.78, p. 31 Statutory plates and inscriptions
for motor vehicles and trailers 76/114  
29 78/549 12.6.78 L168, 26.6.78, p.
45 Wheel guards of motor vehicles   
30 78/665 14.7.78 L223, 14.8.78, p.
48 Measures to be taken against air pollution
by gases from spark ignition engines of motor vehicles 70/220
as amended by 74/290
and 77/102 4B, 4C 2
31 78/1015 23.11.78 L349, 13.12.78, p.
21 The permissible sound level and exhaust
system of motorcycles   
32 79/488 18.4.79 L128,
26.5.79, p. 1 External projections of
motor vehicles 74/483 19A 
33 79/489 18.4.79 L128,
26.5.79, p. 12 The braking devices of
certain categories of motor vehicles and their trailers 71/320
as amended by 74/132
and 75/524 13B 6, 6C
34 79/490 18.4.79 L128, 26.5.79, p.
22 Liquid fuel tanks and rear under-run
protection 70/221  
35 79/795 20.7.79 L239, 22.9.79, p.
1 The rear-view mirrors of motor vehicles
 71/127 10A 

36 79/1073 22.11.79 L331,
27.12.79, p. 20 Field of vision and windscreen
wipers for agricultural motor vehicles 74/347  
37 80/780 22.7.80 L229, 30.8.80, p.
49 Rear view mirrors for motor cycles
   
38 80/1269 16.12.80 L375,
31.12.80, p. 46 The engine power of motor
vehicles   
39 81/334 13.4.81 L131,
18.5.81, p. 6 The permissible sound level
and exhaust system of motor vehicles 70/157 as amended by 73/350 and 77/212 14C 4B, 4C, 4D
40 81/575 29.7.81 L209, 29.7.81, p.
30 Anchorages for motor vehicle seat
belts 76/115 12A 

41 81/576 29.7.81 L209,
29.7.81, p. 32 Seat belts and restraint
systems for motor vehicles 77/541 12A 
42 81/643 29.7.81 L231,
15.8.81, p. 41 Field of vision of motor
vehicles drivers 77/649  
43 82/318 2.4.82 L139, 19.5.82, p. 9
 Anchorages for motor vehicle seat belts
 76/115
as amended by 81/575 12A

44 82/319 2.4.82 L139,
19.5.82, p. 17 Seat belts and restraint
systems for motor vehicles 77/541 as amended by 81/576 12A 
45 82/890 17.12.82 L378,
31.12.82, p. 45 Agricultural motor vehicles
   
46 83/351 16.6.83 L197,
20.7.83, p. 1 Air pollution by gases
from positive ignition engines of motor vehicles 70/220
as amended by 74/290, 77/102 and 78/665 4C 
47 84/372 3.7.84 L196,
26.7.84, p. 47 The permissible sound
level and exhaust system of motor vehicles 70/157 as amended by 73/350, 77/212 and 81/334  
48 84/424 3.9.84 L238, 6.9.84, p. 31
 The permissible sound level and exhaust
system of motor vehicles 70/157 as amended by 73/350, 77/212, 81/334 and 84/372  
48A 85/3 19.12.84 L2, 3.1.85, p.14 The weights dimensions and other technical characteristics of certain road vehicles   
49 85/205 18.2.85 L90, 29.3.85, p. 1
 Mirrors 71/127 as amended by 79/795 10B 
49A  85/210 20.3.85 L96, 3.4.85, p.25    The lead content of petrol   
50 85/647 23.12.85 L380, 31.12.85, p.1 The braking devices of certain motor vehicles and their trailers 71/320 as amended by 74/132, 75/524 and 79/489  
50A 86/360 24.7.86 L217, 5.8.86, p.19 The weights dimensions and other technical characteristics of certain road vehicles 85/3  
51  86/56 26.11.86 L327, 27.11.86, p.49 Mirrors 71/127 as amended by 79/795 and 85/205  
51A  87/56 18.12.86 L24, 27.1.87, p.42. The permissible sound level and exhaust system of motorcycles 78/1015  
52
 88/76 3.12.87 L36, 9.2.88, p.1 Measures to be taken against air pollution by gases from the engines of motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, and 83/351 4D  2B
53  89/297 13.4.89 L124, 5.5.89,p.1. Lateral protection (side guards) of certain motor vehicles and their trailers   
54 88/77 3.12.87 L36, 9.2.88, p. 33 Measures to be taken against the emission of gaseous pollutants from diesel engines for use in vehicles  4E 2D
54A  88/194 24.3.88 L92, 9.4.88 p.47 The braking devices of certain categories of motor vehicles and their trailers 71/320 as amended by 74/132, 75/524, 79/489 and 85/647  
55 88/195 24.3.88 L92, 9.4.88, p.50 Engine power of motor vehicles 80/1269  
55A 88/218 11.4.88 L98, 15.4.88, p.48 The weights dimensions and other technical characteristics of certain road vehicles 85/3 as amended by 86/360  
55B 88/321 16.5.88 L147, 14.6.88, p.77 Mirrors 71/127 as amended by 79/795, 85/205 and 86/562 10C 
55C 88/366 17.5.88 L181, 12.7.88, p.40 Field of vision of motor vehicle drivers 77/649 as amended by 81/643  
56 88/436 16.6.88 L124, 6.8.88, p.1 Measures to be taken against air pollution by gases from engines of motor vehicles (restriction of particulate pollution emissions from diesel engines) 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, 83/351 and 88/76 4D 2C
56A 89/235 13.3.89 L98, 11.4.89. p.1 The permissible sound level and exhaust systems of motor cycles 78/1015 amended by 87/56 —  —
 56AA 89/338 27.4.89 L142, 25.5.89, p.3 The weights dimensions and other technical characteristics of certain road vehicles 85/3 as amended by 86/360 and 88/218  
57 89/458 18.7.89 L226, 3.8.89, p. 1 Measures to be taken against air pollution by emissions from motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, 83/351, 88/76 and 88/436  
57A 89/460 18.7.89 L226, 3.8.89, p.5 The weights dimensions and other technical characteristics of certain road vehicles 85/3 as amended by 86/360, 88/218 and 89/338  
57B 89/461 18.7.89 L226, 3.8.89, p.7 The weights dimensions and other technical characteristics of certain road vehicles 85/3 as amended by 86/360, 88/218, 89/338 and 89/460  
57C 89/491 17.07.89 L238, 15.08.89 p.43 Motor Vehicles 72/306  
58  90/628 30.10.90 L341, 6.12.90, p.1 Safety belts and restraint systems of motor vehicles 77/541 as amended by 81/576 and 82/319 12A 
59 90/629 30.10.90 L341, 6.12.90, p.14 Anchorages for motor vehicle safety belts 76/115 as amended by 81/575 and 82/318 12A 
60 90/360 30.10.90 L341, 6.12.90, p.20 Field of vision of motor vehicle drivers 77/649 as amended by 81/643 and 88/366  
60A 91/60 4.2.91 L37, 9.2.91, p.37 The weights dimensions and other technical characteristics of certain vehicles 85/3 as amended by 86/360, 88/218, 89/338, 89/460 and 89/641  
61 91/226	 27.3.91	 L103, 23.4.91, p.5	 Spray-suppression systems of certain categories of motor vehicles and their trailers   
61A 91/422 15.7.91 L233, 22.8.91, p.21 The braking devices of certain categories of motor vehicles and their trailers 71/320 as amended by 74/132, 75/524, 79/489, 85/647 and 88/194  
62 92/7 10.2.91 L57, 2.3.92, p.29 The weights dimensions and other technical characteristics of certain road vehicles 85/3 as amended by 86/360, 88/218, 89/338, 89/460 and 89/641  
63 91/441 26.6.9 L242, 30.8.91, p.1 Measures to be taken against air pollution by emissions from motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77,102, 78/665, 83/351, 88/76, 88/436 and 89/458 4G 2F
64 91/542 1.10.91 L295, 25.10.91, p.1 Measures to be taken against the emission of gaseous pollutants from diesel engines for use in vehicles 88/77 4H 2G
64A 92/6 10.2.92 L57, 2.3.92, p.27 The installation and use of speed limitation devices   
65 92/22 31.3.92 L129, 14.5.92, p. 11 Safety glazing and glazing materials on motor vehicles and their trailers —  —  —
66 92/23 31.3.92 L129, 14.5.92, p.95 Tyres of motor vehicles and their trailers and their fitting — —  —
67 92/24 31.3.92 L129, 14.5.92, p154 Speed limitation devices or similar speed limitation onboard certain categories of motor vehicles – — —
67A 93/14 5.4.93 L121, 15.5.93, p.1 The braking of two or three-wheel motor vehicles   
68 93/59 28.6.93  Measures to be taken against air pollution by emissions from motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, 83/351, 88/76, 88/436, 89/458 and 91/441 4K 2I
69 94/12 23.3.94. L100, 19.4.94, p.42 Measures to be taken against air pollution by emissions from motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, 83/351, 88/76, 88/436, 89/458, 91/441 and 93/59 4L 2J
69A 94/20 30.5.94 L195, 29.7.94, p.1 Mechanical coupling devices of motor vehicles and their trailers   
70 92/97 10.11.92 L371, 19.12.92, p.1 Permissible sound level and the exhaust system of motor vehicles 70/157 as amended by 73/350, 77/212, 81/334, 84/372 and 84/424 14G 4F
71 95/54 31.10.95 L266, 8.11.95, p.1 The suppression of radio interference of motor vehicles 72/245 2B 5B
72 96/1 22.1.96 L40, 17.2.96, p.1 Measures to be taken against the emission of gaseous pollutants from diesel engines for use in vehicles 88/77 as amended by 91/542 4N 2L
73 96/20 27.3.96 L92, 13.4.96, p.23 Permissible sound level and the exhaust system of motor vehicles 70/157 as amended by 73/350, 77/212, 81/334, 84/372, 84/424 and 92/97 141 4G
73A 96/36 17.6.96 L178, 17.7.96, p.15 Safety belts and restraint systems of motor vehicles 77/541 as amended by 81/576, 82/319 and 90/628  
73B 96/38 17.6.96 L187, 26.7.96, p.95 Anchorages for motor vehicle safety belts 76/115 as amended by 81/575, 82/318 and 90/629  
74 96/53 25.7.96 L 234, 17.9.96, p.59 Maximum dimensions in national and international traffic and maximum weights in international traffic   
74A 96/63 30.9.96 L253, 5.10.96, p.13 Braking devices of wheeled agricultural or forestry tractors 76/432  
74B 96/69 08.10.96 L282,1.11.96, p.64 Measures to be taken against air pollution by emissions from motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, 83/351, 88/76, 88/436, 89/491, 91/441, 93/59, 94/12, and 96/44  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
75 97/19 18.4.97 L 125, 16.5.97, p.1 Liquid fuel tanks and rear under-run protection of motor vehicles and their trailers 70/221 as amended by 79/490 and 81/333  
75A 97/20 18.04.97 L125, 16.05.97, p.21 The measures to be taken against the emission of pollutants from diesel engines for use in vehicles 72/306, as amended by 89/491  
76 97/27 22.7.97 L 233, 25.8.97, p.1 Masses and dimensions of certain categories of vehicle and their trailers   
77 97/39 27.4.97 L 177, 5.7.97, p.15 Reverse and speedometer equipment of motor vehicles 75/443  
77A  98/12 27.1.98 L81,18.3.98, p.1 The braking devices of certain vehicles and their trailers 71/320 as amended by 74/132, 75/524, 79/489, 85/647, 88/184, 91/422 and 98/12  
78 98/69 13.10.98 L350, 28.12.98, p.1 Measures to be taken against air pollution by emissions from motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, 83/351, 88/76, 88/436, 89/491, 91/441, 93/59, 94/12, 96/44 and 96/69  
79 1999/96 13.12.99 L44, 16.2.2000, p.1 Measures to be taken against the emission of gaseous and particulate pollutants from compression ignition engines for use in vehicles and the emission of gaseous pollutants from positive ignition engines fuelled with natural gas or liquefied petroleum gas for use in vehicles 88/77 as amended by 91/542 and 96/1  
80 1999/102 15.12.99 L334, 28.12.99, p.43 Measures to be taken against air pollution by emissions from motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, 83/351, 88/76, 88/436, 89/491, 91/441, 93/59, 94/12, 96/44, 96/69 and 98/69  
81 2001/1 22.01.2001 L35, 06.2.2001, p. 34 Measures to be taken against air pollution by emissions from motor vehicles 70/220 as amended by 74/290, 77/102, 78/665, 83/351, 88/76, 88/436, 89/491, 91/441, 93/59, 94/12, 96/44, 96/69, 98/69, and 1999/102  
82  2001/27 10.4.01 L107, 18.4.2001 p.10 Measures to be taken against the emission of gaseous and particulate pollutants from compression- ignition engines for use in vehicles, and the emission of gaseous pollutants from positive-ignition engines fuelled with natural gas or liquefied petroleum gas for use in vehicles 
                      88/77 as amended by 91/542 and 1999/96  
82A.  2001/43 4.8.2001 L211, 4.8.2001, p.25 Tyres for motor vehicles and their trailers and to their fitting 92/23  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   
84 2002/85 5.11.2002 L57, 4.12.2002, p.327 Installation and use of speed limitation devices for certain categories of motor vehicles in the Community 92/6  
85 2003/26 3.4.2003 L90, 8.4.2003, p.37 Speed limiters and exhaust emissions of commercial vehicles 2000/30  
86 2003/27 3.4.2003 L90, 8.4.2003, p.41 Testing of exhaust emissions from motor vehicles 96/96  
87 2003/97 10.11.2003 L25, 29.1.2004, p.1 
Devices for indirect vision
 
71/127 as amended by 79/795, 85/205, 86/562 and 88/321  
88 2004/11 11.2.2004 L44, 14.2.2004,p.19 Speed limitation devices or similar speed limitation on-board systems of certain categories of motor vehicles 92/24 9A 
88A 2005/21 07.03.2005 L61, 08.03.2005, p.25 The measures to be taken against the emission of pollutants from diesel engines for use in vehicles 72/306, as amended by 89/491, 97/20  
89 2005/27 30.3.2005 L81, 30.3.2005, p.44 Devices for indirect vision 71/127 as replaced by 2003/97  
90. 2005/55 28.09.05 L275, 20.10.05, p1 The measures to be taken against the emission of gaseous and particulate pollutants from compression-ignition engines for use in vehicles, and the emission of gaseous pollutants from positive-ignition engines fuelled with natural gas or liquefied petroleum gas for use in vehicles   
91. 2005/78 14.11.05 L31, 29.11.05, p1 The measures to be taken against the emission of gaseous and particulate pollutants from compression-ignition engines for use in vehicles, and the emission of gaseous pollutants from positive ignition engines fuelled with natural gas or liquefied petroleum gas for use in vehicles 2005/55  
91A. 2006/40 17.5.2006 L161, 14.6.2006, p.12 Emissions from air conditioning systems in motor vehicles.   
92. 2006/51 6.6.06 L152. 7.6.2006, p11 The measures to be taken against the emission of gaseous and particulate pollutants from compression-ignition engines for use in vehicles, and the emission of gaseous pollutants from positive ignition engines fuelled with natural gas or liquefied petroleum gas for use in vehicles 2005/55, 2005/78  
93 2007/38 11.07.07 L184, 14.7.2007, p.25 Retrofitting of mirrors to certain heavy goods vehicles   
94. 2007/46 5.9.2007 L263, 9.10.2007, p1 Framework Directive for the approval of motor vehicles and their trailers, and of systems, components and separate technical units intended for such vehicles.   
95 2014/45 29.4.14 L127, 29.4.14, p. 51 Periodic roadworthiness tests for motor vehicles and their trailers 2009/40
96 2014/47 29.4.14 L127, 29.4.14, p. 134 Technical roadside inspection of the roadworthiness of commercial vehicles 2000/30.
NOTE 1. This item is to be interpreted as including reference to the amendments
made by Community Directive 82/890
(item 45).

TABLE II
1 2 3 4
Item 
Reference No. ECE Regulations Item No. in Schedule 1
to—
  (a) (b) (c) (d) (a) (b)
  Number Date Subject matter 
Date of amendment The Type Approval (Great
Britain) Regulations The Type Approval
for Goods Vehicles Regulations
1 10 10 17.12.68 Radio interference suppression — 
2 5
2 10.01 10 17.12.68 Radio interference suppression 19.3.78 2A 5A
2A  10.02  8.12.97 Radio interference suppression   
2B 10.02 Amend. 1 9.7.99 Radio interference suppression   
2C 10.02 Corr. 1 11.2.00 Radio interference suppression   

3 13.03 
13 29.5.69 Brakes 4.1.79 13C, 13D 6A,
6B, 6D
4 13.04 13 29.5.69 Brakes
 11.8.81 
13C, 13D 6A, 6B, 6D
4A 13.05
 13 
29.5.69 Brakes 26.11.84 — —
4B 13.06	 13 	29.5.69	 Brakes	 22.11.90 — —
4C 13.07 13 29.5.69 Brakes 18.9.94 — —
4D  13.08 13 29.5.69 Brakes 26.3.95 — —
4E  13.09 13 29.5.69 Brakes 28.8.96 — —
5A  14 14 30.1.70 Anchorages for seat belts — — —

6 14.01 
14 30.1.70 Anchorages for seat belts 
28.4.76 12A —
6A  14.02 14 30.1.70 Anchorages for seat belts 22.11.84 12A —
6B  14.03 14 30.1.70 Anchorages for seat belts 29.1.92 — —
6C 14.04 14 30.1.70 Anchorages for seat belts 18.1.98 — —
6D 14.05 14 30.1.70 Anchorages for seat belts 4.2.99 — —
6C 14.03  30.1.70 Anchorages for seat belts 29.1.92 12A —
7 15.03 15 11.3.70 Emission
of gaseous pollutants 6.3.78 4B 2
8 
15.04 15 
11.3.70 Emission of gaseous pollutants
 20.10.81 4C 2
9 16.03 16 14.8.70
 Seat belts and restraint systems 9.12.79 12A
 —
10 24.01 24 23.8.71
 Emission of pollutants by a diesel engine
 11.9.73 
5 3
11 24.02 24 23.8.71 Emission of pollutants by a diesel engine 11.2.80 5A
 3A
12 24.03 24 23.8.71 Emission of pollutants by a diesel engine 20.4.86 —
 —
13 26.01 26 28.4.72
 External projections 11.9.73 19 —
13A 30 30 1.4.75 Pneumatic tyres for motor vehicles and their trailers — 17,17A —
13B 30 30.01 1.4.75 Pneumatic tyres for motor vehicles and their trailers 25.9.77 17,17A —
13C 30.02 30 1.4.75 Pneumatic tyres for motor vehicles and their trailers 5.10.87 17, 17A

14 34 
34 25.7.75 Prevention of fire risks — — —

15 34.01 
34 25.7.75 Prevention of fire risks 
18.1.79 — —
16 36 36 12.11.75 Construction
of public service vehicles 
— — —
17 39 39 11.7.78 Speedometers
 — 20 —
18 
43 43 
15.9.80 Safety glass and glazing materials
 — 15B —
19 
43.01 43 
15.9.80 Safety glass and glazing materials
 12.11.82 15B —
20 44 44 1.2.81 Child restraints — — —

21 44.01 
44 1.2.81 Child restraints 1.2.84 — —

21A 46.01 46. 21.10.84 Mirrors 30.5.88 —  —
21A(1)  46.02 46 21.10.84. Mirrors 23.06.05  
21A(2)  46.04 46 21.10.84 Mirrors 15.07.13 — —
21AA 49.01 49 14.5.90 emissions of gaseous pollutants — — 
21AB 49.02 49 15.4.82 Emissions of gaseous pollutants 30.12.92  
21BA 51.02 51 18.4.95 Noise emissions from motor vehicles having at least 4 wheels — 14E 4D(4) or 4E
21BB 52.01 52 1.11.1982 Construction of small buses and coaches (M2 and M3) 12.9.1995 — —
21B 49 49 15.4.82. Emissions of gaseous pollutants — — —
21C 54 54 1.3.83 Pneumatic tyres for commercial vehicles and their trailers — 17A —
22 64 64 1.8.85 Vehicles with
temporary-use spare wheels/tyres — — —
22A 67 67 27.04.90 Vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas — — —
22B 67.01 67 13.11.99 Vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas — — —
23 78 78 15.10.88 Brakes — —  —
24 78.01 78 15.10.88 Brakes 22.11.90 —  —
25 83 83 5.11.89 Emissions of gaseous pollutants — 4F 2H
26 83.01 83 5.11.89 Emissions of gaseous pollutants 30.12.92 4K 2F
27 107.01 107 18.6.1998 Construction of small buses and coaches (M2 and M3) 12.8.2004 — —
28 107.02 107 18.6.1998 (Construction of small buses and coaches (M2 and M3) 10.11.2007 — —
28A 108 108 23.6.98 Retreaded tyres for passenger cars and their trailers — — 
28B 109 109 23.6.98 Retreaded tyres for commercial vehicles and their trailers — — 
29  117.01 117 6.4.2005 Tyres – Rolling sound emissions and adhesion to wet surfaces 2.2.2007 — —
30 134 134 15.6.2015 Hydrogen and fuel cell vehicles — — —
31 134.01 134 15.6.2015 Hydrogen and fuel cell vehicles 7.1.2022 — —
32 134.02 134 15.6.2015 Hydrogen and fuel cell vehicles 15.6.2024 — —

SCHEDULE 2A
Regulation 3A
PART I
1 

(1) In this Schedule—
 “the Approval Regulations” means the Motor Vehicles (Approval) Regulations 1996;
 “approval certificate” means a Minister’s approval certificate in the form prescribed by the Approval Regulations;
 “approval date”, in relation to a vehicle in respect of which an approval certificate has been issued, is the date that the certificate was issued;
 “goods vehicle approval certificate” means an approval certificate which appears to have been issued on the basis that the vehicle is a vehicle to which Part III of the Approval Regulations applies;
 “individual approval certificate” means a certificate issued under regulation 27(10) of the Vehicle Approval Regulations;
 “passenger vehicle approval certificate” means an approval certificate which appears to have been issued on the basis that the vehicle is a vehicle to which Part II of the Approval Regulations applies.
2 

(1) Subject to paragraph 3, references in this Schedule to a vehicle complying with or being exempt from the approval requirements shall be construed in accordance with the following provisions of this paragraph.
(2) Subject to sub-paragraphs (4) and (5), a vehicle in respect of which a goods vehicle approval certificate has been issued shall be regarded as complying with or exempt from the approval requirements in relation to a specified subject matter if and only if it for the time being satisfies at least one of the conditions in regulation 6(5) of the Approval Regulations in relation to that subject matter.
(3) Subject to sub-paragraphs (4) and (5), a vehicle in respect of which a passenger vehicle approval certificate has been issued shall be regarded as complying with or exempt from the approval requirements in relation to a specified subject matter if and only if it for the time being satisfies at least one of the conditions in regulation 4(5) of the Approval Regulations in relation to that subject matter.
(4) A vehicle in respect of which an approval certificate has been issued shall be regarded as neither complying with nor being exempt from the approval requirements in relation to any subject matter if—
(a) the certificate is a goods vehicle approval certificate and the vehicle is not for the time being a vehicle to which Part III of the Approval Regulations applies; or
(b) the certificate is a passenger vehicle approval certificate and the vehicle is not for the time being a vehicle to which Part II of the Approval Regulations applies.
(5) For the purposes of this paragraph, the Approval Regulations shall have effect with the omission of regulations 4(8) and 6(7).
PART II
3 
Regulation 32(2), (7) and (10) shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which a passenger vehicle approval certificate has been issued, if it complies with or is exempt from the approval requirements relating to glazing.
4 
Regulation 33 shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which a passenger vehicle approval certificate has been issued, if it complies with or is exempt from the approval requirements relating to rear view mirrors.
5 
Regulation 35 shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which a passenger approval certificate has been issued, if it complies with or is exempt from the approval requirements relating to speedometers.
6 
Regulation 39(2)(c)(i) shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which either a passenger vehicle approval certificate or a goods vehicle approval certificate has been issued, if it complies with the approval requirements relating to general vehicle construction.
7 
Regulation 46 shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which a passenger vehicle approval certificate has been issued, if it complies with or is exempt from the approval requirements relating to anchorage points.
8 
Regulation 47, so far as it relates to seat belts for adults, shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which a passenger vehicle approval certificate has been issued, if it complies with or is exempt from the approval requirements relating to seat belts (including the requirements relating to the installation of seat belts).
9 

(1) Regulation 61 shall have effect with the following modifications in relation to a vehicle in respect of which there has been issued an approval certificate containing the letter “A” pursuant to regulation 12(2)(c) of the Approval Regulations.
(2) For the purposes of paragraphs (3A), (7), (8) and (9), the date of first use of the vehicle shall be regarded as being 1st January immediately preceding the date of manufacture of the engine by which it is propelled.
 However, the date on which the vehicle is first used shall not, by virtue of this paragraph, be regarded in any circumstances as being later than the date on which it would otherwise have been regarded as being first used had this paragraph been omitted.
(3) Paragraphs 10(A) and 10(AA) shall not apply to the vehicle if it complies with or is exempt from the approval requirements relating to exhaust emissions.
9A 
Paragraphs (10A), (10AA) and (10BA) of regulation 61 shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which either a passenger vehicle approval certificate or a goods vehicle approval certificate has been issued, if it complies with, or is exempt from, the approval requirements relating to exhaust or smoke emissions.
9B 

(1) Regulation 61A shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which either a passenger vehicle approval certificate or a goods vehicle approval certificate has been issued, if it complies with or is exempt from the approval requirements relating to exhaust or smoke emissions.
(2) Regulation 61A shall have effect with the following modifications in relation to a vehicle in respect of which there has been issued an approval certificate containing the letter “A” pursuant to regulation 12(2)(c) of the Approval Regulations.
(3) For the purposes of paragraphs (2) and (3) of regulation 61A, the date as is specified (as defined in regulation 61A) shall be regarded as being the 1st January immediately preceeding the date of manufacture of the engine by which the vehicle is propelled; provided that the date as is specified shall not in any circumstances be regarded as being later than the date on which the motor vehicle would otherwise have been regarded as being first used.
9C. 
Paragraphs (5) and (6) of regulation 61B shall not apply to a vehicle in relation to which a passenger vehicle approval certificate, a goods vehicle approval certificate or an individual approval certificate has been issued if it complies with the approval requirements for air conditioning systems designed to contain high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases.
10 
Regulation 67 shall not apply to a vehicle in respect of which an approval certificate has been issued if—
(a) the vehicle is equipped with a plate which is in a conspicuous and readily accessible position, is affixed to a vehicle part which is not normally subject to replacement and shows clearly and indelibly the identification number shown on the certificate and the name of the manufacturer; and
(b) that number is marked on the chassis, frame or other similar structure, on the offside of the vehicle, in a clearly visible and accessible position, and by a method such as hammering or stamping, in such a way that it cannot be obliterated or deteriorate.
SCHEDULE 3
(see regulation 16)
1 
The braking requirements referred to in regulation 16(4) are set out in
the Table and are to be interpreted in accordance with 
paragraphs 2 to 5 of this Schedule.

TABLE(Schedule 3)

Number Requirement
1 The vehicle shall be equipped
with—(a) one
efficient braking system having two means of operation;(b) one efficient split braking system having one
means of operation; or(c)
two efficient braking systems each having a separate means of operation.and in the case of a vehicle first used on or after 1st January
1968, no account shall be taken of a multi-pull means of operation unless,
at first application, it operates a hydraulic, electric or pneumatic device
which causes the application of brakes with total braking efficiency not less
than 25%.
2 The vehicle shall be equipped with—(a) one efficient braking system having two means
of operation; or(b)
two efficient braking systems each having a separate means of operation.
3 
The vehicle shall be equipped with an efficient braking system.
4 
The braking system shall be so designed that in the event of failure of any
part (other than a fixed member or a brake shoe anchor pin) through or by
means of which the force necessary to apply the brakes is transmitted, there
shall still be available for application by the driver brakes sufficient under
the most adverse conditions to bring the vehicle to rest within a reasonable
distance. The brakes so available shall be applied to—(a) in the case of a track-laying vehicle, one track
on each side of the vehicle;
(b) in the case of a wheeled motor vehicle, one wheel if the vehicle
has 3 wheels and otherwise to at least half the wheels; and(c) in the case of a wheeled trailer, at least one
wheel if it has only 2 wheels and otherwise at least 2 wheels.This requirement applies to the braking systems of both a trailer
and the vehicle by which it is being drawn except that if the drawing vehicle
complies with regulation 15,  Community Directive  79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 or 98/12 or ECE Regulation 13.03, 13.04, 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09, the requirements applies
only to the braking system of the drawing vehicle. It does not apply to vehicles
having split braking systems (which are subject to regulation 18(3)(b)) or to road
rollers. (The expressions `part' and `half the wheels' are to be interpreted
in accordance with paragraphs (3) and (4)
respectively).
5 The braking system shall be so designed and constructed
that, in the event of the failure of any part thereof, there shall still be
available for application by the driver a brake sufficient under the most
adverse conditions to bring the vehicle to rest within a reasonable distance.

6 The braking system of a vehicle, when drawing a trailer which complies
with regulation 15, Community Directive 79/489, 85/647, 88/194, 91/422 or 98/12 or ECE Regulation 13.03, 13.04, 13.05, 13.06, 13.07, 13.08 or 13.09, shall be so constructed
that, in the event of a failure of any part (other than a fixed member or
brake shoe anchor pin) of the service braking system of the drawing vehicle
(excluding the means of operation of a split braking system) the driver can
still apply brakes to at least one wheel of the trailer, if it has only 2
wheels, and otherwise to at least 2 wheels, by using the secondary braking
system of the drawing vehicle.(The expression “part”
is to be interpreted in accordance with paragraph 3).

7 The application of any means of operation of a braking system shall
not affect or operate the pedal or hand lever of any other means of operation.

8 The braking system shall not be rendered ineffective by the non-rotation
of the engine of the vehicle or, in the case of a trailer, the engine of the
drawing vehicle (steam-propelled vehicles, other than locomotives and buses,
are excluded from this requirement).
9 At least one means of operation
shall be capable of causing brakes to be applied directly, and not through
the transmission gear, to at least half the wheels of the vehicle. This requirement
does not apply to a works truck with an unladen weight not exceeding 7370
kg, or to an industrial tractor; and it does not apply to a vehicle with more
than 4 wheels if—(a) the drive is transmitted
to all wheels other than the steering wheels without the interposition of
a differential driving gear or similar mechanism between the axles carrying
the driving wheels; and(b) the brakes applied by one
means of operation apply directly to 2 driving wheels on opposite sides of
the vehicle; and(c) the brakes applied by another means
of operation act directly on all the other driving wheels.
(The expression “half the wheels” is to be interpreted in accordance
with paragraph (4)).

10 The brakes of a trailer shall come into operation automatically
on its overrun or, in the case of a track-laying trailer drawn by a vehicle
having steerable wheels at the front or a wheeled trailer, the driver of,
or some other person on, the drawing vehicle or on the trailer shall be able
to apply the brakes on the trailer.
11 The brakes of a trailer
shall come into operation automatically on its overrun or the driver of the
drawing vehicle shall be able to apply brakes to all the wheels of the trailer,
using the means of operation which applies the service brakes of the drawing
vehicle.
12 The brakes of the vehicle shall apply to all wheels other
than the steering wheels.

13 The brakes of the vehicle shall apply
to at least 2 wheels.
14 The brakes of the vehicle shall apply in the case
of a wheeled vehicle to at least 2 wheels if the vehicle has no more than
4 wheels and to at least half the wheels if the vehicle has more than 4 wheels;
and in the case of a track-laying vehicle to all the tracks.
15 The brakes
shall apply to all the wheels.

16 The parking brake shall be so designed
and constructed that—
(a) in the case of a wheeled heavy motor
car or motor car, its means of operation is independent of the means of operation
of any split braking system with which the vehicle is fitted;
(b) in the case of a motor vehicle other
than a motor cycle or an invalid carriage, either— 
(i) it is capable of being applied by direct
mechanical action without the intervention of any hydraulic, electric or pneumatic
device; or
(ii) the vehicle complies with requirement
15; and
(c) it can at all times when the vehicle
is not being driven or is left unattended be set so as— 
(i) in the case of a track-laying vehicle,
to lock the tracks; and
(ii) in the case of a wheeled vehicle, to
prevent the rotation of at least one wheel in the case of a three wheeled
vehicle and at least two wheels in the case of a vehicle with more than three
wheels.
17
 The parking brake shall be capable of
being set so as effectively to prevent two at least of the wheels from revolving
when the trailer is not being drawn.
18 The parking brake shall
be so designed and constructed that—(a) in the case of a motor vehicle, its means of
operation (whether multi-pull or not) is independent of the means of operation
of any braking system required by regulation 18
to have a total braking efficiency of not less than 50%; and(b) in the case of a trailer, its brakes can be applied
and released by a person standing on the ground by a means of operation fitted
to the trailer; and(c)
in either case, its braking force, when the vehicle is not being driven or
is left unattended (and in the case of a trailer, whether the braking force
is applied by the driver using the service brakes of the drawing vehicle or
by a person standing on the ground in the manner indicated in sub-paragraph (b)) can at all times be maintained in operation
by direct mechanical action without the intervention of any hydraulic, electric
or pneumatic device and, when so maintained, can hold the vehicle stationary
on a gradient of at least 16% without the assistance of stored energy.
2 
For the purposes of requirement 3 in the Table,
in the case of a motor car or heavy motor car propelled by steam and not used
as a bus, the engine shall be deemed to be an efficient braking system with
one means of operation if the engine is capable of being reversed and, in
the case of a vehicle first used on or after 1st January 1927, is incapable
of being disconnected from any of the driving wheels of the vehicle except
by the sustained effort of the driver.
3 
For the purpose of requirements 4 and 6 in the
Table, in the case of a wheeled motor car and of a vehicle first used on or
after 1st October 1938 which is a locomotive, a motor tractor, a heavy motor
car or a track-laying motor car, every moving shaft which is connected to
or supports any part of a braking system shall be deemed to be part of the
system.
4 
For the purpose of  requirements 4, 9 and 14  in the
Table, in determining whether brakes apply to at least half the wheels of
a vehicle, not more than one front wheel shall be treated as a wheel to which
brakes apply unless the vehicle is—
(a) a locomotive or motor
tractor with more than 4 wheels;
(b) a heavy motor car
or motor car first used before 1st October 1938;
(c) a motor car with
an unladen weight not exceeding 1020 kg;
(d) a motor car which
is a passenger vehicle but is not a bus;
(e) a works truck;
(f) a heavy motor car
or motor car with more than 3 wheels which is equipped in respect of all its
wheels with brakes which are operated by one means of operation; or
(g) a track-laying vehicle.

5 
In this Schedule a “multi-pull means of operation”
 means a device forming part of a braking
system which causes the muscular energy of the driver to apply the brakes
of that system progressively as a result of successive applications of that
device by the driver.
SCHEDULE 3A
(see regulations 39A and 39B)
PART I
1 

(1) In this Part —
 “EEC type approval certificate” means a certificate issued by a member state of the European Economic Community in accordance with Community Directive 70/220 as originally made or with any amendments which have from time to time been made before 5th September 1988;
 “engine capacity” means in the case of a reciprocating engine, the nominal swept volume and, in the case of a rotary engine, double the nominal swept volume;
 ...
 “relevant authority” means —
(a) in relation to an EEC type approval certificate issued by the United Kingdom, the Secretary of State, and
(b) in relation to an EEC type approval certificate issued by any other member state of the European Economic Community, the authority having power under the law of that state to issue that certificate.
(2) The reference in this Schedule to a M1 category vehicle is a reference to a vehicle described as M1 in Council Directive 70/156/EEC of 6th February 1970 as amended at 5th September 1988.
2 
A vehicle of a description specified in column 2 of the Table below is excluded from the application of regulation 39A if it is first used before the date specified in column 3 and the conditions specified in paragraph 3 are satisfied in respect to it on that date.
3 
The conditions referred to in paragraph 2 are —
(a) that the vehicle is a model in relation to which there is in force an EEC type approval certificate issued before 1st October 1989;
(b) that the manufacturer of the vehicle has supplied to the relevant authority which issued the EEC type approval certificate, a certificate stating that adapting vehicles of that model to the fuel requirements specified in the Annexes to Community Directive 88/76 would entail a change in material specification of the inlet or exhaust valve seats or a reduction in the compression ratio or an increase in the engine capacity to compensate for loss of power; and
(c) that the relevant authority has accepted the certificate referred to in sub-paragraph (b).

Table
Item Description of vehicle Date before which vehicle must be first used
(1) (2) (3)
1. Vehicles with an engine capacity of less than 1400cc. 1.4.92
2. Vehicles with an engine capacity of not less than 1400cc and not more than 2000cc. 1.4.94
3. M1 category vehicles with an engine capacity of more than 2000cc and which —
(a) are constructed or adapted to carry not more than 5 passengers excluding the driver, or
(b) have a maximum gross weight of not more than 2500kg.not being in either case, an off-road vehicle. 1.4.93
PART II
SCHEDULE 3B
Regulation 36C
PART I
1 
The Secretary of State may authorise—
(a) an individual proposing to seal speed limiters other than on behalf of another person;
(b) a firm; or
(c) a corporation; and a person or body so authorised is referred to in this Schedule as an “authorised sealer”.
2 
An authorised sealer shall comply with the conditions set out in Part II of this Schedule and with such other conditions as may from time to time be imposed by the Secretary of State.
3 
An authorised sealer may charge for sealing a speed limiter.
4 
The Secretary of State may at any time withdraw an authorisation granted under this Schedule.
5 

(1) An authorisation under this Schedule in respect of an individual shall terminate if—
(a) he dies;
(b) is  made  bankrupt or, in Scotland, has his estate sequestrated; or
(c) becomes a person who lacks capacity (within the meaning of the Mental Capacity Act 2005 (c.9)) to carry on the activities covered by the authorisation or, in Scotland, becomes incapable of managing his own affairs.
(2) An authorisation under this Schedule in respect of a firm shall terminate if the firm is dissolved or if all the partners are adjudged bankrupt.
(3) An authorisation under this Schedule in respect of a company shall terminate if—
(a) the company goes into liquidation or enters administration;
(b) a receiver or manager of the trade or business of the company is appointed; or
(c) possession is taken by or on behalf of the holders of any debenture secured by a floating charge, or any property of the company comprised in or subject to the charge, occurs.
PART II
6 
An authorised sealer shall not—
(a) seal a speed limiter fitted to a vehicle to which regulation 36A applies unless he is satisfied that the speed limiter fulfils the requirements of—
(i) paragraph (5)(b);
(ii) paragraph (6), (7) or (7A); and
(iii) paragraph (8) or (9),
of that regulation, or
(b) seal a speed limiter fitted to a vehicle to which regulation 36B applies unless he is satisfied that the speed limiter fulfils the requirements of—
(i) paragraph (7)(b);
(ii) paragraph (8) or (9); and
(iii) paragraph (10) or (11),
of that regulation.
7 
When sealing a speed limiter fitted to a vehicle to which regulation 36A applies, an authorised sealer shall do so in such a manner that the speed limiter fulfils the requirements of paragraph (5)(a) of that regulation.
8 
When sealing a speed limiter fitted to a vehicle to which regulation 36B applies, an authorised sealer shall do so in such a manner that the speed limiter fulfils the requirements of paragraph (7)(a) of that regulation.
9 
When an authorised sealer has sealed a speed limiter fitted to a vehicle to which section 36A applies he shall supply the owner with a plate which fulfils the requirements of regulation 70A.
10 
When an authorised sealer has sealed a speed limiter fitted to a vehicle to which section 36B applies he shall supply the owner with a plate which fulfils the requirements of regulation 70A
SCHEDULE 4
(see regulation 40)
PART I
1 

In this Schedule, unless the context otherwise requires, the following expressions
have the meanings hereby assigned to them respectively, that is to say—

 “gas container” means a container fitted to a motor vehicle or a trailer and intended
for the storage of gaseous fuel for the purpose of the propulsion of the vehicle
or the drawing vehicle as the case may be;
 “gas cylinder” means a container fitted to a motor vehicle or a trailer and intended
for the storage of compressed gas for the purpose of the propulsion of the
vehicle or the drawing vehicle as the case may be;
 “compressed gas” means gaseous fuel under a pressure exceeding 1.0325 bar above atmospheric
pressure;
 “pipe line” means all pipes connecting a gas container or containers— 
(a) 
to the engine or the mixing device for the supply of a mixture of gas and
air to the engine; and
(b) to the filling point on the vehicle;
 “pressure pipe line”
means any part of a pipe line intended for the conveyance
of compressed gas; and
 “reducing valve” means an apparatus which automatically reduces the pressure of the gas
passing through it.
2 
Every gas container
shall—
(a) be securely
attached to the vehicle in such manner as not to be liable to displacement
or damage due to vibration or other cause; and
(b) be so placed
or insulated as not to be adversely affected by the heat from the exhaust
system.
3 

(1) Every pipe
line shall be supported in such manner as to be protected from excessive vibration
and strain.
(2) No part
of a pipe line shall be in such a position that it may be subjected to undue
heat from the exhaust system.
(3) Every pressure
pipe line shall be made of steel solid drawn.
(4) The maximum
unsupported length of a pressure pipe line shall not exceed 920 mm.
4 

(1) Every union
shall be so constructed and fitted that it will—
(a) not
be liable to work loose or develop leakage when in use; and
(b) be readily
accessible for inspection and adjustment.
(2) No union
on a pressure pipe line or on a gas cylinder shall contain a joint other than
a metal to metal joint.
5 
Every reducing
valve shall be—
(a) so fitted
as to be readily accessible; and
(b) so constructed
that there can be no escape of gas when the engine is not running.
6 

(1) Every valve
or cock intended to be subjected to a pressure exceeding 6.8948 bar shall
be of forged steel or of brass or bronze complying with the specification
contained in Part II
of this Schedule.
(2) A valve
or cock shall be fitted to the pipe line to enable the supply of gas from
the container or containers to the mixing device to be shut off.
(3) 
(a) In the
case of a pressure pipe line the valve or cock shall be placed between the
reducing valve and the container or containers and shall be readily visible
and accessible from the outside of the vehicle and a notice indicating its
position and method of operation shall be affixed in a conspicuous position
on the outside of the vehicle carrying the gas container or containers.
(b) In other
cases, if the valve or cock is not so visible and accessible as aforesaid,
a notice indicating its position shall be affixed in a conspicuous position
on the outside of the vehicle carrying the container or containers.
7 
Every pressure
gauge connected to a pressure pipe line shall be so constructed as not to
be liable to deterioration under the action of the particular gases employed
and shall be so constructed and fitted that—
(a) in the event
of failure of such pressure gauge no gas can escape into any part of the vehicle;

(b) it is not
possible owing to leakage of gas into the casing of the pressure gauge for
pressure to increase therein to such extent as to be liable to cause a breakage
of the glass thereof; and
(c) in the event
of failure of such pressure gauge the supply of gas thereto may be readily
cut off.
8 

(1) Every connection
for charging a gas container shall be outside the vehicle and in the case
of a public service vehicle no such connection shall be within 610 mm of any
entrance or exit.
(2) An efficient
shut-off valve shall be fitted as near as practicable to the filling point.
Provided that
in cases where compressed gas is not used a cock or an efficient non-return
valve may be fitted in lieu thereof.
(3) Where compressed
gas is used an additional emergency shut-off valve shall be fitted adjacent
to the valve referred to in sub-paragraph (2) of this paragraph.
(4) A cap shall
be fitted to the gas filling point on the vehicle and where compressed gas
is used this cap shall be made of steel with a metal to metal joint.
9 

(1) Where a
trailer is used for the carriage of a gas cylinder, a reducing valve shall
be fitted on the trailer.
(2) No pipe
used for conveying gas from a trailer to the engine of a vehicle shall contain
compressed gas.
10 

Every part of a gas container propulsion system shall be—
(a) so placed
or protected as not to be exposed to accidental damage and shall be soundly
and properly constructed of suitable and well-finished materials capable of
withstanding the loads and stresses likely to be met with in operation and
shall be maintained in an efficient, safe and clean condition; and
(b) so designed
and constructed that leakage of gas is not likely to occur under normal working
conditions, whether or not the engine is running.
PART II
1 
The stamping
or pressing from which each valve is manufactured shall be made from bars
produced by (a) extrusion, 
(b) rolling, (c) forging, (d) extrusion and drawing, or 
(e) rolling and drawing.
2 
Each stamping or
pressing shall be heat treated so as to produce an equiaxed microstructure
in the material.
3 
All stampings
or pressings and the bars from which they are made shall be free from cracks,
laminations, hard spots, segregated materials and variations in composition.

4 
Tensile tests shall
be made on samples of stampings or pressings taken at random from any consignment.
The result of the tensile test shall conform to the following conditions—

 Yield Stress.—Not less than 231.6 N/mm
2.
 Ultimate Tensile Stress.—Not less than 463.3 N/mm
2.
 Elongation on 50 mm gauge length.—Not less than 25%.

Note.—When the gauge length
is less than 50 mm the required elongation shall be proportionately reduced.

The fractured test piece shall be free from piping
and other defects (see paragraph 3 of this Part of this Schedule).
SCHEDULE 5
(see regulations 40 and 96)
1 
In this Schedule—
 “check valve” means a device which permits the flow of gas in one direction and prevents
the flow of gas in the opposite direction;
 “design pressure” means the pressure which a part of a gas system has been designed and
constructed safely to withstand;
 “double-check valve”
means a device which consists of two check valves in
series and which permits the flow of gas in one direction and prevents the
flow of gas in the opposite direction;
 “electrically operated valve” means a device which is electrically operated and opens when the ignition is switched on and closes when the ignition is switched off or the power is otherwise cut off;
 “excess flow valve” means a device which automatically and instantaneously reduces to a minimum
the flow of gas through the valve when the flow rate exceeds a set value;

 “fixed gas container”
means a gas container which is attached to a vehicle
permanently and in such a manner that the container can be filled without
being moved;
 “gas container” means any container, not being a container for the carriage of gas as
goods, which is fitted to or carried on a motor vehicle or trailer and is
intended for the storage of gas for either— 
(a) the propulsion of the motor vehicle, or
(b) the operation of a gas-fired appliance;
 “high pressure” means a pressure exceeding 1.0325 bar absolute;
 “high pressure pipeline”
 means a pipeline intended to contain
gas at high pressure;
 “pipeline” means any pipe or passage connecting any two parts of a gas propulsion
system of a vehicle or of a gas-fired appliance supply system on a vehicle
or any two points on the same part of any such system;
 “portable gas container”
 means a gas container which may be attached
to a vehicle but which can readily be removed;
 “pressure relief valve”
 means a device which opens automatically
when the pressure in the part of the gas system to which it is fitted exceeds
a set value, reaches its maximum flow capacity when the set valve is exceeded
by 10% and closes automatically when the pressure falls below a set value
; and
 “reducing valve” means a device which automatically reduces the pressure of the gas passing
through it, and includes regulator devices.
2 

(1) Every gas container
shall—
(a) be capable
of withstanding the pressure of the gas which may be stored in the container
at the highest temperature which the gas is likely to reach,
(b) if fitted
inside the vehicle be so arranged as to prevent so far as is practicable the
possibility of gas entering the engine, passenger or living compartments due
to leaks or venting from the container or valves, connections and gauges immediately
adjacent to it, and the space containing these components shall be so ventilated
and drained as to prevent the accumulation of gas,
(c) be securely
attached to the vehicle in such a manner as not to be liable to displacement
or damage due to vibration or other cause, and
(d) be so placed
and so insulated or shielded as not to suffer any adverse effect from the
heat of the exhaust system of any engine or any other source of heat.
(2) Every portable
gas container shall be either—
(a) hermetically
sealed, or
(b) fitted
with a valve or cock to enable the flow of gas from the container to be stopped.

(3) Every fixed
gas container shall—
(a) be fitted
with—
(i) at
least one pressure relief valve, and
(ii) 
at least one manually operated valve which may be extended by an internal
dip tube inside the gas container so as to indicate when the container has
been filled to the level corresponding to the filling ratio specified in the
British Standards Institution Specification for Filling Ratios and Developed
Pressure for Liquefiable and Permanent Gases (as defined, respectively, in
paragraphs 3.2 and 3.5 of the said Specification) published in May 1976 under
the number BS 5355, and
(b) be conspicuously
and permanently marked with its design pressure.
(4) If any fixed
gas container is required to be fitted in a particular attitude or location,
or if any device referred to in sub-paragraph (3) above requires the container
to be fitted in such a manner, then it shall be conspicuously and permanently
marked to indicate that requirement.
(5) If the operation
of any pressure relief valve or other device referred to in sub-paragraph
(3) above may cause gas to be released from the gas container, an outlet shall
be provided to lead such gas to the outside of the vehicle so as not to suffer
any adverse effect from the heat of the exhaust system of any engine or any
other source of heat, and that outlet from the pressure relief valve shall
not be fitted with any other valve or cock.
3 

(1) Every connection
for filling a fixed gas container shall be on the outside of the vehicle.

(2) There shall
be fitted to every fixed gas container either—
(a) a manually
operated shut-off valve and an excess flow valve, or
(b) a manually
operated shut-off valve and a single check valve, or
(c) a double-check
valve.and all parts of these valves in contact with gas shall be made
entirely of suitable metal except that they may contain non-metal washers
and seals provided that such washers and seals are supported and constrained
by metal components.
(3) In every case
where a pipe is attached to a gas container for the purpose of filling the
gas container there shall be fitted to the end of the pipe furthest from the
gas container a check valve or a double-check valve.
(4) There shall
be fitted over every gas filling point on a vehicle a cap which shall—

(a) prevent
any leakage of gas from the gas filling point,
(b) be secured
to the vehicle by a chain or some other suitable means,
(c) be made
of suitable material, and
(d) be fastened
to the gas filling point by either a screw thread or other suitable means.

4 

(1) Every pipeline
shall be fixed in such a manner and position that—
(a) it will
not be adversely affected by the heat of the exhaust system of any engine
or any other source of heat,
(b) it is protected
from vibration and strain in excess of that which it can reasonably be expected
to withstand, and
(c) in the
case of a high pressure pipeline it is so far as is practicable accessible
for inspection.
(2) Save as provided
in sub-paragraph (4) below, every high pressure pipeline shall be—
(a) a rigid
line of steel, copper or copper alloy of high pressure hydraulic grade, suitable
for service on road vehicles and designed for a minimum service pressure rating
of not less than 75 bar absolute, and
(b) effectively
protected against, or shielded from, or treated so as to be resistant to,
external corrosion throughout its length unless it is made from material which
is corrosion resistant under the conditions which it is likely to encounter
in service.
(3) No unsupported
length of any high pressure pipeline shall exceed 600 mm.
(4) Flexible hose may be used in a high pressure pipeline either if—
(a) 
(i) it is reinforced either by stainless steel wire braid or by textile braid,
(ii) its length does not exceed 500mm, and
(iii) save in the case of a pipeline attached to a gas container for the purpose of filling that container the flexibility which it provides is necessary for the construction or operation of the gas system of which it forms a part, or
(b) its length exceeds 500mm and it complies with Annex 8 of ECE Regulation 67.01 and is approved and marked in accordance with that Regulation.
(4A) In the case of a motor vehicle which first used gas as a fuel for its propulsion on or after 1st January 2004 a flexible hose of any length used in a high pressure pipe line shall comply with the requirements of Annex 8 of ECE Regulation 67.01 shall be approved and marked in accordance with that Regulation and shall be no longer than is reasonably necessary.
(5) If a high pressure
pipeline or part of such a pipeline is so constructed or located that it may,
in the course of its normal use (excluding the supply of fuel from a gas container),
contain liquid which is prevented from flowing, a relief valve shall be incorporated
in that pipeline.
5 

(1) Every union
and joint on a pipeline or gas container shall be so constructed and fitted
that it will—
(a) not be
liable to work loose or leak when in use, and
(b) be readily
accessible for inspection and maintenance.
(2) Every union
on a high pressure pipeline or on a gas container shall be made of suitable
metal but such a union may contain non-metal washers and seals provided that
such washers and seals are supported and constrained by metal components.

6 
Every reducing valve shall be made of suitable
materials and be so fitted as to be readily accessible for inspection and
maintenance.
7 

(1) Every pressure
relief valve which is fitted to any part of a gas system (including a gas
container) shall—
(a) be made
entirely of suitable metal and so constructed and fitted as to ensure that
the cooling effect of the gas during discharge shall not prevent its effective
operation,
(b) be capable,
under the most extreme temperatures likely to be met (including exposure to
fire), of a discharge rate which prevents the pressure of the contents of
the gas system from exceeding its design pressure,
(c) have a
maximum discharge pressure not greater than the design pressure of the gas
container,
(d) be so designed
and constructed as to prevent unauthorised interference with the relief pressure
setting during service, and
(e) have outlets
which are—
(i) so
sited that so far as is reasonably practicable in the event of an accident
the valve and its outlets are protected from damage and the free discharge
from such outlets is not impaired, and
(ii) 
so designed and constructed as to prevent the collection of moisture and other
foreign matter which could adversely affect their performance.
(2) The pressure
at which a pressure relief valve is designed to start lifting shall be clearly
and permanently marked on every such valve.
(3) Every pressure
relief valve which is fitted to a gas container shall communicate with the
vapour space in the gas container and not with any liquefied gas.
8 

(1) A valve or
cock shall be fitted to every supply pipeline as near as practicable to every
fixed gas container and such valve or cock shall by manual operation enable
the supply of gas from the gas container to the gas system to be stopped,
and save as provided in sub-paragraph (2) below, shall—
(a) if fitted
on the outside of the vehicle, be readily visible and accessible from the
outside of the vehicle, or
(b) if fitted
inside the vehicle be readily accessible for operation and be so arranged
as to prevent so far as is practicable the possibility of gas entering the
engine, passenger or living compartments due to leaks, and the space containing
the valve or cock shall be so ventilated and drained as to prevent the accumulation
of gas in that space.
(2) Where a fixed gas container supplies no gas system other than a gas propulsion system—
(a) an electrically operated valve may be fitted in place of the valve or cock referred to in sub-paragraph (1) above; and
(b) either—
(i) it shall be fitted as near as practicable to the gas container; or
(ii) if fitted in addition to the valve or cock referred to in sub-paragraph (1) above it shall either be incorporated into that valve or cock or be fitted immediately downstream from it; and
(c) it shall if fitted inside the vehicle be so arranged as to prevent as far as is practicable the possibility of gas entering the engine, passenger or living compartments due to leaks, and the space containing the valve shall be so ventilated and drained as to prevent the accumulation of gas in that space.
(3) A notice clearly
indicating the position, purpose and method of operating every valve or cock
referred to in sub-paragraphs (1) and (2) above shall be fixed—
(a) in all
cases, in a conspicuous position on the outside of the vehicle, and
(b) in every
case where the valve or cock is located inside the vehicle in a conspicuous
position adjacent to the gas container.
(4) In the case
of a high pressure pipeline for the conveyance of gas from the gas container
an excess flow valve shall be fitted as near as practicable to the gas container
and such valve shall operate in the event of a fracture of the pipeline or
other similar failure.
(5) All parts of
every valve or cock referred to in this paragraph which are in contact with
gas shall be made of suitable metal, save that they may contain non-metal
washers and seals provided that such washers and seals are supported and constrained
by metal components.
9 
Every gauge connected to a gas container or
to a pipeline shall be so constructed as to be unlikely to deteriorate under
the action of the gas used or to be used and shall be so constructed and fitted
that—
(a) no gas can
escape into any part of the vehicle as a result of any failure of the gauge,
and
(b) in the event
of any failure of the gauge the supply of gas to the gauge can be readily
stopped.
Provided that the requirement
specified in sub-paragraph (b) above shall
not apply in respect of a gauge fitted as an integral part of a gas container.

10 

(1) Every gas
propulsion system shall be so designed and constructed that—
(a) the supply
of gas to the engine is automatically stopped by the operation of a valve
when the engine is not running at all or is not running on the supply of gas,
and
(b) where
a reducing valve is relied on to comply with sub-paragraph 
(a) above, the supply of gas to the engine is automatically stopped
by the operation of an additional valve when the engine is switched off.
(2) Where the
engine of a vehicle is constructed or adapted to run on one or more fuels
as alternatives to gas, the safety and efficiency of the engine and any fuel
system shall not be impaired by the presence of any other fuel system.
11 
In the case of a bus there shall be fitted
as near as practicable to the gas container a valve which shall stop the flow
of gas into the gas supply pipeline in the event of—
(a) the angle
of tilt of the vehicle exceeding that referred to in regulation 6 of the Public Service Vehicles (Conditions
of Fitness, Equipment, Use and Certification) Regulations 1981, and

(b) the deceleration
of the vehicle exceeding 5g.
12 
Every part of a gas-fired appliance shall be—

(a) so designed
and constructed that leakage of gas is unlikely to occur, and
(b) constructed
of materials which are compatible both with each other and with the gas used.

13 
Every gas-fired appliance shall be—
(a) so located
as to be easily inspected and maintained,
(b) so located
and either insulated or shielded that its use shall not cause or be likely
to cause danger due to the presence of any flammable material,
(c) so constructed
and located as not to impose undue stress on any pipe or fitting, and
(d) so fastened
or located as not to work loose or move in relation to the vehicle.
14 
With the exception of catalytic heating appliances,
every appliance of the kind described in regulation 96(3)(b) or (c)
which is fitted to a motor vehicle shall be fitted with a flue which shall
be—
(a) connected
to an outlet which is on the outside of the vehicle,
(b) constructed
and located so as to prevent any expelled matter from entering the vehicle,
and
(c) located so
that it will not cause any adverse effect to, or suffer any adverse effect
from, the exhaust outlet of any engine or any other source of heat.
15 
Every part of a gas propulsion system or a
gas-fired appliance system, excluding the appliance itself, shall be—

(a) so far as
is practicable so located or protected as not to be exposed to accidental
damage,
(b) soundly and
properly constructed of materials which are compatible with one another and
with the gas used or to be used and which are capable of withstanding the
loads and stresses likely to be met in operation, and
(c) so designed
and constructed that leakage of gas is unlikely to occur.
Schedule 5A
(see regulation 94)
1 

(1) In this Schedule—
 “hydrogen-fuelled vehicle” means a vehicle that is specified in regulation 94(2B) or (2C) and that uses compressed gaseous hydrogen as a fuel to propel the vehicle.
(2) Other expressions that are used in this Schedule and that are defined in ECE Regulation 134.02 have the same meaning in this Schedule as they have in ECE Regulation 134.02.
2 

(1) A fuelling receptacle must be fitted to a hydrogen-fuelled vehicle.
(2) A fuelling receptacle fitted to a hydrogen-fuelled vehicle must—
(a) prevent reverse flow of gaseous hydrogen fuel to the atmosphere;
(b) have a label affixed close to the fuelling receptacle that shows—
(i) the fuel type,
(ii) the maximum fuelling pressure,
(iii) the nominal working pressure, and
(iv) the date of removal from service of each container;
(c) be mounted on the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle to ensure positive locking of the fuel nozzle;
(d) be protected from tampering and ingress of dirt and water.
(3) A fuelling receptacle fitted to a hydrogen-fuelled vehicle must not—
(a) be mounted within the external energy absorbing elements of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle;
(b) be installed so that access for refilling is in the passenger compartment or an unventilated compartment.
3 

(1) The compressed hydrogen storage system downstream of a pressure regulator must be protected against overpressure.
(2) Use of an overpressure protection device, including a pressure relief device, is sufficient to meet the requirement in sub-paragraph (1).
(3) The set pressure of an overpressure protection device must be lower than or equal to the maximum allowable working pressure for the appropriate section of the compressed hydrogen storage system.
4 

(1) Compressed hydrogen gas discharge from a thermally-activated pressure relief device of a compressed hydrogen storage system must not be directed—
(a) into enclosed or semi-enclosed spaces;
(b) into or towards any vehicle wheel housing;
(c) towards each container;
(d) forward from the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle, or horizontally (parallel to the road) from the back or sides of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle.
(2) If a thermally-activated pressure relief device of a compressed hydrogen storage system has a vent line, the outlet of this vent line must be protected by a cap.
5 

(1) The hydrogen gas discharge from other pressure relief devices that are not thermally-activated, including burst discs, must not be directed—
(a) towards exposed electrical terminals, exposed electrical switches or other ignition sources;
(b) into or towards the passenger compartment;
(c) into or towards any vehicle wheel housing;
(d) towards each container.
(2) At the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle exhaust system’s point of discharge, the hydrogen concentration level must not exceed—
(a) 4.0% average by volume during any moving three-second time interval during normal operation, including start-up and shut-down;
(b) 8.0% at any time.
(3) The test procedure that must be followed, for determining the hydrogen concentration level in sub-paragraph (2), is the compliance test for the vehicle exhaust system in paragraph 4 of Annex 5 to ECE Regulation 134.02.
6 

(1) Hydrogen leakage and permeation from the compressed hydrogen storage system must not directly vent into the passenger compartment, or into any enclosed or semi-enclosed spaces within the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle that contain unprotected ignition sources.
(2) Any single failure downstream of the main hydrogen shut-off valve must not result in accumulations in levels of hydrogen concentration in the passenger compartment.
(3) The requirement in sub-paragraph (2) is met if the hydrogen concentration in the passenger compartment does not exceed 1.0% by volume when tested in accordance with sub-paragraph (4).
(4) The test procedure for determining levels of hydrogen concentration in sub-paragraph (2) is the test procedure for integrity of enclosed spaces and detection systems in paragraph 3.2 of Annex 5 to ECE Regulation 134.02.
(5) If, during operation, the hydrogen concentration exceeds 3.0% by volume in the air in the enclosed or semi-enclosed spaces of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle, a warning must be provided in accordance with paragraph 7.
(6) If, during operation, the hydrogen concentration exceeds 4.0% by volume in the air in the enclosed or semi-enclosed spaces of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle, the main shut-off valve must be closed to isolate the compressed hydrogen storage system.
7 

(1) A warning must be provided if the condition in paragraph 6(5) is met.
(2) The warning must be given by a visual signal or display text and must—
(a) be visible to the driver while the driver is in their designated seating position with their seat belt fastened;
(b) be yellow in colour if the detection system malfunctions;
(c) be red in colour if a single failure results in a hydrogen concentration exceeding 3.0% by volume in the air in the enclosed or semi-enclosed spaces of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle;
(d) when illuminated, be visible to the driver under both daylight and night time driving conditions;
(e) remain illuminated if the ignition locking system is on the ‘On’ or ‘Run’ position, or if the propulsion system is activated, and—
(i) hydrogen concentration exceeds 3.0% by volume in the air in the enclosed or semi-enclosed spaces of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle, or
(ii) a detection system malfunction exists.
8 

(1) The hydrogen fuelling line, including piping and joints, that is downstream of any shut-off valves to the fuel cell system or the engine must not leak.
(2) Compliance with sub-paragraph (1) must be verified at nominal working pressure using the test procedure set out in paragraph 5 of Annex 5 to ECE Regulation 134.02.
9 

(1) Each container must be mounted in a position that is between two vertical planes that are located perpendicular to the centre line of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle.
(2) The two vertical planes referred to in sub-paragraph (1) must be located at least—
(a) 200 mm rearward from the front edge of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle, and
(b) 200 mm forward of the rear edge of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle.
(3) Each container must be mounted in a position that is between the two vertical planes that are parallel to the centre line of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle.
(4) The two vertical planes referred to in sub-paragraph (3) must be located at least 200 mm inside from the outermost edges of the hydrogen-fuelled vehicle in the proximity of each container.
(5) A hydrogen-fuelled vehicle that does not comply with sub-paragraphs (3) and (4) may still be considered compliant with the requirements of this paragraph if it has passed the lateral impact test specified in paragraph 7.2.4.3 of ECE Regulation 134.02.
(6) For the purposes of sub-paragraph (5)—
(a) the lateral impact test must be conducted by a Technical Service that is responsible for conducting approval tests and that has been communicated to the United Nations secretariat in accordance with paragraph 12 of ECE Regulation 134.02;
(b) the requirement for the compressed hydrogen storage system to be filled with hydrogen or helium in paragraph 1 of Part 1 or paragraph 1 of Part 2 of Annex 8 to ECE Regulation 134.02 does not need to be met if the following criteria are met instead—
(i) the compressed hydrogen storage system is empty or filled with an inert gas to a pressure below or equal to 20 bar for the purposes of the lateral impact test,
(ii) after the lateral impact test, any inert gas is removed and the compressed hydrogen storage system is repressurised to nominal working pressure with hydrogen or helium, before the Technical Service tests hydrogen gas leakage in accordance with paragraph 7.2.1 of ECE Regulation 134.02, and
(iii) for the purposes of sub-paragraph (ii), the time interval for starting measurement of hydrogen gas leakage is after the compressed hydrogen storage system has been repressurised with hydrogen or helium;
(c) demonstration of compliance through the calculation method described in paragraph 7.2.4.3 of ECE Regulation 134.02 is not permitted as an alternative to the lateral impact test.
SCHEDULE 6
(see regulation 41)
The requirements referred to
in regulation 41
are as follows—

1 
The outlet of every
exhaust pipe fitted to a minibus shall be either at the rear or on the off
side of the vehicle.
2 

(1) Every minibus shall
be fitted with at least—
(a) one service door
on the near side of the vehicle; and
(b) one emergency
door either at the rear or on the off side of the vehicle so, however, that
any emergency door fitted on the off side of the vehicle shall be in addition
to the driver's door and there shall be no requirement for an emergency door
on a minibus if it has a service door at the rear in addition to the service
door on the near side.
(2) No minibus shall
be fitted with any door on its off side other than a driver's door and an
emergency door.
3 
Every emergency
door fitted to a minibus, whether or not required pursuant to these Regulations,
shall—
(a) be clearly marked,
in letters not less than 25 mm high, on both the inside and the outside, “EMERGENCY
DOOR” or “FOR EMERGENCY USE ONLY”, and the means of its
operation shall be clearly indicated on or near the door;
(b) if hinged, open outwards;

(c) be capable of being
operated manually; and
(d) when fully opened,
give an aperture in the body of the vehicle not less than 1210 mm high nor
less than 530 mm wide.
4 

(1) Every power-operated
door fitted to a minibus shall—
(a) incorporate transparent
panels so as to enable a person immediately inside the door to see any person
immediately outside the door;
(b) be capable of
being operated by a mechanism controlled by the driver of the vehicle when
in the driving seat;
(c) be capable, in
the event of an emergency or a failure of the supply of power for the operation
of the door, of being opened from both inside and outside the vehicle by controls
which—
(i) over-ride
all other controls,
(ii) are placed
on, or adjacent to, the door, and
(iii) are accompanied
by markings which clearly indicate their position and method of operation
and state that they may not be used by passengers except in an emergency;

(d) have a soft edge
so that a trapped finger is unlikely to be injured; and
(e) be controlled
by a mechanism by virtue of which if the door, when closing, meets a resistance
exceeding 150 Newtons, either
 —the door will cease to close and begin to open, or

 —the closing force will cease and the door will become
capable of being opened manually.
(2) No minibus shall
be equipped with a system for the storage or transmission of energy in respect
of the opening or closing of any door which, either in normal operation or
if the system fails, is capable of adversely affecting the operation of the
vehicle's braking system.
5 

No minibus shall be fitted with—
(a) a door which can
be locked from the outside unless, when so locked, it is capable of being
opened from inside the vehicle when stationary;
(b) a handle or other
device for opening any door, other than the driver's door, from inside the
vehicle unless the handle or other device is designed so as to prevent, so
far as is reasonably practicable, the accidental opening of the door, and
is fitted with a guard or transparent cover or so designed that it must be
raised to open the door;
(c) a door which is not
capable of being opened, when not locked, from inside and outside the vehicle
by a single movement of the handle or other device for opening the door;
(d) a door in respect
of which there is not a device capable of holding the door closed so as to
prevent any passenger falling through the doorway;
(e) a side door which
opens outwards and is hinged at the edge nearest the rear of the vehicle except
in the case of a door having more than one rigid panel;
(f) a door, other than
a power-operated door, in respect of which there is not either—
(i) a slam lock of
the two-stage type; or
(ii) a device by
means of which the driver, when occupying the driver's seat, is informed if
the door is not securely closed, such device being operated by movement of
the handle or other device for opening the door or, in the case of a handle
or other device with a spring-return mechanism, by movement of the door as
well as of the handle or other device.
Provided that the provisions
of sub-paragraphs (a), (c), (d) and (f) of this paragraph shall not apply in respect
of a near side rear door forming part of a pair of doors fitted at the rear
of a vehicle if that door is capable of being held securely closed by the
other door of that pair.
6 

(1) Save as provided
in sub-paragraph (2), every minibus shall be fitted with mirrors or other
means so that the driver, when occupying the driver's seat, can see clearly
the area immediately inside and outside every service door of the vehicle.

(2) The provisions of
sub-paragraph (1) shall be deemed to be satisfied in respect of a rear service
door if a person 1.3 metres tall standing 1 metre behind the vehicle is visible
to the driver when occupying the driver's seat.
7 

(1) Save as provided
in sub-paragraph (2), there shall be unobstructed access from every passenger
seat in a minibus to at least two doors one of which must be on the nearside
of the vehicle and one of which must be either at the rear or on the offside
of the vehicle.
(2) Access to one only
of the doors referred to in sub-paragraph (1) may be obstructed by either
or both of—
(a) a seat which
when tilted or folded does not obstruct access to that door; and
(b) a lifting platform
or ramp which—
(i) does not
obstruct the handle or other device on the inside for opening the door with
which the platform or ramp is associated, and
(ii) when the
door is open, can be pushed or pulled out of the way from the inside so as
to leave the doorway clear for use in an emergency.
8 
Every
minibus shall be fitted as respects every side service door with a grab handle
or a hand rail to assist passengers to get on or off the vehicle.
9 

(1) No seat shall be
fitted to any door of a minibus.
(2) Every seat and every
wheelchair anchorage fitted to a minibus shall be fixed to the vehicle.
(3) No seat, other than
a wheelchair, fitted to a minibus shall be less than 400 mm wide, and in ascertaining
the width of a seat no account shall be taken of any arm-rests, whether or
not they are folded back or otherwise put out of use.
(4) No minibus shall
be fitted with an anchorage for a wheelchair in such a manner that a wheelchair
secured to the anchorage would face either side of the vehicle.
(5) No minibus shall
be fitted with a seat—
(a) facing either
side of the vehicle and immediately forward of a rear door unless the seat
is fitted with an arm-rest or similar device to guard against a passenger
on that seat falling through the doorway; or
(b) so placed that
a passenger on it would, without protection, be liable to be thrown through
any doorway which is provided with a power-operated door or down any steps,
unless the vehicle is fitted with a screen or guard which affords adequate
protection against that occurrence.
10 

(1) Save as provided
in sub-paragraph (2) no minibus shall be fitted with any—
(a) electrical circuit
which is liable to carry a current exceeding that for which it was designed;

(b) cable for the
conduct of electricity unless it is suitably insulated and protected from
damage;
(c) electrical circuit,
other than a charging circuit, which includes any equipment other than—

(i) a starter
motor,
(ii) a glow
plug,
(iii) an ignition
circuit, and
(iv) a device
to stop the vehicle's engine,unless it includes a fuse or circuit breaker so, however, that
one fuse or circuit breaker may serve more than one circuit; or
(d) electrical circuit
with a voltage exceeding 100 volts unless there is connected in each pole
of the main supply of electricity which is not connected to earth a manually-operated
switch which is—
(i) capable
of disconnecting the circuit, or, if there is more than one, every circuit,
from the main supply,
(ii) not capable
of disconnecting any circuit supplying any lamp with which the vehicle is
required to be fitted, and
(iii) located
inside the vehicle in a position readily accessible to the driver.
(2) The provisions of
sub-paragraph (1) do not apply in respect of a high tension ignition circuit
or a circuit within a unit of equipment.
11 
No minibus shall be
fitted with a fuel tank or any apparatus for the supply of fuel which is in
the compartments or other spaces provided for the accommodation of the driver
or passengers.
12 
Every minibus
shall be provided with lamps to illuminate every step at a passenger exit
or in a gangway.
13 

Every minibus, including all bodywork and fittings, shall be soundly and properly
constructed of suitable materials and maintained in good and serviceable condition,
and shall be of such design as to be capable of withstanding the loads and
stresses likely to be met in the normal operation of the vehicle.
14 
In this Schedule—

 “driver's door” means a door fitted to a minibus for use by the driver;
 “emergency door” means a door fitted to a minibus for use by passengers in an emergency
; and
 “service door” means a door fitted to a minibus for use by passengers in normal circumstances
.
SCHEDULE 7
PART I
(see regulation 42)
A fire extinguisher which complies in all respects with the specification for portable fire extinguishers issued by the British Standards Institution numbered BS 5423: 1977 or BS 5423: 1980 or BS 5423:1987 and which_
(a) has a minimum test fire rating of 8A or 21B, and
(b) contains water or foam or contains, and is marked to indicate that it contains, halon 1211 or halon 1301.

PART II
(see regulation 43)

(i) Ten antiseptic wipes, foil packed;
(ii) One conforming disposable bandage (not
less than 7.5 cm wide);
(iii) Two triangular bandages;
(iv) One packet of 24 assorted adhesive dressings;

(v) Three large sterile unmedicated ambulance
dressings (not less than 15.0 cm × 20.0 cm);
(vi) Two sterile eye pads, with attachments;

(vii) Twelve assorted safety pins; and
(viii) One pair of rustless blunt-ended scissors.


SCHEDULE 7XA
Regulations 55A(1) and 61(11)
PART I
1 

(1) An item numbered 2 or higher in the Table in regulation 55A shall not apply to—
(a) a type approval end of series vehicle;
(b) a non-type approval end of series vehicle; or
(c) a late entry into service vehicle,
if it is first used before the first anniversary of the date specified in column 3 of the item.
(2) An item numbered 8, 9 or 11 in Table II of regulation 61 shall not apply to a type approval end of series vehicle if it is first used before the first anniversary of the date specified in column 3 of the item.
(3) An item numbered 9 or 11 in Table II of regulation 61 shall not apply to a non-type approval end of series vehicle if it is first used before the first anniversary of the date specified in column 3 of the item.
(4) An item numbered 10 or higher (other than 11) in Table II of regulation 61 shall not apply to—
(a) a type approval end of series vehicle;
(b) a non-type approval end of series vehicle; or
(c) a late entry into service vehicle,
if it is first used before the first anniversary of the date specified in column 3 of the item.
(4A) No provision of any Community Directive specified in an item numbered 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61A shall be deemed to be a design, construction or equipment requirement applying to, or to impose limit values in relation to, a vehicle by virtue of paragraphs (2) and (3) of regulation 61A, if the vehicle is—
(a) a type approval end of series vehicle,
(b) a non-type-approval end of series vehicle, or
(c) a late entry into service vehicle,
in relation to such a provision, and the vehicle is first used before the first anniversary of the date as is specified (as defined in regulation 61A) by the relevant Community Directive in item 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61A.
(4B) Paragraphs (5) and (6) of regulation 61B shall not apply to a type approval end of series vehicle, if it has been first used before 1st January 2018 and is lawfully equipped with an air conditioning system designed to contain high-GWP fluorinated greenhouse gases.
(5) Parts II, III and IV of this Schedule shall have effect for the purpose of interpreting the expressions “type approval end of series vehicle”, “non-type approval end of series vehicle” and “late entry into service vehicle” respectively for the purposes of this paragraph.
PART II
2 

(1) For the purposes of paragraph 1, a vehicle is a type approval end of series vehicle, in relation to item 8, 9 or 11 in Table II in regulation 61, if it meets the requirements of sub-paragraph (3) in relation to the item.
(2) For the purposes of paragraph 1 , and subject to regulation 3 of the Motor Vehicles (Type Approval for Goods Vehicles) (Great Britain) (Amendment) Regulations 2007, a vehicle is a type approval end of series vehicle, in relation to an item numbered 2 or higher in the Table in regulation 55A or an item numbered 10 or higher (other than item 11) in Table II in regulation 61 or any provision of any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61Aor paragraph (5) or (6) of regulation 61B if—
(a) by virtue of either item 2J of Schedule 1 or Schedule 1C to the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations, ... or
(b) by virtue of Schedule 1C to the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations, ...
(c) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
( which, other than item 2J of Schedule 1,  in certain circumstances defer the date on which certain requirements relating to exhaust emissions, air conditioning systems, noise and silencers cease to apply) the type approval requirements that applied to the vehicle on the date specified in column 3 of the item or, in relation to any provision of any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61A, on the date as is specified (as defined in regulation 61A) by the relevant Community Directiveor, in relation to paragraph (5) or (6) of regulation 61B, 1st January 2017, are the same as the type approval requirements that applied to the vehicle immediately before the date so specified in that column of that item  or in relation to any provision of any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61A, the date as is specified by the relevant Community Directiveor, in relation to paragraph (5) or (6) of regulation 61B, immediately before 1st January 2017.
(2A) For the purposes of paragraph 1, a vehicle is a type-approval end of series vehicle in relation to an item in the Table in regulation 55A , or in Table II in regulation 61, or any provision in any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61A, or paragraph (5) or (6) of regulation 61B if it has been exempted from that item or provision under—
(a) the laws of a relevant State (as defined by paragraph 5(1)(c)) other than the United Kingdom, or
(b) the laws applicable in Northern Ireland,
pursuant to Article 8(2)(b) of the Framework Directive , or Article 27 of Community Directive 2007/46.
(2B) For the purposes of paragraph 1, a vehicle is a type approval end of series vehicle in relation to—
(a) an item numbered 2 or higher in the Table in regulation 55A,
(b) an item numbered 10 or higher (other than item 11) in Table II in regulation 61,
(c) any provision of any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61A, or
(d) paragraph (5) or (6) of regulation 61B,
if a direction given under regulation 12 or 13 of the EC Whole Vehicle Type Approval Regulations or regulation 31 or 32 of the Vehicle Approval Regulations is in force in relation to the vehicle.
(3) A vehicle meets the requirements of this sub-paragraph, in relation to the item, if—
(a) it was manufactured during the relevant period;
(b) one of the following conditions is satisfied—
(i) a certificate of conformity was issued in respect of the vehicle before the date specified in column 3 of the item by virtue of a TAC issued before the date specified in column 4 of the Table in paragraph 6 in relation to the item, or
(ii) a sub-MAC was issued in respect of the vehicle before the date specified in column 3 of the item by virtue of a MAC issued before the date specified in column 4 of that Table;
(c) it was in the territory of a relevant state at some time before the date specified in column 3 of the item; and
(d) the number of relevant vehicles which were—
(i) manufactured before that vehicle was manufactured, and
(ii) still in existence on the date specified in column 3 of that item, was less than the specified number of 50 (whichever is the greater).
(4) For the purposes of sub-paragraph (3)—
(a) “MAC” means a Minister’s approval certificate issued under section 58(1) of the Road Traffic Act 1988;
(b) “sub-MAC” means a Minister’s approval certificate issued under section 58(4) of the Road Traffic Act 1988; and
(c) “TAC” means a type approval certificate.
3 

(1) For the purposes of paragraph 2(3)(d), in relation to a particular vehicle to which Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations apply (in this paragraph referred to as “the vehicle in question”) and a particular item, a “relevant vehicle” is a vehicle (other than the vehicle in question) which—
(a) is a vehicle to which those Regulations apply;
(b) meets the requirements specified in paragraphs (a) to (c) of paragraph 2(3);
(c) was manufactured by the manufacturer of the vehicle in question; and
(d) had not been registered under the Vehicles (Excise) Act 1971 or the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 before the date specified in column 3 of the item.
(2) For the purposes of paragraph 2(3)(d) in relation to a particular vehicle to which the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations apply (in this paragraph referred to as “the vehicle in question”) and a particular item, a “relevant vehicle” is a vehicle (other than the vehicle in question) which—
(a) is a vehicle to which those Regulations apply;
(b) meets the requirements specified in paragraphs (a) to (c) of paragraph 2(3);
(c) was manufactured by the manufacturer of the vehicle in question; and
(d) had not been registered under the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 before the date specified in column 3 of the item.
4 

(1) For the purposes of paragraph 2(3)(d), in relation to a particular vehicle to which the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations apply (in this paragraph referred to as “the vehicle in question”) and a particular item, “the specified number” is 10% of the total number of vehicles to which those Regulations apply that were both—
(a) manufactured by the manufacturer of the vehicle in question; and
(b) registered under the Vehicles Excise Act 1971 or the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 during the one year period ending immediately before the date specified in column 3 of the item.
(2) For the purposes of paragraph 2(3)(d), in relation to a particular vehicle to which the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations apply (in this paragraph referred to as “the vehicle in question”) and a particular item, “the specified number” is 10% of the total number of vehicles to which those Regulations apply that were both—
(a) manufactured by the manufacturer of the vehicle in question, and
(b) registered under the Vehicles Excise Act 1971 or the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 during the one year period ending immediately before the date specified in column 3 of the item.
5 

(1) For the purposes of paragraph 2(3)(c)—
(a) at any material time before the 5th November 1993, “relevant state” means a member State;
(b) in relation to any time on or after 5th November 1993 but before 1st May 1995, “relevant state” means an EEA State other than Liechtenstein; and
(c) in relation to any time on or after 1st May 1995, “relevant state” means any EEA State.
(2) For the purposes of this paragraph—
 “EEA agreement” means the Agreement on the European Economic Area signed at Oporto on the 2nd May 1992 as adjusted by the protocol signed at Brussels on the 17th March 1993; and
 “EEA State” means a State which is a contracting party to the EEA agreement.
6 
For the purposes of this Part, “the relevant period” in relation to an item numbered 8, 9 or 11 in Table II in regulation 61 is the period—
(a) beginning on the date specified in column 2 of the Table below against that item; and
(b) ending immediately before the date specified in column 3 of the Table below against that item.

THE TABLE
1 2 3 4 5
Item in Table II in regulation 61 Date on which the relevant period begins: Date immediately before which the relevant period ends. Date before which type approval etc. needs to be granted Date in column 3 of Table II in regulation 61
8 1st August 1990 1st September 1992 1st July 1992 31st December 1992
9 1st April 1991 1st October 1993 1st October 1993 1st October 1993
11 1st August 1992 1st August 1994 1st October 1993 1st October 1994
PART III
7 

(1) For the purposes of paragraph 1, a vehicle is a non-type approval end of series vehicle in relation to an item or provision if it meets the requirements of sub-paragraph (2) in relation to the item or provision.
(2) A vehicle meets the requirements of this sub-paragraph in relation to an item or provision if—
(a) it is a vehicle to which neither the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations nor the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations nor the EC Whole Vehicle Type Approval Regulationsnor the Vehicle Approval Regulations apply;
(b) it was manufactured during the relevant period;
(c) no EC certificate of conformity has been issued in respect of the vehicle;
(d) it was in the territory of a relevant state at some time before the end of the relevant period; and
(e) the number of relevant vehicles which were both—
(i) manufactured before that vehicle was manufactured, and
(ii) still in existence on the date specified in column 3 in the item or in relation to any provision of any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61A, on the date as is specified (as defined in regulation 61A) by the relevant Community Directive, is less than the specified number, or 100, whichever is the greater.
8 
For the purposes of paragraph 7(2)(e), in relation to a particular vehicle (in this paragraph referred to as “the vehicle in question”) and a particular item , or provision, a “relevant vehicle” is a vehicle (other than the vehicle in question) which—
(a) meets the requirements specified in paragraphs (a) to (d) of paragraph 7(2);
(b) is a “vehicle” within the meaning of Community Directive 70/220 (as amended by Community Directive 83/351) or Community Directive 2005/55 (as amended by Community Directives 2005/78 and 2006/51);
(c) was manufactured by the manufacturer of the vehicle in question;
(d) had not been registered under the Vehicles (Excise) Act 1971 or the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 during the relevant period.
9 

(1) For the purposes of paragraph 7(2)(e), in relation to a particular vehicle (in this paragraph referred to as “the vehicle in question”) and a particular item  or provision,  “the specified number” is 30% of the total number of vehicles that—
(a) are vehicles to which neither the Type Approval (Great Britain) Regulations nor the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations nor the EC Whole Vehicle Type Approval Regulations apply; and
(b) meet the requirements of sub-paragraph (2).
(2) A vehicle meets the requirements of this paragraph if it—
(a) is a “vehicle” within the meaning of Community Directive 70/220 (as amended by Community Directive 83/351) or Community Directive 2005/55 (as amended by Community Directives 2005/78 and 2006/51);
(b) was manufactured by the manufacturer of the vehicle in question; and
(c) was registered under the Vehicles (Excise) Act 1971 or the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 during the one year period ending immediately before the date specified in column 3 of that item or, in relation to any provision of any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 of the Table in regulation 61A, before the date as is specified (as defined in regulation 61A) by the relevant Community Directive.
10 
Paragraph 5 in Part II of this Schedule shall have effect for the purposes of paragraph 7(2)(d) as it has effect for the purposes of paragraph 2(3)(c).
11 
For the purposes of paragraphs 7(2)(d), “the relevant period”—
(a) in relation to an item numbered 9 or 11 in Table II in regulation 61 is the period—
(i) beginning on the date specified in column 2 of the Table below against the item, and
(ii) ending immediately before the date specified in column 3 of the Table below against the item; and
(b) in relation to any item in the Table in regulation 55A or any item numbered 10 or higher (other than 11) in the said Table II is the two year period ending immediately before the date specified in column 3 of that item ; and
(c) in relation to any provision of any Community Directive specified in an item numbered 1 or 2 in the Table in regulation 61A is the two year period ending immediately before the date as is specified (as defined in regulation 61A) by the relevant Community Directive in the Table.

THE TABLE
1 2 3 4
Item in Table II in regulation 61 Date on which relevant period begins Date immediately before which the relevant period ends Date in column 3 of Table II in regulation 61
9 1st April 1991 1st October 1993 1st October 1993
11 1st August 1992 1st August 1994 1st October 1994
PART IV
12 
For the purposes of paragraph 1, a vehicle is a late entry into service vehicle, in relation to an item or provision, if—
(a) no EC certificate of conformity has been issued in respect of the vehicle;
(b) it was in the territory of a relevant state at some time before the date specified in column 3 of the item or, in relation to any provision of any Community Directive specified in item 1 or 2 of the Table in regulation 61A, before the date as is specified (as defined in regulation 61A) by the relevant Community Directive;
(c) it was manufactured at least two years before that date.
13 
Paragraph 5 in Part II of this Schedule shall have effect for the purposes of paragraph 12(b) as it has effect for the purposes of paragraph 2(3)(c).
SCHEDULE 7A
Regulations 57, 57A and 57B
PART I
1 

(1) For the purposes of these Regulations a vehicle meets the requirements of an item in the Table below if its sound level does not exceed by more than 1 dB(A) the relevant limit specified in column 2 in that item when measured under the conditions specified in column 3 in that item by the method specified in column 4 in that item using the apparatus prescribed in regulation 55(6).
(2) In this Part of this Schedule, “moped” has the same meaning as in regulation 57.

TABLE
1 2 3 4
 Limits of sound level  
Item Mopeds Vehicles other than mopeds Conditions of measurement Methods of measurement
1 73 dB(A) Limit determined in accordance with paragraph 2.1.1 of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015 by reference to the cubic capacity of the vehicle Conditions specified in paragraph 2.1.3 of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015 Methods specified in paragraph 2.1.4 of Annex I to Community Directive 78/1015
2 73 dB(A) First stage limit determined in accordance with paragraph 2.1.1 of Annex I to  Community Directive 87/56 by reference to the cubic capacity of the vehicle Conditions specified in paragraph 2.1.3 of Annex I to Community Directive 87/56 Methods specified in paragraph 2.1.4 of Annex I to Community Directive 87/56
3 74 dB(A) The limit specified in item 2 plus 1 dB(A) As in item 2 As in item 2
PART II
2 
The requirements of this paragraph are that the silencer—
(a) is so constructed that—
(i) it meets the requirements of paragraphs 3 and 4 of British Standard BS AU 193: 1983;
(ii) were it to be fitted to an unused vehicle of the same model as the vehicle in question, the unused vehicle would meet the requirements of paragraph 5.2 of that Standard; and
(b) is clearly and indelibly marked “BS AU 193/T2”.
3 
The requirements of this paragraph are that the silencer—
(a) is so constructed that—
(i) it meets the requirements of paragraphs 3 and 4 of British Standard BS AU 193a: 1990;
(ii) were it to be fitted to an unused vehicle of the same model as the vehicle in question, the unused vehicle would meet the requirements of paragraph 5.2 of that Standard; and
(b) is clearly and indelibly marked “BS AU 193a: 1990/T2”
4 
The requirements of this paragraph are that the silencer—
(a) is so constructed that—
(i) it meets the requirements of paragraphs 3 and 4 of British Standard BS AU 193a: 1990;
(ii) were it to be fitted to an unused vehicle of the same model as the vehicle in question, the unused vehicle would meet the requirements of paragraph 5.3 of that Standard; and
(b) is clearly and indelibly marked “BS AU 193a: 1990/T3”.
5 
In this Part of this Schedule—
(a) “British Standard BS AU 193: 1983” means the British Standard Specification for replacement motor cycle and moped exhaust systems published by the British Standards Institution under reference number BS AU 193: 1983;
(b) “British Standard BS AU 193a: 1990” means the British Standard Specification for replacement motor cycle and moped exhaust systems published by the British Standards Institution under reference number BS AU 193a: 1990.
PART III
6 
Paragraph (4) of regulation 57A shall not apply to a replacement silencer if the second requirement referred to in that regulation would be met were there substituted in Part II of this Schedule,—
(a) for the references to provisions in either of the British Standard Specifications, references to equivalent provisions in a corresponding standard; and
(b) for the references to a mark, references to a mark made pursuant to that corresponding standard indicating that the silencer complies with those equivalent provisions.
7 
In this Part of this Schedule, “corresponding standard”, in relation to a British Standard Specification, means—
(a) a standard or code of practice of a national standards body or equivalent body of any member State;
(b) any international standard recognised for use as a standard by any member State; or
(c) a technical specification or code of practice which, whether mandatory or not, is recognised for use as a standard by a public authority of any member State,where the standard, code of practice, international standard or technical specification provides, in relation to motor cycles, a level of noise limitation and safety equivalent to that provided by the British Standard Specification and contains a requirement as respects the marking of silencers equivalent to that provided by that instrument.
8 
A reference in this part of this Schedule to a British Standard Specification is a reference to British Standard BS AU 193: 1983 or British Standard BS AU 193a: 1990; and “either of the British Standard Specifications” shall be construed accordingly.
9 
In this Part of this Schedule, “British Standard BS AU 193: 1983” and “British Standard BS AU 193a: 1990” have the same meanings as in Part II of this Schedule.
SCHEDULE 7B
Regulation 61(10AA), (10AB) and (10BA)
PART I
1 
This Part of this Schedule applies to a vehicle if, when the engine is running without load at a normal idling speed, the carbon monoxide content of the exhaust emissions from the engine exceeds the relevant percentage of the total exhaust emissions from the engine by volume.
2 
This Part of this Schedule also applies to a vehicle if, when the engine is running without load at a fast idling speed,—
(a) the carbon monoxide content of the exhaust emissions from the engine exceeds the relevant percentage of the total exhaust emissions from the engine by volume;
(b) the hydrocarbon content of those emissions exceeds 0.02% of the total exhaust emissions from the engine by volume; or
(c) the lambda value is not within the relevant limits.
3 
For the purposes of paragraph 1 of this Part of this Schedule the relevant percentage, in respect of a vehicle, is—
(a) if the vehicle is of a description specified in the Annex to the emissions publication, the percentage shown against that description of vehicle in column 2(a) of that Annex; ...
(b) if the vehicle is not of such a description and is first used before 1st July 2002, 0.5%; or
(c) if the vehicle is not of such a description and is first used on or after 1st July 2002, 0.3%.
3A. 
For the purposes of paragraph 2(a) of this Part of this Schedule the relevant percentage, in respect of a vehicle, is, when the engine is running without load at a fast idling speed—
(a) if the vehicle is of a description specified in the Annex to the emissions publication, the percentage shown against that description of vehicle in column 3(a) of that Annex; ...
(b) if the vehicle is not of such a description and is first used before 1st July 2002, 0.3%; or
(c) if the vehicle is not of such a description and is first used on or after 1st July 2002, 0.2%.
4 
For the purposes of this Part of this Schedule, in the case of a vehicle of a description specified in the Annex to the emissions publication, the engine shall be regarded as running at a normal idling speed if and only if the engine is running at a rotational speed between the minimum and maximum limits shown against that description of vehicle in columns 2(b) and (c) respectively of that Annex.
5 
For the purposes of this Part of this Schedule an engine shall be regarded as running at a fast idling speed if—
(a) the vehicle is of a description specified in the Annex to the emissions publication and the engine is running at a rotational speed between the minimum and maximum limits shown against that description of vehicle in columns 3(e) and (f) respectively of that Annex; or
(b) the vehicle is not of such a description and the engine is running at a rotational speed between 2,500 and 3,000 revolutions per minute.
6 
For the purposes of this Part of this Schedule, the lambda value, in respect of a vehicle, shall be regarded as being within relevant limits, if and only if—
(a) the vehicle is of a description specified in the Annex to the emissions publication and the lambda value is between the minimum and maximum limits shown against that description of vehicle in columns 3(c) and (d) respectively of that Annex; or
(b) the vehicle is not of such a description and the lambda value is between 0.97 and 1.03.
7 
In this Part of this Schedule—
(a) a reference to the lambda value, in relation to a vehicle at any particular time, is a reference to the ratio by mass of air to petrol vapour in the mixture entering the combustion chambers divided by 14.7; and
(b) “the emissions publication” is the publication entitled “In Service Exhaust Emission Standards for Road Vehicles – Nineteenth edition” (ISBN 978-1-84864-176-1) published by the Department for Transport.
PART II
8 

(1) This Part of this Schedule applies to a vehicle if, when subjected to a relevant test, the coefficient of absorption of the exhaust emissions from the engine of the vehicle immediately after leaving the exhaust system exceeds—
(a) if the vehicle is first used before 1st July 2008 and the engine of that vehicle is turbo-charged, 3.0 per metre , or the manufacturer’s plate value if lower;
(b) if the vehicle is first used before 1st July 2008 and the engine of that vehicle is not turbo-charged, 2.5 per metre , or the manufacturer’s plate value if lower; or
(c) if the vehicle is first used on or after 1st July 2008 but before 1st January 2014, the manufacturer’s plate value if available, otherwise, 1.5 per metre;
(d) if the vehicle is first used on or after 1st January 2014, the manufacturer’s plate value if available, otherwise 0.7 per metre.
(2) In paragraph (1) “a relevant test” means a test conducted in accordance with—
(a) point 8.2.2 of Annex 1 of Directive 2014/45/EU; or
(b) point 8.2.2 of Annex 2 of Directive 2014/47/EU
9 
In this Part of this Schedule—
(a) “coefficient of absorption” shall be construed in accordance with paragraph 3.5 of Annex VII to Community Directive 72/306; ...
(b) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SCHEDULE 8
(see regulation 66)
PART IParticulars to be shown
on plate for motor vehicles (including motor vehicles forming part of articulated
vehicles)
1. Manufacturer's name.
2. Vehicle type.
3. Engine type and power 
(a).
4. Chassis or serial number.
5. Number of axles.
6. Maximum axle weight for each axle (b).
7. Maximum gross weight 
(c).
8. Maximum train weight 
(d).
9. Maximum weight in Great Britain for each
axle (b) (e).
10. Maximum gross weight in Great Britain (c) (e). 
(a) The power need not
be shown in the case of a motor vehicle manufactured before 1st October 1972
(hereinafter in this Schedule referred to as “an excepted vehicle”)
and shall not be shown in the case of any motor vehicle which is propelled
otherwise than by a compression ignition engine.
(b) This weight as respects each axle is
the sum of the weights to be transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels
of that axle.
(c) This weight is the sum of the weights
to be transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels of the motor vehicle
(including any load imposed by a trailer, whether forming part of an articulated
vehicle or not, on the motor vehicle).
(d) This weight is the sum of the weights
to be transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels of the motor vehicle
and of any trailer drawn, but this item need not be completed where the motor
vehicle is not constructed to draw a trailer.
(b), (c), (d) References to the weights to
be transmitted to the road surface by all or any of the wheels of the vehicle
or of any trailer drawn are references to the weights so to be transmitted
both of the vehicle or trailer and of any load or persons carried by it.
(e) This item need not be completed in the
case of an excepted vehicle or in the case of a vehicle which is a locomotive
or motor tractor.

PART IIParticulars to be shown
on plate for trailers (including trailers forming part of articulated vehicles)

1. Manufacturer's name.
2. Chassis or serial number.
3. Number of axles.
4. Maximum weight for each axle (a).
5. Maximum load imposed on drawing vehicle (b).
6. Maximum gross weight 
(c).
7. Maximum weight in Great Britain for each
axle (a) (e).
8. Maximum gross weight in Great Britain (c) (f).
9. Year of manufacture 
(d). 
(a) This weight as respects each axle is
the sum of the weights to be transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels
of that axle.
(b) Only for trailers forming part of articulated
vehicles or where some of the weight of the trailer or its load is to be imposed
on the drawing vehicle. This item need not be completed in the case of a converter
dolly manufactured before 1st February 1992
(c) This weight is the sum of the weights
to be transmitted to the road surface by all the wheels of the trailer, including
any weight of the trailer to be imposed on the drawing vehicle.
(a), (b), (c) References to the weights to
be transmitted to the road surface by all or any of the wheels of the trailer
are references to the weight so to be transmitted both of the trailer and
of any load or persons carried by it and references to the weights to be imposed
on the drawing vehicle are references to the weights so to be imposed both
of the trailer and of any load or persons carried by it except where only
the load of the trailer is imposed on the drawing vehicle.
(d) This item need not be completed in the
case of a trailer manufactured before 1st April 1970.
(e) This item need not be completed in the
case of a trailer manufactured before 1st October 1972.
(f) This item need not be completed in the
case of a trailer manufactured before 1st October 1972 or which forms part
of an articulated vehicle.

PART III
1 
The power of an engine, which is to be shown
only in the case of a compression ignition engine on the plate in respect
of item 3 in Part I
of this Schedule, shall be the amount in kilowatts equivalent to the installed
power output shown in a type test certificate issued—
(a) by a person
authorised by the Secretary of State for the type of engine to which the engine
conforms; and
(b) in accordance
with either—
(i) the
provisions relating to the installed brake power output specified in the British
Standard Specification for the Performance of Diesel Engines for Road Vehicles
published on 19th May 1971 under the number BS AU 141a: 1971;
(ii) 
the provisions relating to the net power specified in Community Directive 80/1269 but
after allowance has been made for the power absorbed by such equipment, at
its minimum power setting, driven by the engine of the vehicle as is fitted
for the operation of the vehicle (other than its propulsion) such power being
measured at the speed corresponding to the engine speed at which maximum engine
power is developed; or
(iii) 
the provisions of Annex 10 of ECE Regulation 24.02
as further amended with effect from 15th February 1984  or Annex 10 of ECE Regulation 24.03 or Community Directive 88/195 relating to the method
of measuring internal combustion engine net power, but after allowance has
been made for the power absorbed by any disconnectable or progressive cooling
fan, at its maximum setting, and by any other such equipment, at its minimum
power setting, driven by the engine of the vehicle as is fitted for the operation
of the vehicle (other than its propulsion), such power being measured at the
speed corresponding to the engine speed at which maximum engine power is developed.

2 

(1) Subject to paragraph 3A, the weights
to be shown on the plate in relation to items 6, 7 and 8 in Part I
and in relation to items 4, 5 and 6 in Part II
shall be the weight limits at or below which the vehicle is considered fit
for use, having regard to its design, construction and equipment and the stresses
to which it is likely to be subject in use, by the Secretary of State if the
vehicle is one to which the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations or the Motor Vehicles (Approval) Regulations 2001 apply,
and by the manufacturer if the vehicle is one to which those Regulations do
not apply.Provided that,
where alterations are made to a vehicle which may render the vehicle fit for
use at weights which exceed those referred to above in this paragraph and
shown on the plate—
(a) 
there may be shown on the plate, in place of any of those weights, such new
weights as the manufacturer of the vehicle or any person carrying on business
as a manufacturer of motor vehicles or trailers (or a person duly authorised
on behalf of that manufacturer or any such person) or a person authorised
by the Secretary of State considers to represent the weight limits at or below
which the vehicle will then be fit for use, having regard to its design, construction
and equipment and to those alterations and to the stresses to which it is
likely to be subject in use; and
(b) 
the name of the person who has determined the new weights shall be shown on
the plate as having made that determination and, where he is a person authorised
by the Secretary of State, his appointment shall be so shown.
(2) In relation
to a vehicle manufactured on or after 1st October 1972, in the foregoing paragraph—

(a) the
references to equipment shall not be treated as including a reference to the
type of tyres with which the vehicle is equipped; and
(b) for
the words “weight limits at or below”
in both places where they occur there shall be substituted the words “maximum weights at”.
3 
Subject to paragraph 3A, the weights to be shown on the plate in respect
of—
(a) item 9 in Part I of this Schedule
shall be the weights shown at item 6 in that Part and in respect of item 7 in Part II of this Schedule
shall be the weights shown at item 4 in that Part, in each case reduced so
far as necessary to indicate the maximum weight applicable to each axle of
the vehicle, if the vehicle is not to be used in contravention of regulations 23, 75, 78 or 79,
and if the tyres with which the vehicle is equipped are not, as respects strength,
to be inadequate to support the weights to be so shown at item 9 and item
7;
(b) item 10
in the said Part I shall be the weight shown at item 7 in that Part and in
respect of item 8 in the said Part II shall be the weight shown at item 6
in that Part, in each case reduced so far as necessary to indicate the maximum
permissible weight applicable if the vehicle is not to be used in contravention
of regulation 75
if the tyres with which the vehicle is equipped are not, as respects strength,
to be inadequate to support the weights to be so shown at item 10 and item
8.
3A 
In the case of a vehicle—
(a) which complies with the requirements specified in regulation 4(2) of the Motor Vehicles (Approval) Regulations 2001;
(b) in respect of which a Minister’s approval certificate has been issued under section 58 of the 1988 Act for the purposes of the type approval requirements prescribed by those Regulations; and
(c) in respect of which a Minister’s approval certificate has not subsequently been issued under that section for the purposes of the type approval requirements prescribed by the Type Approval for Goods Vehicles Regulations,the weight shown on the plate in relation to items 7 and 10 in Part I of this Schedule shall be 3,500 kg.
4 

(1) Subject
to sub-paragraph (2) of this paragraph weights on plates first affixed to
a vehicle on or after 1st October 1972 shall be shown in kilograms and weights
on plates first so affixed before that date shall be shown in tons and decimals
thereof.
(2) Where
a new weight is first shown on a plate by virtue of the proviso to paragraph 2(1) the
weight shall be shown as if it was on a plate first affixed to a vehicle on
the date it was first shown.
5 
All letters and figures shown on the plate shall
be not less than 6mm in height.
6 
In this Schedule references to the manufacturer
of a motor vehicle or trailer are in relation to—
(a) a vehicle
constructed with a chassis which has not previously formed part of another
vehicle, references to the person by whom that chassis was made;
(b) any other
vehicle, references to the person by whom that vehicle was constructed.
SCHEDULE 9
(see regulation 69)
1 
The plate required by regulation 69 shall be firmly
attached to a part of the motor cycle which is not normally subject to replacement
during the life of the motor cycle.
2 
The plate shall be in the form shown in the
diagram in this paragraph, shall have dimensions not less than those shown
in that diagram and shall show the information provided for in that diagram
and detailed in the Notes below.
Notes:
1. The categories are “standard motor
cycle” and “moped”.
2. The details are— 
(a) for standard motor cycles— 
(i) the engine capacity,
(ii) the maximum engine power, and
(iii) the power to weight ratio,
() provided that the details under (ii) and (iii) need not be
shown for a vehicle first used before 1st January 1982;
(b) for mopeds— 
(i) the engine capacity,
(ii) the kerbside weight, and
(iii) the maximum speed.
3. The vehicle identification number (VIN)
shall be marked in the form used by the manufacturer to identify any one individual
vehicle.
4. In the case of a plate fitted to a vehicle
first used before 1st January 1982 or to a moped this dimension shall be 40
mm.
3 
The information on the plate shall be shown
in characters not less than 4 mm in height and in the positions on the plate
indicated in the diagram above.
4 
No information, other than that provided for
in the diagram above, shall be marked within the rectangle which is shown
in that diagram.
5 
In this Schedule and, in respect of the definition
of “moped”, in regulations 54
and 57—

 “maximum engine power”
means the maximum net power the motor cycle engine will
develop, in kilowatts, when measured in accordance with the test conditions
specified in the International Standard number ISO 4106 developed by the technical
committee of the International Organisation for Standardisation, and approved
by member bodies, including the United Kingdom, and published under the reference
ISO 1978 4106–09–01;
 “moped” means 
a motor cycle which— 
(a) has a kerbside weight not exceeding 250 kg, and
(b) 
if propelled by an internal combustion engine, has an engine with a cylinder
capacity which does not exceed 50 cc, and
(c) 
is designed to have a maximum speed not exceeding 30 mph when driven under
the conditions set out in paragraph 6.

 “power to weight ratio”
means the ratio of the maximum engine power to the kerbside
weight of the vehicle measured, as regards the maximum engine power, in kilowatts
and, as regards the kerbside weight, in 1000 kg;
 “standard motor cycle”
means a motor cycle which is not a moped.

6 
A motor cycle shall regarded as complying with
paragraph (c) of the definition of “moped”
in paragraph 5
if it cannot exceed 35 mph when tested under the following conditions—

(a) the surface on which
it is tested shall be dry asphalt or concrete;
(b) the rider shall be
a person not exceeding 75 kg in weight;
(c) no passenger or load
shall be carried;
(d) the test route shall
be so located that acceleration to, and deceleration from, maximum speed can
take place elsewhere than on the test route itself;
(e) the test route shall
not have a gradient exceeding 5%;
(f) the motor cycle shall
be ridden in opposite directions along the test route and the speed recorded
for the purpose of the test shall (in order to minimise the effect of wind
resistance and gradient) be the average of speeds shown for each direction;

(g) when being driven
along the test route, the motor cycle shall be driven in such manner and in
such gear as to achieve the maximum speed of which it is capable; and
(h) if the motor cycle
is fitted with a device which can, without the use of specialist tools or
equipment, be readily modified or removed so as to increase its maximum speed,
the test shall be carried out with the device in the modified condition or,
as the case may be, without the device.
SCHEDULE 10
(see regulation 70)

SCHEDULE 10A

SCHEDULE 10B
(see Regulation 3(2))
Note: A weight is not required in the box for Maximum Train Weight unless the vehicle is capable of being lawfully used on a road in Great Britain, having regard to Schedule 11A, at a greater train weight than the train weight at which it could lawfully be used ignoring that Schedule.

SCHEDULE 10C
(see Regulation 3(2))
Note: A weight is not required in the box for Maximum Train Weight unless the vehicle is capable of being lawfully used on a road in Great Britain, having regard to Schedule 11A, at a greater train weight than the train weight at which it could lawfully be used ignoring that Schedule.

SCHEDULE 11
(see regulations 75, 77 and 79)
PART I (see regulation 75)
1 
The maximum permitted laden weight of a two or three axle vehicle to which this Part applies of a description specified in column 2 of Table I below shall, for the purposes of regulation 75, be the weight specified in column 3 of that item.
2 
In the case of a vehicle to which this Part applies and which is not of a description specified in an item in column 2 of Table I below, the maximum permitted laden weight shall, for the purposes of regulation 75, be the weight specified in column 4 of Table II below in the item which is appropriate having regard to columns 2 and 3 of that Table.

TABLE I
(1) (2) (3)
Item Description of Vehicle Maximum permitted laden weight (kg)
1 A two axle trailer in which—
(a) the two axles are closely spaced, and
(b) the distance between the foremost axle of the trailer and the rearmost axle of the drawing vehicle is at least 4.2m 18,000
2 A three axle trailer in which—
(a) the three axles are closely spaced, and
(b) the distance between the foremost axle of the trailer and the rearmost axle of the drawing vehicle is at least 4.2m 24,000
3 A two axle motor vehicle which is a goods vehicle in which the distance between the foremost and rearmost axles is at least 3.0m 17,000
4 A two axle trailer in which the distance between the foremost axle and the rearmost axle is at least 3.0m 18,000

TABLE II
(1) (2) (3) (4)
Item No. of axles Distance between foremost and rearmost axles (metres) Maximum permitted laden weight (kg)
1 2 Less than 2.65 14,230
2 2 At least 2.65 16,260
3 3 or more Less than 3.0 16,260
4 3 or more At least 3.0 but less than 3.2 18,290
5 3 or more At least 3.2 but less than 3.9 20,330
6 3 or more At least 3.9 but less than 4.9 22,360
7 3 At least 4.9 25,000
8 4 or more At least 4.9 but less than 5.6 25,000
9 4 or more At least 5.6 but less than 5.9 26,420
10 4 or more At least 5.9 but less than 6.3 28,450
11 4 or more At least 6.3 30,000
PART IA (see regulation 75)
1 
Subject to paragraph 2, the maximum permitted gross weight of a vehicle to which this Part applies shall, for the purposes of regulation 75, be the weight shown in column 4 of the Table below in the item which is appropriate, having regard to columns 2 and 3 in that Table.
2 
In the case of a vehicle to which this Part applies being a two axle goods vehicle which has a distance between its axles of at least 3.0m, the maximum permitted laden weight for the purposes of regulation 75 shall be 17,000 kg.

TABLE
(1) (2) (3) (4)
Item No. of axles Distance between foremost and rearmost axles (metres) Maximum permitted laden weight (kg)
1 2 Less than 2.65 14,230
2 2 At least 2.65 16,260
3 3 or more Less than 3.0 16,260
4 3 or more At least 3.0 but less than 3.2 18,290
5 3 or more At least 3.2 but less than 3.9 20,330
6 3 or more At least 3.9 but less than 4.9 22,360
7 3 or more At least 4.9 but less than 5.2 25,000
8 3 At least 5.2 26,000
9 4 or more At least 5.2 but less than 6.4 The distance in metres between the foremost and rearmost axles multiplied by 5,000, rounded up to the next 10 kg
10 4 or more At least 6.4 32,000
PART II
(see regulation 75)

1 2 3 4 5
Item
 No. of axles Distance between foremost and rearmost axles (metres) Weight not exceeded by any axle not being the foremost
or rearmost (kg) Maximum permitted laden
weight (kg)

1 2 
At least 2.0 — 14,230

2 2 
At least 2.4 — 16,260

3 2 
At least 2.7 — 17,000 ...

4 3 or more At least 3.0 8,390 20,330

5 3 or more At least 3.8 8,640 22,360

6 3 or more At least 4.0 10,500 22,500

7 3 or more At least 4.3 9,150 24,390

8 3 or more At least 4.9 10,500 24,390
PART III
(see regulation 77)

1 2 3 ...
Item Relevant axle spacing (metres) Maximum weight (kg) 
 (a) Where motor vehicle
has 2 axles (b) Where motor vehicle has
more than 2 axles

1 At least 2.0 At least 2.0 20,330 

2 At least 2.2 At least 2.2 22,360 

3 At least 2.6 At least 2.6 23,370 

4 At least 2.9 At least 2.9 24,390 

5 At least 3.2 At least 3.2 25,410 

6 At least 3.5 At least 3.5 26,420 

7 At least 3.8 At least 3.8 27,440 

8 At least 4.1 At least 4.1 28,450 

9 At least 4.4 At least 4.4 29,470 

10 At least 4.7 At least 4.7 30,490 

11 At least 5.0 At least 5.0 31,500 

12 At least 5.3 At least 5.3 32,520 

13 At least 5.5 At least 5.4 33,000 
14 At least 5.8 At least 5.6 
34,000 
15 
At least 6.2 At least 5.8 35,000 
16 At least 6.5 At least
6.0 36,000 

17 At least 6.7 At least 6.2 37,000 
18 At least 6.9 At least 6.3 
38,000 
PART IV (see regulation 77)

(1) (2) (3)
Item Type of articulated vehicle Maximum permitted weight (kg)
1 Motor vehicle first used on or after 1st April 1973 and semi-trailer having a total of 5 or more axles 38,000
2 Motor vehicle with 2 axles first used on or after 1st April 1973 and semi-trailer with 2 axles while being used for international transport 35,000
3 Motor vehicle with 2 axles first used on or after 1st April 1973 in which—
(a) every driving axle not being a steering axle is fitted with twin tyres; and
(b) every driving axle is fitted with road friendly suspension;and a semi-trailer with 2 axles 35,000
4 Motor vehicle and semi–trailer having a total of 4 or more axles and not described in item 1, 2 or 3. 32,520
5 Motor vehicle with 2 axles first used on or after 1st April 1973 in which—
(a) every driving axle not being a steering axle is fitted with twin tyres; and
(b) every driving axle is fitted with road friendly suspension;and a semi-trailer with 1 axle 26,000
6 Motor vehicle with 2 axles and a semi-trailer with 1 axle being a combination not described in item 5 25,000
PART V Regulation 79(2)

(1) (2) (3)
Item Description of vehicle Maximum permitted weight of the two closely spaced axles (kg)
1 A motor vehicle or trailer in which (in either case) the distance between the two closely-spaced axles is less than 1.3 metres 16,000
2 A vehicle being—
(a) a motor vehicle in which the distance between the two closely-spaced axles is at least 1.3m, or
(b) a trailer in which that distance is at least 1.3m and less than 1.5m,not being a vehicle described in item 3 or 4 18,000
3 A motor vehicle in which the distance between the two closely-spaced axles is at least 1.3m and—
(a) every driving axle not being a steering axle is fitted with twin tyres; and
(b) either every driving axle is fitted with road friendly suspension or neither of the two closely-spaced axles has an axle weight exceeding 9,500 kg 19,000
4 A trailer in which—
(a) the two closely-spaced axles are driven from the motor vehicle drawing the trailer and are fitted with twin tyres; and
(b) either those axles are fitted with road friendly suspension or neither of them has an axle weight exceeding 9,500 kg 19,000
5 A trailer in which the distance between the two closely-spaced axles is at least 1.5m and less than 1.8m 19,320
6 A trailer in which the distance between the two closely-spaced axles is at least 1.8m 20,000
PART VI Regulation 79(3)

(1) (2) (3)
Item Description of vehicle Maximum permitted weight of the three closely-spaced axles (kg)
1 A vehicle in which the smallest distance between any two of the three closely-spaced axles is less than 1.3m 21,000
2 A vehicle in which the smallest distance between any two of the three closely-spaced axles is at least 1.3m and at least one of those axles does not have air suspension 22,500
3 A vehicle in which the smallest distance between any two of the three closely-spaced axles is at least 1.3m and all three axles are fitted with air suspension 24,000
PART VII
(see regulation 79(4))
...

SCHEDULE 11A (see regulations 76(1A), 77(2A) and  80(2B))
PART I
1 
Regulation 76 does not apply to a wheeled heavy motor car drawing one wheeled trailer if the requirements set out in Part II of this Schedule are for the time being fulfilled.
2 
Regulation 77 does not apply to an articulated vehicle if the requirements set out in Part III of this Schedule are for the time being fulfilled.
2A 
Regulations 75, 76, 77 and 78 do not apply to an articulated vehicle if the requirements set out in Part IIIA of this Schedule are for the time being fulfilled.
PART II
3 

(1) The drawing vehicle and trailer must be carrying a relevant receptacle as part of an intermodal transport operation, each such receptacle being on a journey—
(a) to a railhead or water transport terminal from which the relevant receptacle is, as part of the operation, to be transported in a relevant manner by railway or waterborne transport pursuant to a relevant contract made before the journey began; or
(b) from a railhead or water transport terminal to which the relevant receptacle has, as part of the operation, been transported in a relevant manner by railway or waterborne transport.
(2) There must be carried in the cab of the drawing vehicle a document—
(a) if the vehicle is on a journey to a railhead or water transport terminal, specifying the railhead or water transport terminal, the date the relevant contact was made and the parties to that contract;
(b) if the vehicle is on a journey from a railhead or water transport terminal, specifying the railhead or water transport terminal and the date and time at which the receptacles were collected from that railhead or water transport terminal.
4 
The following conditions must be satisfied in relation to the drawing vehicle, namely—
(a) it complies with the relevant braking requirement;
(b) every driving axle not being a steering axle is fitted with twin tyres; and
(c) either every driving axle is fitted with road friendly suspension or no axle has an axle weight exceeding 8,500kg.
5 

(1) The motor vehicle and trailer must have a total of at least 6 axles.
(2) The total laden weight of the motor vehicle and trailer must not exceed 44,000kg.
PART III
6 

(1) The motor vehicle comprised in the articulated vehicle must be being used for the conveyance of a loading unit as part of an intermodal transport operation, the loading unit being on a journey—
(a) to a railhead or water transport terminal from which the loading unit is, as part of the operation, to be transported in a relevant manner by railway or waterborne transport pursuant to a relevant contract made before the journey began; or
(b) from a railhead or water transport terminal to which the loading unit has, as part of the operation, been transported in a relevant manner by railway or waterborne transport.
(2) If the loading unit is a bi–modal vehicle, the semi–trailer comprised in the articulated vehicle must be the bi–modal vehicle in its semi–trailer mode.
(3) If the loading unit is a relevant receptacle, the relevant receptacle must be being carried on the semi–trailer comprised in the articulated vehicle.
(4) There must be carried in the cab of the motor vehicle a document—
(a) if the vehicle is on a journey to a railhead or water transport terminal, specifying the railhead or water transport terminal, the date the contract was made and the parties to that contract;
(b) if the vehicle is on a journey from a railhead or water transport terminal, specifying the railhead or water transport terminal and the date and time at which the loading unit was collected from that railhead or water transport terminal.
7 
The following conditions must be satisfied in relation to the motor vehicle, namely—
(a) it complies with the relevant braking requirements;
(b) it has at least three axles;
(c) every driving axle not being a steering axle is fitted with twin tyres; and
(d) either every driving axle is fitted with road friendly suspension or no axle has an axle weight exceeding 8,500kg.
8 

(1) The articulated vehicle must have a total of at least 6 axles.
(2) The laden weight of the articulated vehicle must not exceed the weight determined in accordance with sub-paragraph (3).
(3) The weight for the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) is the number of kilograms equal to the product of the distance measured in metres between the king-pin and the centre of the rearmost axle of the semi-trailer multiplied by 5500 and rounded up to the nearest 10 kg, if that number is less than 44000 kg.
PART IIIA
8A 

(1) The requirements of paragraph 6 are fulfilled.
(2) The vehicle is one which falls within the first indent of paragraph 1 of Article 3 of Community Directive 96/53 (vehicles used in international traffic or put into circulation in any other Member State) and complies with the limit values specified in paragraph 2.2.2 of Annex I and the other relevant requirements of that Directive.
PART IV
9 

(1) In this Schedule—
 “bi–modal vehicle” means a semi–trailer which can be adapted for use as a railway vehicle or for waterborne transport;
 “journey”, except in sub–paragraph (3), means a journey by road;
 “loading unit” means a bi–modal vehicle , road-rail semi-trailer  or a relevant receptacle;
 “railhead” means a facility for the transhipment of—
(a) bi–modal vehicles from the ground onto the track of a railway, or
(b) relevant receptacles from road vehicles onto railway vehicles situated on the track of a railway, or, 
(c) road-rail semi-trailers from the ground onto railway vehicles on the track of a railway,or vice versa;
 “relevant contract” means a contract for the transport of a loading unit by railway  or waterborne transport;
 “relevant receptacle” means a receptacle (not being a vehicle) having a length of at least 6.1m designed and constructed for repeated use for the carriage of goods on, and for transfer between, road vehicles and railway vehicles;
 “road-rail semi-trailer” means a semi-trailer constructed or adapted so as to be capable of being both used as a semi-trailer on roads and carried on a railway vehicle;
 “water transport terminal” means a facility for the transhipment of any of the following—
(a) a vehicle from the ground or from a railway vehicle onto a waterborne vessel;
(b) a vehicle from a waterborne vessel onto the ground or onto a railway vehicle;
(c) a relevant receptacle from the ground or from a road or rail vehicle onto a waterborne vessel;
(d) a relevant receptacle from a waterborne vessel onto the ground or onto a road or rail vehicle;
(e) a road-rail semi-trailer from the ground onto a waterborne vessel;
(f) a road-rail semi-trailer from a waterborne vessel onto the ground;
 “road friendly suspension” and “twin tyres” have the meanings given by regulation 75; and
 “network”, “network licence”, “railway vehicle”, “track” and “train” have the meanings given by section 83 of the Railways Act 1993.
(2) The definition of “railway” in section 67(1) of the Transport and Works Act 1992 shall have effect for the purposes of this Schedule as it has effect for the purposes of that Act, and cognate expressions shall be construed accordingly.
(3) In these Regulations, a reference to an intermodal transport operation is a reference to the transport of one or more containers or swap bodies where all of the following conditions are met—
(a) the total maximum length of the containers or swap bodies is no more than 45 feet;
(b) the initial or final leg of the journey uses the road;
(c) another leg of the journey uses rail or waterborne transport;
(d) no goods are added to or removed from the loading unit between the time when the journey begins and when it ends; and
(e) the length of the initial or the final road leg does not exceed 150 km in Great Britain, except where necessary to reach the nearest transport terminal.
(4) Subject to sub–paragraph (5), for the purposes of this Schedule—
(a) a bi–modal vehicle shall be regarded as being transported by railway in a relevant manner if and only if the vehicle in its railway vehicle mode is travelling by railway as part of a train; ...
(b) a relevant receptacle shall be regarded as being transported by railway in a relevant manner if and only if it is being carried on a railway vehicle which forms part of a train, and
(c) a road-rail semi-trailer shall be regarded as being transported by railway in a relevant manner if and only if it is being carried on a railway vehicle which forms part of a train.
(5) A relevant receptacle shall be regarded, for the purposes of this Schedule, as not being transported by railway in a relevant manner at any time when—
(a) the relvant receptacle is in or on a motor vehicle or trailer; and
(b) the motor vehicle or trailer is being carried on a railway vehicle.
(6) A road-rail semi-trailer shall be regarded, for the purposes of this Schedule, as not being transported by railway in a relevant manner at any time when it is being carried on a railway vehicle as part of an articulated vehicle.
SCHEDULE 12
(see regulations 81 and 82)
PART I
1 

(a) Before
using on a road a vehicle or vehicles to which this paragraph applies, the
owner shall give notice of the intended use to the Chief Officer of Police
for any area in which he proposes to use the vehicle or vehicles. The notice
shall be given so that it is received by the date after which there are at
least two working days before the date on which the use of the vehicle or
vehicles is to begin, and shall include the following details—
(i) time,
date and route of the proposed journey, and
(ia) in a case to which regulation 7(9) applies, the overall length of the trailer,
(ii) 
in a case to which regulation 82(2)
applies, the overall length and width of the vehicle by which the load is
carried and the width of the lateral projection or projections of its load,

(iii) 
in a case to which regulation 82(4)(a)
applies, the overall length and width of each vehicle by which the load is
carried, the length of any forward or rearward projection and, where the load
rests on more than one vehicle, the distance between the vehicles,
(iv) 
in a case to which regulation 82(4)(b)
applies, the overall length of the combination of vehicles and the length
of any forward or rearward projection of the load, and
(v) in
a case to which regulation 82(7) and (8)
applies, the overall length of the vehicle and the length of any forward or
rearward projection of the load or special appliance or apparatus.The Chief Officer of Police for any police area may, at his discretion,
accept a shorter period of notice or fewer details.
(b) The vehicle
or vehicles shall be used only in accordance with the details at (a) subject to any variation in the time, date or
route which may be directed by—
(i) any
such Chief Officer of Police to the owner of the vehicle or vehicles, or
(ii) 
a police constable to the driver in the interests of road safety or in order
to avoid undue traffic congestion by halting the vehicle or vehicles in a
place on or adjacent to the road on which the vehicle or vehicles are travelling.

(c) In this
paragraph—
(i) “Chief
Officer of Police” has, in relation
to England and Wales, the same meaning as in the Police Act 1964, and in relation
to Scotland, means the chief constable of the Police Service of Scotland,

(ii) “working
day” means a day which is not a
Sunday, a bank holiday, Christmas Day or Good Friday, and
(iii) “bank holiday”
 means a day which is a bank holiday
by or under the Banking and Financial Dealings
Act 1971, either generally or in the locality
in which the road is situated.
2 
At least one person
in addition to the person or persons employed in driving a motor vehicle to
which this paragraph applies shall be employed—
(a) in attending
to that vehicle and its load and any other vehicle or vehicles drawn by that
vehicle and the load or loads carried on the vehicle or vehicles so drawn,
and
(b) to give
warning to the driver of the said motor vehicle and to any person of any danger
likely to be caused to any such other person by reason of the presence of
the said vehicle or vehicles on the road.
Provided that, where
three or more vehicles as respects which the conditions in this paragraph
are applicable are travelling together in convoy, it shall be a sufficient
compliance with this paragraph if only the foremost and rearmost vehicles
in the convoy are attended in the manner prescribed in this paragraph.
For the purpose of this paragraph when a motor vehicle is drawing
a trailer or trailers—
(i) any person
employed in pursuance of section 34
of the 1972 Act in attending that vehicle or any such trailer shall be treated
as being an attendant required by this paragraph so long as he is also employed
to discharge the duties mentioned in this paragraph; and
(ii) when
another motor vehicle is used for the purpose of assisting in their propulsion
on the road, the person or persons employed in driving that other motor vehicle
shall not be treated as a person or persons employed in attending to the first-mentioned
vehicle or any vehicle or vehicles drawn thereby.
3 

(a) Every forward
and rearward projection to which this paragraph applies shall be fitted with—

(i) an
end marker, except in the case of a rearward projection which is fitted with
a rear marking in accordance with the Lighting Regulations, and
(ii) 
where required by sub-paragraphs (c) and (d) of this paragraph, two or more side markers;
which shall be of the size, shape and colour described in Part II of this Schedule.
(b) the end
marker shall be so fitted that—
(i) it
is as near as is practicable in a transverse plane,
(ii) 
it is not more than 0.5 m from the extreme end of the projection,
(iii) 
the vertical distance between the lowest point of the marker and the road
surface is not more than 2.5 m,
(iv) 
it, and any means by which it is fitted to the projection, impedes the view
of the driver as little as possible, and
(v) it
is clearly visible within a reasonable distance to a person using the road
at the end of the vehicle from which the projection extends;
(c) where the
forward projection exceeds 2 m or the rearward projection exceeds 3 m, one
side marker shall be fitted on the right hand side and one on the left hand
side of the projection so that—
(i) each
marker is as near as is practicable in a longitudinal plane,
(ii) 
no part extends beyond the end of the projection,
(iii) 
the vertical distance between the lowest part of each marker and the surface
of the road is not more than 2.5 m,
(iv) 
the horizontal distance between each marker and the end marker or, as the
case may be, the rear marking carried in accordance with the Lighting Regulations
does not exceed 1 m, and
(v) each
marker is clearly visible within a reasonable distance to a person using the
road on that side of the projection;
(d) where—

(i) a forward
projection exceeds 4.5 m, or
(ii) 
a rearward projection exceeds 5 mextra side markers shall be fitted on either side of the projection
so that the horizontal distance between the extreme projecting point of the
vehicle from which the projection extends and the nearest point on any side
marker from that point, and between the nearest points of any adjacent side
markers on the same side does not exceed—
 2.5 m in the case of a forward projection, or
 3.5 m in the case of a rearward projection.For the purposes of this sub-paragraph the expression “the vehicle”
 shall not include any special appliance
or apparatus or any part thereof which is a forward projection or a rearward
projection within the meaning of regulation 81;

(e) the extra
side markers required by this sub-paragraph shall also meet the requirements
of (i), (iii) and (v) of sub-paragraph (c);
(f) every marker
fitted in accordance with this paragraph shall be kept clean and unobscured
and  between sunset and sunrise  be illuminated by a lamp which renders it
readily visible from a reasonable distance and which is so shielded that its
light, except as reflected from the marker, is not visible to other persons
using the road.
4 

A projection to which this paragraph applies shall be rendered clearly visible
to other persons using the road within a reasonable distance, in the case
of a forward projection, from the front thereof or, in the case of a rearward
projection, from the rear thereof and, in either case, from either side thereof.

5 

(a) Subject to sub-paragraph (d), every load carried on a vehicle in circumstances where this paragraph applies shall be fitted on each side and in the prescribed manner, with—
(i) a prescribed marker in such a position that it is visible from the front of the vehicle, and
(ii) a prescribed marker in such a position that it is visible from the rear of the vehicle,
(b) For the purposes of sub-paragraph (a)—
(i) a marker on a side of the load is fitted in the prescribed manner if at least part of it is within 50mm of a longitudinal plane passing through the point on that side of the load which is furthest from the axis of the vehicle; and
(ii) a prescribed marker is a marker of the size, shape and colour described in Part II of this Schedule.
(c) Every marker fitted pursuant to this paragraph shall be kept clean and between sunset and sunrise be illuminated by a lamp which renders it readily visible from a reasonable distance and which is so shielded that its light, except as reflected from the marker, is not visible to other persons using the road.
(d) If the load does not extend beyond the longitudinal plane passing through the extreme projecting point on one side of the vehicle, it shall not be necessary for a marker to be fitted to the load on that side.
PART II
(see paragraph 3(a) and 5(b) of this Schedule)
SCHEDULE 13
(see regulation 3(2))
1 
A vehicle displays a plate in accordance with the requirements of this Schedule if a plate in respect of which the following conditions are satisfied is displayed on the vehicle in a prominent position.
(2) The conditions are–
(a) the plate must be in the form shown in the diagram below;
(b) the plate must be at least 150mm wide and at least 120mm high;
(c) the figures “5” and “0” must be at least 100mm high and 50mm wide with a stroke width of at least 12mm, the figures being black on a white background; and
(d) the border must be black and between 3mm and 5mm wide.